db8de08055ebb3d0c5e014649a9acf8811e6022c
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.58 2009/10/16 08:52:05 tom Exp $
2 .
3 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
5 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
6 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
7 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
8 .
9 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
10 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
11 . unwanted vertical space.
12 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13
14 .include stdflags
15 .include stdmacs
16
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
19 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20
21 .docbook
22
23 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
25 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
26 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
27 . processors.
28 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29
30 .literal xml
31 <?sdop
32 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
33 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
34 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
35 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
36 ?>
37 .literal off
38
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
41 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42
43 .book
44
45 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
46 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
47 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
48 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
49
50 .set previousversion "4.69"
51 .set version "4.70"
52
53 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
54 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
55
56
57 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
58 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
59 . provided in the xfpt library.
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61
62 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
63
64 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
65
66 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
67 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
68
69 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
70 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
71
72 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
73 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
74 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
75 . --- index entry.
76
77 .macro option
78 .arg 5
79 .oindex "&%$5%&"
80 .endarg
81 .arg -5
82 .oindex "&%$1%&"
83 .endarg
84 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
85 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
86 .endtable
87 .endmacro
88
89 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
90 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
91 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
92
93 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
94 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
95 .endmacro
96
97 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
98 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
99 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
100
101 .macro irow
102 .arg 4
103 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
104 .endarg
105 .arg -4
106 .arg 3
107 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
108 .endarg
109 .arg -3
110 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
111 .endarg
112 .endarg
113 .endmacro
114
115 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
116 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
117 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
118 . --- ID that ties them together.
119
120 .macro cindex
121 &<indexterm role="concept">&
122 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
123 .arg 2
124 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
125 .endarg
126 &</indexterm>&
127 .endmacro
128
129 .macro scindex
130 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
131 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
132 .arg 3
133 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
134 .endarg
135 &</indexterm>&
136 .endmacro
137
138 .macro ecindex
139 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
140 .endmacro
141
142 .macro oindex
143 &<indexterm role="option">&
144 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
145 .arg 2
146 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
147 .endarg
148 &</indexterm>&
149 .endmacro
150
151 .macro vindex
152 &<indexterm role="variable">&
153 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
154 .arg 2
155 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
156 .endarg
157 &</indexterm>&
158 .endmacro
159
160 .macro index
161 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
162 .endmacro
163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
164
165
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
168 . output formats.
169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
170
171 .literal xml
172 <bookinfo>
173 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
174 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
175 <date>09 June 2009</date>
176 <author><firstname>Philip</firstname><surname>Hazel</surname></author>
177 <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
178 <affiliation><orgname>University of Cambridge Computing Service</orgname></affiliation>
179 <address>New Museums Site, Pembroke Street, Cambridge CB2 3QH, England</address>
180 <revhistory><revision>
181 <revnumber>4.70</revnumber>
182 <date>10 June 2009</date>
183 <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>2009</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
186 </bookinfo>
187 .literal off
188
189
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
191 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
192 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
193 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
194 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
195
196 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
197 .literal xml
198
199 <indexterm role="variable">
200 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
201 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
202 </indexterm>
203 <indexterm role="concept">
204 <primary>address</primary>
205 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
206 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
207 </indexterm>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
211 </indexterm>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
215 </indexterm>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CR character</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
219 </indexterm>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>CRL</primary>
222 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
223 </indexterm>
224 <indexterm role="concept">
225 <primary>delivery</primary>
226 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
227 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
228 </indexterm>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>dialup</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
232 </indexterm>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>exiscan</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
236 </indexterm>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>failover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
240 </indexterm>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>fallover</primary>
243 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
244 </indexterm>
245 <indexterm role="concept">
246 <primary>filter</primary>
247 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
248 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
249 </indexterm>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>ident</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
253 </indexterm>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>LF character</primary>
256 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
257 </indexterm>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>maximum</primary>
260 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
261 </indexterm>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>monitor</primary>
264 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
265 </indexterm>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
268 <see>entry for xxx</see>
269 </indexterm>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>NUL</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
273 </indexterm>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>passwd file</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
277 </indexterm>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>process id</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
281 </indexterm>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>RBL</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
285 </indexterm>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>redirection</primary>
288 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
289 </indexterm>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>return path</primary>
292 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
293 </indexterm>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>scanning</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
297 </indexterm>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>SSL</primary>
300 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
301 </indexterm>
302 <indexterm role="concept">
303 <primary>string</primary>
304 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
305 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
306 </indexterm>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>top bit</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
310 </indexterm>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>variables</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
314 </indexterm>
315 <indexterm role="concept">
316 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
317 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
318 </indexterm>
319
320 .literal off
321
322
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
324 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
325 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
326 . chapter "Introduction"
327 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
328
329 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
330 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
331 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
332 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
333
334 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
335 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
336 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
337 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
338 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
339 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
340 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
341
342 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
343 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
344 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
345
346 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
347 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
348 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
349
350 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
351 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
352 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
353 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
354 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
355
356 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
357 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
358 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
359 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
360 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
361
362 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
363 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
364 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
365 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
366 contributors.
367
368
369 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
370 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
371 .new
372 .cindex "documentation"
373 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
374 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
375 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
376 capable of showing a change indicator.
377 .wen
378
379 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
380 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
381 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
382 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
383 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
384 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
385 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
386 very wide interest.
387
388 .cindex "books about Exim"
389 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
390 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
391 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
392 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
393
394 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
395 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
396 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
397 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
398
399 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
400 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
401 Debian-specific features in the file
402 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
403 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
404 information.
405
406 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
407 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
408 .cindex "change log"
409 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
410 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
411 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
412 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
413 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
414
415 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
416 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
417 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
418 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
419
420 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
421 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
422
423 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
424 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
425 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
426 directory are:
427
428 .table2 100pt
429 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
430 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
431 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
432 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
433 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
434 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
435 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
436 .endtable
437
438 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
439 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
440 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
441
442
443
444 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
445 .cindex "web site"
446 .cindex "FTP site"
447 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
448 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
449 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
450 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
451 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
452 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
453
454 .cindex "wiki"
455 .cindex "FAQ"
456 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
457 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
458 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
459 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
460 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
461
462 .cindex Bugzilla
463 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
464 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
465 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
466
467
468
469 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
470 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
471 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
472
473 .table2 140pt
474 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
475 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
476 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
477 .row &'exim-future@exim.org'& "Discussion of long-term development"
478 .endtable
479
480 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
481 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
482 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
483 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
484 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
485 via this web page:
486 .display
487 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
488 .endd
489 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
490 lists.
491
492 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
493 .cindex "training courses"
494 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
495 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
496 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
497 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
498
499 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
500 .cindex "bug reports"
501 .cindex "reporting bugs"
502 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
503 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
504 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
505 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
506
507
508
509 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
510 .cindex "FTP site"
511 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
512 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
513 .display
514 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
515 .endd
516 This is mirrored by
517 .display
518 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
519 .endd
520 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
521 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
522 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
523
524 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
525 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
526 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
527 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
528 .display
529 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
530 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
531 .endd
532 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
533 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
534 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
535
536 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
537 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
538 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
539 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
540 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
541 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
542 in:
543 .display
544 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
545 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
546 .endd
547 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
548 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
549 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
550
551 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
552 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
553 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
554 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
555 .display
556 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
557 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
558 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
559 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
560 .endd
561 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
562 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
563
564
565 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
566 .ilist
567 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
568 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
569 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
570 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
571 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
572 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
573 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
574 .next
575 .cindex "domainless addresses"
576 .cindex "address" "without domain"
577 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
578 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
579 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
580 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
581 arrival.
582 .next
583 .cindex "transport" "external"
584 .cindex "external transports"
585 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
586 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
587 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
588 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
589 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
590 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
591 .next
592 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
593 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
594 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
595 other means.
596 .next
597 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
598 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
599 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
600 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
601 a number of common scanners are provided.
602 .endlist
603
604
605 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
606 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
607 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
608 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
609 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
610 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
611
612
613 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
614 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
615 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
616 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
617 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
618 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
619 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
620 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
621 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
622 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
623 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
624 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
625
626 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
627 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
628 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
629 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
630
631
632
633 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
634 .cindex "terminology definitions"
635 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
636 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
637 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
638 below) by a blank line.
639
640 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
641 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
642 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
643 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
644 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
645 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
646 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
647 rise to further bounce messages.
648
649 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
650 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
651 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
652 otherwise.
653
654 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
655 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
656 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
657 until a later time.
658
659 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
660 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
661 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
662
663 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
664 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
665 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
666 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
667 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
668 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
669 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
670 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
671
672 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
673 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
674 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
675 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
676 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
677 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
678 line.
679
680 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
681 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
682 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
683 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
684 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
685
686 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
687 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
688 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
689 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
690 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
691 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
692
693 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
694 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
695 message's envelope.
696
697 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
698 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
699 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
700 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
701 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
702
703 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
704 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
705 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
706 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
707 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
708
709 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
710 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
711 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
712 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
713 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
714 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
715
716
717
718
719
720
721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
723
724 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
725 .cindex "incorporated code"
726 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
727 .cindex "PCRE"
728 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
729
730 .ilist
731 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
732 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
733 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
734 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
735 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
736 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
737 .next
738 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
739 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
740 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
741 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
742 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
743 following statements:
744
745 .blockquote
746 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
747
748 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
749 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
750 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
751 version.
752 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
753 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
754 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
755 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
756 restrictions applied to it).
757 .endblockquote
758 .next
759 .cindex "SPA authentication"
760 .cindex "Samba project"
761 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
762 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
763 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
764 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
765 under the Gnu GPL.
766 .next
767 .cindex "Cyrus"
768 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
769 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
770 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
771 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
772 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
773 conditions expressed therein.
774
775 .blockquote
776 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
777
778 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
779 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
780 are met:
781
782 .olist
783 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
784 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
785 .next
786 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
787 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
788 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
789 distribution.
790 .next
791 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
792 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
793 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
794 details, please contact
795 .display
796 Office of Technology Transfer
797 Carnegie Mellon University
798 5000 Forbes Avenue
799 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
800 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
801 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
802 .endd
803 .next
804 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
805 acknowledgment:
806
807 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
808 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
809
810 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
811 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
812 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
813 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
814 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
815 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
816 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
817 .endlist
818 .endblockquote
819
820 .next
821 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
822 .cindex "X-windows"
823 .cindex "Athena"
824 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
825 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
826 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
827 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
828
829 .blockquote
830 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
831 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
832
833 All Rights Reserved
834
835 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
836 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
837 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
838 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
839 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
840 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
841 software without specific, written prior permission.
842
843 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
844 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
845 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
846 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
847 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
848 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
849 SOFTWARE.
850 .endblockquote
851
852 .next
853 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
854 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
855 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
856 .endlist
857
858
859
860
861
862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
864
865 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
866 "Receiving and delivering mail"
867
868
869 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
870 .cindex "design philosophy"
871 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
872 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
873 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
874 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
875 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
876 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
877
878
879 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
880 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
881 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
882 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
883 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
884 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
885 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
886
887 .ilist
888 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
889 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
890 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
891 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
892 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
893 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
894 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
895 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
896 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
897 error code.
898 .next
899 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
900 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
901 .next
902 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
903 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
904 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
905 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
906 .next
907 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
908 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
909 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
910 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
911 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
912 .next
913 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
914 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
915 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
916 .next
917 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
918 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
919 runs at the start of every delivery process.
920 .endlist
921
922
923
924 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
925 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
926 .cindex "Sieve filter"
927 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
928 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
929 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
930 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
931 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
932 of filtering are available:
933
934 .ilist
935 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
936 by RFC 3028.
937 .next
938 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
939 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
940 .endlist
941
942 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
943
944
945
946 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
947 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
948 .cindex "format" "of message id"
949 .cindex "id of message"
950 .cindex "base62"
951 .cindex "base36"
952 .cindex "Darwin"
953 .cindex "Cygwin"
954 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
955 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
956 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
957 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
958 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
959 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
960 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
961 not always case-sensitive.
962
963 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
964 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
965 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
966 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
967 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
968 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
969 somewhat eccentric:
970
971 .ilist
972 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
973 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
974 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
975 way of representing the date and time of day).
976 .next
977 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
978 received the message.
979 .next
980 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
981 .olist
982 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
983 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
984 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
985 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
986 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
987 .next
988 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
989 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
990 (1/100) of a second.
991 .endlist
992 .endlist
993
994 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
995 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
996 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
997 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
998 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
999
1000
1001 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1002 .cindex "receiving mail"
1003 .cindex "message" "reception"
1004 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1005 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1006 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1007 there are several possibilities:
1008
1009 .ilist
1010 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1011 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1012 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1013 .next
1014 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1015 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1016 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1017 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1018 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1019 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1020 .next
1021 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1022 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1023 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1024 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1025 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1026 .next
1027 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1028 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1029 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1030 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1031 .endlist
1032
1033
1034 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1035 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1036 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1037 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1038 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1039 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1040 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1041 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1042 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1043 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1044 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1045 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1046 users to change sender addresses.
1047
1048 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1049 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1050 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1051 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1052 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1053 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1054 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1055
1056 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1057 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1058 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1059 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1060 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1061 message is received.
1062
1063
1064
1065
1066
1067 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1068 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1069 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1070 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1071 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1072 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1073 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1074 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1075
1076 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1077 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1078 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1079 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1080 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1081 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1082 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1083 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1084 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1085 affect file system performance.
1086
1087 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1088 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1089 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1090 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1091 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1092
1093 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1094 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1095 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1096 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1097 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1098 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1099 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1100 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1101 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1102 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1103 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1104 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1105
1106
1107
1108 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1109 .cindex "message" "life of"
1110 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1111 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1112 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1113 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1114 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1115 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1116 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1117
1118 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1119 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1120 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1121 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1122 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1123 to be sent.
1124
1125 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1126 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1127 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1128 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1129 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1130
1131 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1132 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1133 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1134 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1135 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1136 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1137 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1138 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1139 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1140 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1141 systems.
1142
1143 .cindex "journal file"
1144 .cindex "file" "journal"
1145 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1146 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1147 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1148 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1149 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1150 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1151 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1152 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1153
1154 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1155 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1156 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1157 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1158 deliveries caused by crashes.
1159
1160
1161
1162 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1163 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1164 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1165 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1166 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1167 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1168 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1169 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1170 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1171
1172 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1173 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1174 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1175 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1176 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1177 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1178 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1179 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1180 the driver's features in general.
1181
1182 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1183 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1184 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1185 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1186 to be bounced.
1187
1188 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1189 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1190 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1191 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1192 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1193 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1194
1195 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1196 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1197 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1198 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1199 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1200 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1201
1202 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1203 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1204 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1205 configuration.
1206
1207 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1208 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1209 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1210 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1211 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1212 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1213 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1214 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1215 configured to fail the address.
1216
1217 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1218 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1219 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1220 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1221 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1222 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1223
1224 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1225 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1226 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1227 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1228 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1229 the address is bounced.
1230
1231
1232
1233 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1234 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1235 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1236 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1237 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1238 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1239 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1240 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1241
1242 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1243 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1244 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1245 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1246 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1247 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1248 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1249 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1250
1251
1252
1253
1254 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1255 .cindex "router" "running details"
1256 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1257 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1258 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1259 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1260 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1261 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1262 the following:
1263
1264 .ilist
1265 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1266 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1267 original address ceases,
1268 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1269 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1270 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1271 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1272 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1273 end of routing.
1274
1275 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1276 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1277 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1278 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1279 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1280 .next
1281 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1282 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1283 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1284 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1285 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1286 .next
1287 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1288 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1289 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1290 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1291 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1292 .next
1293 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1294 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1295 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1296 .next
1297 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1298 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1299 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1300 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1301 .next
1302 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1303 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1304 .endlist
1305
1306 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1307 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1308 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1309 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1310 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1311
1312 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1313 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1314 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1315 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1316 facility for this purpose.
1317
1318
1319 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1320 .cindex "case of local parts"
1321 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1322 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1323 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1324 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1325 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1326 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1327 routed addresses are shown.
1328
1329
1330
1331 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1332 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1333 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1334 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1335 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1336 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1337
1338 .ilist
1339 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1340 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1341 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1342 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1343 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1344 of any other conditions.
1345 .next
1346 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1347 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1348 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1349 address.
1350 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1351 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1352 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1353 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1354 .next
1355 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1356 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1357 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1358 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1359 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1360 .next
1361 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1362 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1363 .next
1364 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1365 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1366 .next
1367 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1368 of domains that it defines.
1369 .next
1370 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1371 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1372 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1373 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1374 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1375 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1376 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1377 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1378 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1379 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1380 .next
1381 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1382 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1383 .vindex "&$home$&"
1384 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1385 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1386 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1387 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1388 remaining preconditions.
1389 .next
1390 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1391 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1392 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1393 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1394 could lead to confusion.
1395 .next
1396 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1397 set of addresses that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1400 specified files is tested.
1401 .next
1402 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1403 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1404 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1405 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1406 .endlist
1407
1408
1409 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1410 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1411 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1412 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1413 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1414 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1415 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1416
1417
1418
1419 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1420 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1421 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1422
1423 .ilist
1424 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1425 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1426 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1427 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1428 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1429 filtering'&.
1430 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1431 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1432
1433 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1434 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1435 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1436 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1437 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1438 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1439 filter.
1440 .next
1441 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1442 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1443 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1444 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1445 processed entirely independently of each other.
1446 .next
1447 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1448 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1449 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1450 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1451 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1452 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1453 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1454 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1455 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1456 .next
1457 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1458 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1459 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1460 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1461 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1462 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1463 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1464 addresses to the same domain.
1465 .next
1466 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1467 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1468 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1469 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1470 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1471 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1472 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1473 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1474 .next
1475 .cindex "queue runner"
1476 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1477 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1478 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1479 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1480 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1481 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1482 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1483 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1484 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1485 .next
1486 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1487 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1488 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1489 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1490 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1491 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1492 .next
1493 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1494 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1495 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1496 messages to other addresses.
1497 .next
1498 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1499 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1500 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1501 &'deferred'&.
1502 .next
1503 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1504 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1505 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1506 .endlist
1507
1508
1509
1510
1511 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1512 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1513 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1514 .cindex "queue runner"
1515 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1516 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1517 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1518 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1519 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1520 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1521 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1522 passed its retry time.
1523 You can run several queue runners at once.
1524
1525 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1526 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1527 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1528 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1529 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1530 as permanent.
1531
1532
1533
1534 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1535 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1536 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1537 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1538 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1539 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1540 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1541 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1542 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1543 also apply.
1544
1545 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1546 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1547 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1548 deferred,
1549
1550 .cindex "hints database"
1551 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1552 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1553 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1554 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1555 one connection.
1556
1557
1558
1559
1560 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1561 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1562 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1563 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1564 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1565 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1566 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1567 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1568 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1569 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1570 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1571
1572 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1573 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1574 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1575 automatically.
1576
1577 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1578 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1579 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1580 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1581 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1582 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1583 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1584 of the list.
1585
1586
1587
1588 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1590 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1591 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1592 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1593 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1594 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1595 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1596
1597
1598
1599
1600
1601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1603
1604 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1605 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1606
1607 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1608 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1609 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1610 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1611
1612 .table2 140pt
1613 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1614 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1615 documented"
1616 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1617 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1618 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1619 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1620 instructions"
1621 .endtable
1622
1623 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1624 following subdirectories are created:
1625
1626 .table2 140pt
1627 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1628 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1629 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1630 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1631 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1632 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1633 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1634 .endtable
1635
1636 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1637 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1638 that may be useful to some sites.
1639
1640
1641 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1642 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1643 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1644 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1645 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1646 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1647 system.
1648 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1649 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1650 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1651 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1652 overridden if necessary.
1653
1654
1655 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1656 .cindex "PCRE library"
1657 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1658 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1659 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1660 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1661 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1662 headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
1663 and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
1664 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1665 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1666
1667 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1668 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1669 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1670 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1671 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1672 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1673 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1674
1675 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1677 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1678 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1679 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1680 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1681 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1682 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1683
1684 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1685 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1686 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1687 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1688 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1689 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1690 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1691 Berkeley DB library.
1692
1693 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1694 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1695 possibilities:
1696
1697 .olist
1698 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1699 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1700 .next
1701 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1702 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1703 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1704 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1705 file name is used unmodified.
1706 .next
1707 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1708 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1709 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1710 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1711 .next
1712 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1713 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1714 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1715 .next
1716 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1717 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1718 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1719 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1720 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1721 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1722 .next
1723 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1724 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1725 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1726 operates on a single file.
1727 .endlist
1728
1729 .cindex "USE_DB"
1730 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1731 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1732 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1733 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1734 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1735 .code
1736 USE_DB=yes
1737 .endd
1738 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1739 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1740
1741 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1742 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1743 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1744 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1745 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1746 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1747
1748 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1749 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1750 in one of these lines:
1751 .code
1752 DBMLIB = -ldb
1753 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1754 .endd
1755 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1756 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1757 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1758 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1759 this example:
1760 .code
1761 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1762 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1763 .endd
1764 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1765 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1766
1767
1768
1769 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1770 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1771 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1772 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1773 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1774 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1775 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1777 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1778 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1779 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1780 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1781
1782 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1783 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1784 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1785 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1786 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1787 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1788
1789 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1790 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1791 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1792 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1793 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1794 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1795 be logged.
1796
1797 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1798 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1799 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1800 facilities, you need to set
1801 .code
1802 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1803 .endd
1804 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1805 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1806
1807
1808 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1809 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1810 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1811 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1812 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1813 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1814 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1815
1816 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1817 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1818 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1819 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1820 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1821 do this.
1822
1823
1824
1825 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1826 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1827 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1828 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1829 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1830 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1831 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1832 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1833 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1834 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1835
1836 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1837 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1838 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1839 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1840 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1841 .code
1842 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1843 .endd
1844 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1845
1846
1847
1848 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1849 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1850 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1851 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1852 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1853 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1854 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1855 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1856 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1857 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1858 line option).
1859
1860 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1861 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1862 implementing SSL.
1863
1864 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1865 .code
1866 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1867 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1868 .endd
1869 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1870 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1871 .code
1872 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1873 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1874 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1875 .endd
1876 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1877 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1878 .code
1879 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1880 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1881 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1882 .endd
1883 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1884 library and include files. For example:
1885 .code
1886 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1887 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1888 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1889 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1890 .endd
1891 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1892 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1893 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1894
1895
1896
1897
1898 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1899 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1900 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1901 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1902 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1903 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1904 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1905 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1906 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1907 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1908 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1909 you might have
1910 .code
1911 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1912 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1913 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1914 .endd
1915 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control files is
1916 &"exim"&. For example, the line
1917 .code
1918 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1919 .endd
1920 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1921 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1922 All other connections are denied. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1923 further details.
1924
1925
1926
1927 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1928 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1929 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1930 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1931 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1932 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1933 library files.
1934
1935 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1936 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1937 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1938 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1939 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1940 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1941 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1942 support has not been tested for some time.
1943
1944
1945
1946 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1947 .cindex "build directory"
1948 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1949 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1950 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1951 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1952 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
1953 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
1954 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1955
1956 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
1957 building process fails if it is set.
1958
1959 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
1960 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1961 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1962 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1963 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1964 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
1965 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1966 directory, should this ever be necessary.
1967
1968 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1969 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
1970 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
1971
1972
1973
1974 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
1975 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
1976 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
1977 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
1978 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
1979 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
1980 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
1981 .code
1982 FULLECHO='' make -e
1983 .endd
1984 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
1985 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
1986 given in addition to the short output.
1987
1988
1989
1990 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
1991 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
1992 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
1993 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
1994 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
1995 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
1996 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
1997 order:
1998 .display
1999 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2000 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2001 &_Local/Makefile_&
2002 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2003 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2004 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2005 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2006 .endd
2007 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2008 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2009 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2010 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2011 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2012 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2013 and are often not needed.
2014
2015 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2016 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2017 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2018 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2019 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2020 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2021 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2022 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2023 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2024
2025
2026 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2027 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2028 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2029 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2030 default values are.
2031
2032
2033 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2034 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2035 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2036 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2037 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2038 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2039 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2040 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2041 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2042 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2043 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2044 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2045 containing the lines
2046 .code
2047 CC=cc
2048 CFLAGS=-std1
2049 .endd
2050 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2051 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2052
2053 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2054 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2055 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2056
2057
2058 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2059 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2060 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2061 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2062 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2063 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2064 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2065 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2066 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2067 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2068 .code
2069 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2070 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2071 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2072 .endd
2073 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2074 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2075 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2076 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2077 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2078 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2079 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2080 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2081 errors.
2082
2083 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2084 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2085 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2086 .code
2087 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2088 .endd
2089 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2090 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2091
2092 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2093 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2094 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2095 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2096 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2097 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2098 .code
2099 X11=/usr/X11R6
2100 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2101 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2102 .endd
2103 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2104 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2105 .code
2106 X11=/usr/openwin
2107 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2108 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2109 .endd
2110 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2111 definition of all three of these variables into your
2112 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2113
2114 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2115 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2116 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2117 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2118 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2119
2120 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2121 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2122 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2123 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2124 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2125 libraries.
2126
2127 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2128 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2129 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2130 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2131 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2132
2133
2134 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2135 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2136 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2137 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2138 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2139 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2140 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2141 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2142
2143
2144
2145 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2146 .cindex "building Eximon"
2147 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2148 where the files that are involved are
2149 .display
2150 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2151 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2152 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2153 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2154 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2155 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2156 .endd
2157 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2158 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2159 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2160 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2161 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2162 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2163 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2164 .ecindex IIDbuex
2165
2166
2167 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2168 .cindex "installing Exim"
2169 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2170 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2171 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2172 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2173 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2174 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2175 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2176 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2177 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2178 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2179 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2180 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2181
2182 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2183 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2184 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2185 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2186 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2187 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2188 alternative files, no default is installed.
2189
2190 .cindex "system aliases file"
2191 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2192 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2193 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2194 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2195 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2196 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2197 and outputs a comment to the user.
2198
2199 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2200 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2201 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2202 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2203 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2204
2205 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2206 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2207 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2208 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2209 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2210 over SMTP.
2211
2212 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2213 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2214 command such as
2215 .code
2216 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2217 .endd
2218 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2219 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2220 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2221 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2222 but this usage is deprecated.
2223
2224 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2225 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2226 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2227 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2228 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2229 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2230
2231 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2232 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2233 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2234 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2235 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2236 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2237 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2238
2239 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2240 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2241 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2242 command:
2243 .code
2244 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2245 .endd
2246 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2247 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2248 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2249 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2250 command:
2251 .code
2252 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2253 .endd
2254 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2255 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2256
2257 .ilist
2258 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2259 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2260 .next
2261 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2262 installed binary.
2263 .endlist
2264
2265 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2266 .code
2267 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2268 .endd
2269 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2270 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2271 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2272 .code
2273 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2274 .endd
2275
2276
2277
2278 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2279 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2280 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2281 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2282 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2283 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2284
2285 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2286 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2287 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2288
2289
2290
2291 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2292 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2293 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2294 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2295 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2296 necessary.
2297
2298
2299
2300
2301 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2302 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2303 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2304 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2305 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2306 .code
2307 exim -bV
2308 .endd
2309 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2310 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2311 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2312 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2313 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2314 example,
2315 .display
2316 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2317 .endd
2318 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2319 .display
2320 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2321 .endd
2322 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2323 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2324 user agent. For example:
2325 .code
2326 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2327 From: user@your.domain.example
2328 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2329 Subject: Testing Exim
2330
2331 This is a test message.
2332 ^D
2333 .endd
2334 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2335 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2336 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2337
2338 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2339 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2340 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2341 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2342 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2343 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2344 .display
2345 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2346 .endd
2347 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2348 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2349 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2350 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2351 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2352
2353 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2354 .cindex "lock files"
2355 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2356 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2357 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2358 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2359 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2360 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2361 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2362 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2363 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2364 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2365 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2366 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2367
2368 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2369 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2370 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2371 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2372 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2373 incoming SMTP mail.
2374
2375 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2376 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2377 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2378 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2379 production version.
2380
2381
2382 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2383 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2384 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2385 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2386 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2387 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2388 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2389 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2390 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2391 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2392 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2393 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2394 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2395
2396 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2397 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2398 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2399 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2400 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2401 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2402 as follows:
2403 .code
2404 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2405 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2406 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2407 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2408 .endd
2409 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2410 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2411 favourite user agent.
2412
2413 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2414 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2415 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2416 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2417 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2418 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2419
2420
2421
2422 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2423 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2424 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2425 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2426 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2427 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2428 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2429 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2430 configuration file.
2431
2432
2433
2434
2435 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2436 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2437 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2438 .code
2439 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2440 .endd
2441 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2442 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2443 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2444 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2445 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2446 .code
2447 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2448 .endd
2449 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2450
2451 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2452 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2453 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2454
2455
2456
2457
2458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2459 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2460
2461 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2462 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2463 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2464 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2465 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2466 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2467 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2468 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2469 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2470
2471
2472 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2473 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2474 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2475 were present before any other options.
2476 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2477 standard output.
2478 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2479 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2480 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2481
2482 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2483 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2484 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2485 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2486 format.
2487
2488 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2489 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2490 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2491 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2492
2493 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2494 .cindex "queue runner"
2495 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2496 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2497 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2498
2499 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2500 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2501 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2502 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2503 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2504 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2505 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2506 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2507
2508
2509 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2510 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2511 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2512 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2513 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2514 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2515
2516 .ilist
2517 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2518 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2519 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2520 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2521 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2522 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2523
2524 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2525 .cindex "envelope sender"
2526 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2527 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2528 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2529 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2530 users to set envelope senders.
2531
2532 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2533 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2534 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2535 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2536 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2537
2538 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2539 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2540 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2541 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2542 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2543 that are available to trusted users.
2544 .next
2545 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2546 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2547 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2548 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2549 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2550
2551 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2552 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2553 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2554 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2555
2556 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2557 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2558 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2559 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2560
2561 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2562 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2563 false.
2564 .endlist
2565
2566
2567 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2568 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2569 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2570 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2571
2572
2573
2574
2575 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2576 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2577 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2578 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2579 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2580 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2581 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2582 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2583
2584 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2585 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2586 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2587 . creates a man page for the options.
2588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2589
2590 .literal xml
2591 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2592 .literal off
2593
2594
2595 .vlist
2596 .vitem &%--%&
2597 .oindex "--"
2598 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2599 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2600 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2601 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2602
2603 .vitem &%--help%&
2604 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2605 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2606 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2607 no arguments.
2608
2609 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2610 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2611 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2612 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2613 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2614 clean; it ignores this option.
2615
2616 .vitem &%-bd%&
2617 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2618 .cindex "daemon"
2619 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2620 .cindex "queue runner"
2621 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2622 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2623 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2624
2625 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2626 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2627 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2628 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2629
2630 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2631 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2632 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2633 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2634
2635 When a listening daemon
2636 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2637 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2638 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2639 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2640 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2641 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2642 running as root.
2643
2644 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2645 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2646 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2647
2648 The SIGHUP signal
2649 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2650 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2651 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2652 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2653 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2654 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2655 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2656 because these are reread each time they are used.
2657
2658 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2659 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2660 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2661 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2662
2663 .vitem &%-be%&
2664 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2665 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2666 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2667 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2668 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2669 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2670 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2671
2672 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2673 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2674 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2675 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2676 test data. A line history is supported.
2677
2678 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2679 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2680 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2681 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2682 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2683 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2684 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2685
2686 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2687 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2688 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2689 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2690
2691 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2692 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2693 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2694 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2695 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2696 of a file. For example:
2697 .code
2698 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2699 .endd
2700 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2701 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2702 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2703 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2704 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2705 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2706 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2707 &%-be%&).
2708
2709 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2710 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2711 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2712 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2713 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2714 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2715 system filters are recognized.
2716
2717 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2718 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2719 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2720 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2721 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2722 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2723 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2724 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2725 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2726 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2727 supplied.
2728
2729 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2730 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2731 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2732 .code
2733 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2734 .endd
2735 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2736 variables that are used by the user filter.
2737
2738 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2739 .code
2740 # Exim filter
2741 # Sieve filter
2742 .endd
2743 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2744 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2745 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2746 redirection lists.
2747
2748 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2749 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2750 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2751 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2752
2753 When testing a filter file,
2754 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2755 .cindex "envelope sender"
2756 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2757 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2758 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2759 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2760 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2761 options).
2762
2763 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2764 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2765 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2766 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2767 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2768 &$qualify_domain$&.
2769
2770 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2771 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2772 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2773 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2774 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2775 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2776 actually being delivered.
2777
2778 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2779 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2780 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2781 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2782 prefix.
2783
2784 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2785 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2786 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2787 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2788 suffix.
2789
2790 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2791 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2792 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2793 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2794 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2795 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2796 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2797 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2798 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2799 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2800 after a full stop. For example:
2801 .code
2802 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2803 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2804 .endd
2805 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2806 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2807 conversion to the canonical form is
2808 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2809
2810 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2811 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2812 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2813 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2814 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2815
2816 &*Warning 1*&:
2817 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2818 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2819 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2820 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2821 connection.
2822
2823 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2824 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2825 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2826
2827 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2828 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2829 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2830 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2831 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2832 session were authenticated.
2833
2834 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2835 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2836 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2837
2838 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2839 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2840 specialized SMTP test program such as
2841 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2842
2843 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2844 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2845 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2846 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2847 updating the callout cache database.
2848
2849 .vitem &%-bi%&
2850 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2851 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2852 .cindex "building alias file"
2853 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2854 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2855 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2856 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2857 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2858 recognized.
2859
2860 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2861 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2862 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2863 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2864 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2865 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2866 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2867
2868 .vitem &%-bm%&
2869 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
2870 .cindex "local message reception"
2871 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2872 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2873 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2874 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2875 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2876 if no other conflicting option is present.
2877
2878 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2879 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2880 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2881 suppressing this for special cases.
2882
2883 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2884 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2885
2886 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2887 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2888 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2889
2890 The format
2891 .cindex "message" "format"
2892 .cindex "format" "message"
2893 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2894 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2895 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2896 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2897 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2898 .code
2899 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2900 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2901 .endd
2902 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2903 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2904 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2905 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2906 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2907
2908 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2909 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2910 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2911 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2912 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2913
2914 .vitem &%-bnq%&
2915 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
2916 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2917 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2918 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2919 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2920 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2921 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2922 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2923
2924 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
2925 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2926 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2927 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2928 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2929
2930 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2931 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2932 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2933 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2934
2935
2936 .vitem &%-bP%&
2937 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
2938 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
2939 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
2940 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2941 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2942 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2943 arguments, for example:
2944 .code
2945 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2946 .endd
2947 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
2948 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
2949 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
2950 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
2951 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2952 users, the output is as in this example:
2953 .code
2954 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2955 .endd
2956 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2957 configuration file is output.
2958 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2959 is the name of the file that was actually used.
2960
2961 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2962 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2963 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
2964 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
2965 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
2966 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
2967 written directly into the spool directory.
2968
2969 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
2970 .code
2971 exim -bP +local_domains
2972 .endd
2973 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
2974 local part) and outputs what it finds.
2975
2976 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
2977 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
2978 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
2979 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
2980 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
2981 that driver are output. For example:
2982 .code
2983 exim -bP transport local_delivery
2984 .endd
2985 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
2986 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
2987 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
2988 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
2989 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
2990 &%authenticators%&.
2991
2992 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
2993 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
2994 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
2995 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
2996 The output format is one item per line.
2997
2998 .vitem &%-bp%&
2999 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3000 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3001 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3002 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3003 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3004 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3005 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3006 to allow any user to see the queue.
3007
3008 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3009 .code
3010 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3011 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3012 <other addresses>
3013 .endd
3014 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3015 .cindex "size" "of message"
3016 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3017 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3018 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3019 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3020 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3021 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3022 before the sender address.
3023
3024 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3025 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3026 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3027
3028 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3029 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3030 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3031 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3032 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3033 complete.
3034
3035
3036 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3037 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3038 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3039 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3040 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3041 of just &"D"&.
3042
3043
3044 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3045 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3046 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3047 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3048 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3049 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3050
3051
3052 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3053 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3054 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3055 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3056 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3057 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3058
3059 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3060 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3061 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3062
3063 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3064 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3065 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3066
3067
3068 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3069 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3070 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3071 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3072 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3073 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3074
3075
3076 .vitem &%-brt%&
3077 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3078 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3079 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3080 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3081 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3082 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3083 .code
3084 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3085 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3086 .endd
3087 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3088 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3089 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3090 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3091 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3092 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3093 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3094 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3095 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3096 .code
3097 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3098 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3099 .endd
3100
3101 .vitem &%-brw%&
3102 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3103 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3104 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3105 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3106 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3107 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3108 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3109 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3110
3111 .vitem &%-bS%&
3112 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3113 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3114 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3115 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3116 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3117 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3118 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3119 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3120 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3121 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3122
3123 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3124 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3125 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3126
3127 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3128 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3129 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3130 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3131
3132 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3133 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3134 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3135
3136 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3137 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3138 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3139 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3140 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3141
3142 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3143 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3144
3145 .vitem &%-bs%&
3146 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3147 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3148 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3149 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3150 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3151 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3152 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3153 messages to the MTA.
3154
3155 In
3156 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3157 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3158 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3159 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3160 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3161 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3162 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3163
3164 .cindex "inetd"
3165 The
3166 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3167 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3168 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3169 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3170 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3171 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3172 the listening daemon.
3173
3174 .vitem &%-bt%&
3175 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3176 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3177 .cindex "address" "testing"
3178 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3179 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3180 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3181 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3182 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3183
3184 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3185 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3186
3187 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3188 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3189 security issues.
3190
3191 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3192 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3193 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3194 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3195 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3196 program.
3197
3198 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3199 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3200 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3201 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3202
3203 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3204 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3205 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3206 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3207 always shown.
3208
3209 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3210 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3211 message,
3212 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3213 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3214 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3215 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3216 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3217 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3218 doing such tests.
3219
3220 .vitem &%-bV%&
3221 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3222 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3223 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3224 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3225 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3226 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3227 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3228
3229 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3230 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3231 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3232 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3233 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3234 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3235 dynamic testing facilities.
3236
3237 .vitem &%-bv%&
3238 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3239 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3240 .cindex "address" "verification"
3241 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3242 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3243 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3244 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3245 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3246 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3247
3248 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3249 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3250 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3251
3252 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3253 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3254
3255 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3256 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3257 security issues.
3258
3259 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3260 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3261 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3262 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3263 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3264
3265 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3266 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3267 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3268 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3269 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3270 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3271 to succeed.
3272
3273 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3274 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3275 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3276
3277 The
3278 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3279 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3280 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3281 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3282
3283 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3284 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3285 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3286 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3287
3288 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3289 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3290 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3291 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3292 might happen.
3293
3294 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3295 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3296 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3297 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3298 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3299 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3300 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3301 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3302 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3303 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3304 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3305
3306 When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3307 list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3308 immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3309 the caller. However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in
3310 &_Local/Makefile_&, root privilege is retained for &%-C%& only if the caller of
3311 Exim is root.
3312
3313 That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3314 option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3315 However, if you are using a &"packaged"& version of Exim (source or binary),
3316 the packagers might have enabled it.
3317
3318 Setting ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY locks out the possibility of testing a
3319 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
3320 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
3321 as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the delivery,
3322 the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception
3323 and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue,
3324 using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3325
3326 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3327 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3328 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3329 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3330 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3331 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3332 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3333
3334 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3335 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3336 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3337 configuration file.
3338
3339 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3340 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3341 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3342 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3343 specified by this option.
3344
3345 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3346 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3347 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3348 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3349 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3350 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3351 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3352 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3353
3354 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3355 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3356 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3357 synonymous:
3358 .code
3359 exim -DABC ...
3360 exim -DABC= ...
3361 .endd
3362 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3363 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3364 example:
3365 .code
3366 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3367 .endd
3368 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3369
3370 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3371 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3372 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3373 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3374 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3375 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3376 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3377 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3378 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3379 return code.
3380
3381 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3382 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3383 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3384 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3385 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3386 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3387 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3388 are:
3389 .display
3390 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3391 &`auth `& authenticators
3392 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3393 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3394 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3395 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3396 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3397 &`filter `& filter handling
3398 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3399 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3400 &`ident `& ident lookup
3401 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3402 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3403 &`load `& system load checks
3404 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3405 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3406 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3407 &`memory `& memory handling
3408 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3409 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3410 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3411 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3412 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3413 &`retry `& retry handling
3414 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3415 &`route `& address routing
3416 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3417 &`tls `& TLS logic
3418 &`transport `& transports
3419 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3420 &`verify `& address verification logic
3421 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3422 .endd
3423 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3424 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3425 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3426 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3427 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3428 turn everything off.
3429
3430 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3431 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3432 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3433 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3434 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3435 rather than stderr.
3436
3437 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3438 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3439 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3440 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3441 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3442 run in parallel.
3443
3444 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3445 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3446 in processing.
3447
3448 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3449 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3450
3451 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3452 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3453 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3454 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3455 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3456 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3457
3458 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3459 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3460 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3461 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3462 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3463
3464 .vitem &%-E%&
3465 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3466 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3467 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3468 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3469 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3470 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3471 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3472 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3473 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3474
3475 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3476 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3477 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3478 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3479 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3480 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3481
3482 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3483 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3484 .cindex "sender" "name"
3485 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3486 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3487 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3488 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3489 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3490 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3491
3492 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3493 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3494 .cindex "sender" "address"
3495 .cindex "address" "sender"
3496 .cindex "trusted users"
3497 .cindex "envelope sender"
3498 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3499 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3500 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3501 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3502 users to use it.
3503
3504 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3505 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3506 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3507 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3508 domain.
3509
3510 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3511 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3512 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3513 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3514 examples of shell commands:
3515 .code
3516 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3517 exim -f "" user@domain
3518 .endd
3519 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3520 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3521 &%-bv%& options.
3522
3523 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3524 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3525 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3526 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3527
3528 White
3529 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3530 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3531 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3532 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3533 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3534 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3535
3536 .vitem &%-G%&
3537 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3538 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3539 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3540
3541 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3542 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3543 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3544 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3545 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3546 headers.)
3547
3548 .vitem &%-i%&
3549 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3550 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3551 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3552 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3553 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3554 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3555 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3556
3557 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3558 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3559 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3560 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3561 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3562 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3563 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3564 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3565 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3566
3567 Retry
3568 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3569 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3570 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3571 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3572 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3573 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3574
3575 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3576 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3577 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3578 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3579
3580 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3581 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3582 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3583 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3584 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3585 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3586 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3587 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3588 can be used only by an admin user.
3589
3590 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3591 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3592 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3593 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3594 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3595 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3596 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3597 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3598 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3599 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3600 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3601
3602 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3603 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3604 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3605 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3606 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3607
3608 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3609 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3610 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3611 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3612 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3613
3614 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3615 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3616 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3617 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3618 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3619 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3620 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3621 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3622
3623 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3624 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3625 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3626 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3627 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3628 connection.
3629
3630 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3631 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3632 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3633 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3634 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3635
3636 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3637 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3638 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3639 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3640 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3641 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3642 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3643 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3644 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3645 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3646 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3647 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3648 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3649 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3650 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3651
3652 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3653 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3654 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3655 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3656 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3657 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3658 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3659 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3660 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3661 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3662
3663 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3664 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3665 .cindex "freezing messages"
3666 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3667 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3668 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3669 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3670 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3671 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3672 user.
3673
3674 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3675 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3676 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3677 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3678 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3679 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3680 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3681 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3682 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3683 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3684 user.
3685
3686 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3687 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3688 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3689 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3690 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3691 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3692 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3693
3694 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3695 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3696 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3697 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3698 .cindex "removing recipients"
3699 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3700 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3701 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3702 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3703 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3704 can be used only by an admin user.
3705
3706 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3707 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3708 .cindex "removing messages"
3709 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3710 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3711 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3712 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3713 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3714 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3715 placed on the queue.
3716
3717 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3718 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3719 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3720 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3721 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3722 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3723 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3724 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3725 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3726 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3727 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3728
3729 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3730 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3731 .cindex "thawing messages"
3732 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3733 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3734 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3735 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3736 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3737 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3738 by an admin user.
3739
3740 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3741 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3742 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3743 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3744 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3745 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3746
3747 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3748 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3749 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3750 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2922 format"
3751 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3752 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3753 only by an admin user.
3754
3755 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3756 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3757 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3758 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3759 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3760 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3761 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3762
3763 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3764 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3765 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3766 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3767 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3768 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3769
3770 .vitem &%-m%&
3771 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3772 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3773 treats it that way too.
3774
3775 .vitem &%-N%&
3776 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3777 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3778 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3779 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3780 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3781 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3782 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3783 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3784 than &"=>"&.
3785
3786 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3787 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3788 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3789 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3790 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3791 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3792 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3793 for that message.
3794
3795 .vitem &%-n%&
3796 .oindex "&%-n%&"
3797 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3798 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3799 by Exim.
3800
3801 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3802 .oindex "&%-O%&"
3803 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3804 Exim.
3805
3806 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3807 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
3808 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3809 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3810 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3811 description above.
3812
3813 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3814 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
3815 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3816 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3817 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3818 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3819 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3820 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3821
3822 .vitem &%-odb%&
3823 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
3824 .cindex "background delivery"
3825 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3826 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3827 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3828 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3829 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3830 processes to finish.
3831
3832 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3833 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3834 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3835 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3836
3837 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3838 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3839 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3840 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3841
3842 .vitem &%-odf%&
3843 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
3844 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3845 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3846 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3847 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3848 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3849 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3850
3851 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3852 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3853 during deliveries.
3854
3855 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3856 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3857
3858 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3859 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3860 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3861 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3862
3863
3864 .vitem &%-odi%&
3865 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
3866 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3867 Sendmail.
3868
3869 .vitem &%-odq%&
3870 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
3871 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3872 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3873 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3874 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3875 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3876 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3877 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3878 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3879 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3880 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3881 forces queueing.
3882
3883 .vitem &%-odqs%&
3884 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
3885 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3886 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3887 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3888 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3889 configuration file is in effect.
3890
3891 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3892 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3893 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3894 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3895 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3896 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3897 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3898 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
3899 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3900 &%-qq%& option.
3901
3902 .vitem &%-oee%&
3903 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
3904 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3905 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3906 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3907 message.
3908
3909 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
3910 Provided
3911 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3912 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3913 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3914 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3915
3916 .vitem &%-oem%&
3917 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
3918 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3919 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
3920 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3921 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3922 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3923
3924 .vitem &%-oep%&
3925 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
3926 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3927 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3928 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3929 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
3930 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3931
3932 .vitem &%-oeq%&
3933 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
3934 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3935 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3936 effect as &%-oep%&.
3937
3938 .vitem &%-oew%&
3939 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
3940 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3941 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3942 effect as &%-oem%&.
3943
3944 .vitem &%-oi%&
3945 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
3946 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3947 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
3948 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
3949 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
3950 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
3951 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
3952
3953 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
3954 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
3955 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
3956
3957 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
3958 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
3959 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
3960 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
3961 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3962 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3963 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
3964 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3965
3966 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
3967 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3968 .code
3969 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3970 .endd
3971 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
3972 followed by a colon and the port number:
3973 .code
3974 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3975 .endd
3976 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
3977 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
3978 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
3979 whichever one is last.
3980
3981 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
3982 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
3983 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
3984 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
3985 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
3986 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
3987 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
3988 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
3989
3990 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
3991 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
3992 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
3993 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
3994 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
3995 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
3996 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
3997 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
3998
3999 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4000 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4001 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4002 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4003 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4004 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4005 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4006 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4007 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4008 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4009
4010 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4011 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4012 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4013 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4014 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4015 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4016 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4017
4018 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4019 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4020 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4021 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4022 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4023 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4024 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4025 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4026 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4027 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4028 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4029 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4030
4031 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4032 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4033 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4034 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4035 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4036 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4037 uses the name it is given.
4038
4039 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4040 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4041 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4042 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4043 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4044 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4045 used, when there is no default.
4046
4047 .vitem &%-om%&
4048 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4049 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4050 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4051 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4052 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4053
4054 .vitem &%-oo%&
4055 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4056 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4057 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4058 whatever that means.
4059
4060 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4061 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4062 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4063 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4064 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4065 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4066 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4067 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4068 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4069
4070 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4071 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4072 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4073 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4074 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4075 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4076 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4077
4078 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4079 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4080 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4081 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4082 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4083 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4084 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4085 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4086
4087 .vitem &%-ov%&
4088 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4089 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4090
4091 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4092 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4093 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4094 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4095 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4096 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4097 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4098 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4099 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4100 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4101
4102 .vitem &%-pd%&
4103 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4104 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4105 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4106 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4107 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4108 needed.
4109
4110 .vitem &%-ps%&
4111 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4112 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4113 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4114 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4115 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4116 started.
4117
4118 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4119 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4120 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4121 .display
4122 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4123 .endd
4124 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4125 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4126 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4127 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4128 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4129
4130 .vitem &%-q%&
4131 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4132 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4133 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4134 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4135 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4136 and &%-S%& options).
4137
4138 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4139 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4140 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4141 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4142 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4143 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4144
4145 If
4146 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4147 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4148 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4149 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4150 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4151 proceeding.
4152
4153 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4154 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4155 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4156 this to be repeated periodically.
4157
4158 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4159 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4160 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4161 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4162
4163 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4164 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4165 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4166
4167 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4168 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4169 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4170 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4171
4172 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4173 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4174 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4175 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4176 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4177 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4178 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4179 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4180 transports are run.
4181
4182 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4183 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4184 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4185 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4186 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4187 delivered down a single SMTP
4188 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4189 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4190 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4191 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4192 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4193 intermittently.
4194
4195 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4196 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4197 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4198 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4199 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4200 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4201 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4202
4203 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4204 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4205 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4206 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4207 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4208 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4209 their retry times are tried.
4210
4211 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4212 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4213 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4214 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4215 frozen or not.
4216
4217 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4218 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4219 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4220 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4221 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4222 for later delivery.
4223
4224 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4225 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4226 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4227 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4228 starting message id. For example:
4229 .code
4230 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4231 .endd
4232 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4233 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4234 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4235 .code
4236 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4237 .endd
4238 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4239 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4240 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4241 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4242 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4243 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4244
4245 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4246 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4247 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4248 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4249 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4250 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4251 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4252 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4253 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4254 .code
4255 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4256 .endd
4257 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4258 process every 30 minutes.
4259
4260 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4261 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4262
4263 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4264 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4265 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4266 compatibility.
4267
4268 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4269 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4270 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4271
4272 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4273 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4274 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4275 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4276 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4277 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4278 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4279 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4280 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4281
4282 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4283 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4284 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4285 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4286 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4287 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4288
4289 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4290 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4291 .code
4292 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4293 .endd
4294 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4295 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4296 applied to each queue run.
4297
4298 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4299 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4300 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4301 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4302 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4303 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4304 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4305 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4306 address will be skipped.
4307
4308 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4309 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4310 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4311 &'ff'& is present.
4312
4313 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4314 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4315 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4316 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4317 an arbitrary command instead.
4318
4319 .vitem &%-r%&
4320 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4321 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4322
4323 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4324 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4325 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4326 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4327 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4328 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4329 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4330 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4331
4332 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4333 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4334 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4335 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4336 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4337
4338 .vitem &%-t%&
4339 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4340 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4341 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4342 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4343 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4344 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4345 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4346 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4347 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4348 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4349
4350 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4351 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4352 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4353 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4354 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4355 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4356 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4357 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4358 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4359 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4360 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4361
4362 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4363 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4364 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4365 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4366 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4367 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4368
4369 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4370 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4371 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4372 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4373 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4374 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4375 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4376 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4377 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4378
4379 .vitem &%-ti%&
4380 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4381 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4382 compatibility with Sendmail.
4383
4384 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4385 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4386 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4387 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4388 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4389 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4390 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4391 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4392
4393
4394 .vitem &%-U%&
4395 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4396 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4397 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4398 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4399 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4400 set. Exim ignores this option.
4401
4402 .vitem &%-v%&
4403 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4404 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4405 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4406 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4407 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4408 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4409 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4410 unconditional.
4411
4412 .vitem &%-x%&
4413 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4414 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4415 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4416 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4417 this option.
4418 .endlist
4419
4420 .ecindex IIDclo1
4421 .ecindex IIDclo2
4422
4423
4424 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4425 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4426 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4427 . creates a man page for the options.
4428 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4429
4430 .literal xml
4431 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4432 .literal off
4433
4434
4435
4436
4437
4438 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4440
4441
4442 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4443 "The runtime configuration file"
4444
4445 .cindex "run time configuration"
4446 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4447 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4448 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4449 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4450 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4451 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4452 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4453 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4454 control.
4455
4456 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4457 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4458 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4459 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4460 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4461 actually alter the string.
4462
4463 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4464 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4465 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4466 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4467 existing file in the list.
4468
4469 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4470 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4471 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4472 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4473 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4474 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4475 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4476 specified at compile time by the EXIM_USER option, or by the user that is
4477 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4478 configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
4479 group is the one specified at compile time by the EXIM_GROUP option or by the
4480 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4481
4482 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4483 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4484 easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
4485 of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
4486 configuration is not group writeable.
4487
4488 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4489 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4490 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4491 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4492 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4493 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4494 configuration.
4495
4496
4497
4498 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4499 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4500 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4501 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4502 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the
4503 Exim user (or unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value
4504 from CONFIGURE_FILE). &%-C%& is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4505 configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4506 on a configuration file specified by &%-C%&.
4507
4508 The privileged use of &%-C%& by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4509 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. However,
4510 if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4511 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
4512 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
4513 as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4514 use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4515 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
4516 &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
4517
4518 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4519 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4520 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4521 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4522 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4523
4524 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4525 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4526 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4527 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4528 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4529 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4530
4531 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4532 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4533 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4534 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4535 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4536 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4537 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4538
4539 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4540 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4541 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4542
4543
4544
4545 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4546 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4547 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4548 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4549 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4550 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4551 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4552 optional parts are:
4553
4554 .ilist
4555 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4556 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4557 .next
4558 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4559 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4560 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4561 .next
4562 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4563 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4564 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4565 .next
4566 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4567 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4568 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4569 .next
4570 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4571 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4572 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4573 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4574 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4575 .next
4576 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4577 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4578 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4579 .next
4580 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4581 want to use this feature, you must set
4582 .code
4583 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4584 .endd
4585 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4586 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4587 .endlist
4588
4589 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4590 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4591 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4592 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4593
4594 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4595 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4596 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4597 and does not introduce a comment.
4598
4599 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4600 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4601 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4602 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4603 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4604
4605 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4606 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4607 change settings as required.
4608
4609 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4610 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4611 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4612 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4613 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4614 described.
4615
4616
4617
4618 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4619 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4620 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4621 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4622 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4623 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4624 using this syntax:
4625 .display
4626 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4627 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4628 .endd
4629 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4630 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4631 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4632 name is required.
4633
4634 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4635 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4636 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4637 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4638
4639 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4640 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4641 for example:
4642 .code
4643 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4644 .include /some/file
4645 .endd
4646 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4647 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4648 inclusion appears.
4649
4650
4651
4652 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4653 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4654 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4655 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4656 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4657 definition, and must be of the form
4658 .display
4659 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4660 .endd
4661 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4662 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4663 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4664 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4665 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4666
4667 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4668 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4669 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4670
4671 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4672 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4673 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4674 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4675 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4676 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4677 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4678 define
4679 .display
4680 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4681 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4682 .endd
4683 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4684 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4685 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4686 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4687 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4688 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4689
4690
4691 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4692 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4693 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4694 &'='&. For example:
4695 .code
4696 MAC = initial value
4697 ...
4698 MAC == updated value
4699 .endd
4700 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4701 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4702 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4703 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4704 .code
4705 MAC = initial value
4706 ...
4707 MAC == MAC and something added
4708 .endd
4709 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4710 from a number of other files.
4711
4712 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4713 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4714 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4715 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4716 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4717 file to be ignored.
4718
4719
4720
4721 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4722 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4723 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4724 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4725 .code
4726 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4727 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4728 .endd
4729 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4730 .code
4731 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4732 .endd
4733 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4734 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4735 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4736
4737
4738 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4739 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4740 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4741 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4742 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4743 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4744 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4745
4746 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4747 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4748 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4749 line. Thus:
4750 .code
4751 .ifdef AAA
4752 message_size_limit = 50M
4753 .else
4754 message_size_limit = 100M
4755 .endif
4756 .endd
4757 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4758 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4759 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4760 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4761
4762 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4763 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4764 in this line"& will always be true.
4765
4766 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4767 to clarify complicated nestings.
4768
4769
4770
4771 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4772 .cindex "common option syntax"
4773 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4774 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4775 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4776 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4777 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4778 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4779 space) and then the value. For example:
4780 .code
4781 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4782 .endd
4783 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4784 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4785 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4786 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4787 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4788 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4789 word &"hide"&. For example:
4790 .code
4791 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4792 .endd
4793 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4794 .code
4795 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4796 .endd
4797 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4798 all instances of the same driver.
4799
4800 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4801 that are found in option settings.
4802
4803
4804 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4805 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4806 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4807 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4808 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4809 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4810 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4811 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4812 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4813 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4814 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4815 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4816 .code
4817 queue_only
4818 queue_only = true
4819 .endd
4820 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4821 .code
4822 no_queue_only
4823 queue_only = false
4824 .endd
4825 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4826
4827
4828
4829
4830 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4831 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4832 .cindex "format" "integer"
4833 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4834 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4835 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4836 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4837 hexadecimal number.
4838
4839 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4840 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4841 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4842 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4843 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4844 used.
4845
4846
4847 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4848 .cindex "integer format"
4849 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4850 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4851 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4852 Such options are always output in octal.
4853
4854
4855 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4856 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4857 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
4858 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4859 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4860
4861
4862
4863 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4864 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4865 .cindex "format" "time interval"
4866 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4867 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4868
4869 .table2 30pt
4870 .irow &%s%& seconds
4871 .irow &%m%& minutes
4872 .irow &%h%& hours
4873 .irow &%d%& days
4874 .irow &%w%& weeks
4875 .endtable
4876
4877 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4878 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4879 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
4880
4881
4882
4883 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
4884 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
4885 .cindex "format" "string"
4886 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
4887 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
4888 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
4889 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
4890 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
4891 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
4892 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
4893 therefore equivalent:
4894 .code
4895 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4896 trusted_users = uucp:\
4897 # This comment line is ignored
4898 mail
4899 .endd
4900 .cindex "string" "quoted"
4901 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
4902 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4903 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4904 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4905
4906 .table2 100pt
4907 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
4908 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
4909 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
4910 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
4911 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
4912 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
4913 character"
4914 .endtable
4915
4916 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4917 character, that character replaces the pair.
4918
4919 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4920 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4921 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4922 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4923 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4924 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4925
4926
4927 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
4928 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
4929 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
4930 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4931 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
4932 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
4933 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
4934 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
4935 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
4936 within a quoted configuration string.
4937
4938
4939 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
4940 .cindex "user name" "format of"
4941 .cindex "format" "user name"
4942 .cindex "groups" "name format"
4943 .cindex "format" "group name"
4944 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4945 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4946 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4947 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
4948
4949
4950 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
4951 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
4952 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
4953 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
4954 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4955 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
4956 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
4957 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
4958 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
4959 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
4960 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
4961
4962 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4963 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
4964 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
4965 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
4966 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4967 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4968 example, the list
4969 .code
4970 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
4971 .endd
4972 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
4973
4974 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
4975 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
4976 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
4977 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
4978
4979 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
4980 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
4981 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
4982 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
4983 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
4984 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
4985 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
4986 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
4987 .code
4988 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
4989 .endd
4990 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
4991 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
4992 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
4993
4994 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
4995 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
4996 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
4997 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
4998 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
4999 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5000 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5001 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5002 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5003 .code
5004 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5005 .endd
5006 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5007 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5008 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5009 the value in quotes. For example:
5010 .code
5011 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5012 .endd
5013 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5014 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5015 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5016 enclosing an empty list item.
5017
5018
5019
5020 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5021 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5022 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5023 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5024 .code
5025 senders = user@domain :
5026 .endd
5027 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5028 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5029 items, the second of which is empty:
5030 .code
5031 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5032 .endd
5033 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5034 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5035 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5036 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5037 .code
5038 senders = :
5039 .endd
5040 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5041 is at the end of the list.
5042
5043
5044
5045
5046 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5047 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5048 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5049 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5050 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5051 a sequence of lines like this:
5052 .display
5053 <&'instance name'&>:
5054 <&'option'&>
5055 ...
5056 <&'option'&>
5057 .endd
5058 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5059 followed by three options settings:
5060 .code
5061 localuser:
5062 driver = accept
5063 check_local_user
5064 transport = local_delivery
5065 .endd
5066 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5067 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5068 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5069 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5070 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5071 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5072
5073 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5074 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5075
5076 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5077 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5078 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5079 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5080 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5081 server.
5082
5083 .cindex "generic options"
5084 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5085 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5086 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5087 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5088 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5089 .cindex "private options"
5090 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5091 they all have default values.
5092
5093 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5094 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5095 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5096
5097 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5098 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5099 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5100 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5101 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5102 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5103 configuration lines:
5104 .code
5105 remote_smtp:
5106 driver = smtp
5107 .endd
5108 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5109 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5110 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5111 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5112 thus:
5113 .code
5114 special_smtp:
5115 driver = smtp
5116 port = 1234
5117 command_timeout = 10s
5118 .endd
5119 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5120 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5121 lines.
5122
5123 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5124 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5125 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5126 option.
5127
5128
5129
5130
5131
5132
5133 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5135
5136 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5137 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5138 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5139 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5140 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5141 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5142 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5143 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5144 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5145 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5146 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5147
5148
5149
5150 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5151 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5152 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5153 the line
5154 .code
5155 # primary_hostname =
5156 .endd
5157 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5158 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5159 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5160 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5161
5162 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5163 .code
5164 domainlist local_domains = @
5165 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5166 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5167 .endd
5168 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5169 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5170 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5171 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5172
5173 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5174 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5175 on the local host.
5176
5177 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5178 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5179 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5180 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5181 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5182 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5183
5184 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5185 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5186 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5187 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5188 domain is permitted.
5189
5190 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5191 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5192 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5193 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5194 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5195 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5196
5197 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5198 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5199 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5200
5201 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5202 .code
5203 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5204 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5205 .endd
5206 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5207 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5208 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5209 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5210 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5211 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5212 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5213 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5214 contents of a message to be checked.
5215
5216 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5217 .code
5218 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5219 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5220 .endd
5221 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5222 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5223 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5224 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5225
5226 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5227 .code
5228 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5229 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5230 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5231 .endd
5232 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5233 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5234 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5235 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5236 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5237 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5238 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5239
5240 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5241 .code
5242 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5243 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5244 .endd
5245 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5246 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5247 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5248 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5249 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5250 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5251 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5252 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5253 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5254 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5255 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5256 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5257 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5258 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5259 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5260 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5261
5262 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5263 .code
5264 # qualify_domain =
5265 # qualify_recipient =
5266 .endd
5267 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5268 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5269 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5270 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5271 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5272 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5273
5274 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5275 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5276 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5277 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5278 .code
5279 # allow_domain_literals
5280 .endd
5281 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5282 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5283 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5284 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5285 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5286 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5287
5288 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5289 .code
5290 never_users = root
5291 .endd
5292 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5293 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5294 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5295 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5296 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5297 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5298 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5299 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5300
5301 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5302 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5303 line,
5304 .code
5305 host_lookup = *
5306 .endd
5307 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5308 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5309 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5310 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5311 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5312 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5313 unreachable.
5314
5315 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5316 1413 (hence their names):
5317 .code
5318 rfc1413_hosts = *
5319 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5320 .endd
5321 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5322 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5323 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5324 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5325 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5326 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5327 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5328
5329 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5330 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5331 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5332 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5333 .code
5334 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5335 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5336 .endd
5337 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5338 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5339
5340 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5341 .code
5342 # percent_hack_domains =
5343 .endd
5344 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5345 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5346 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5347
5348 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5349 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5350 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5351 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5352 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5353 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5354 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5355 always bounce messages.
5356 .code
5357 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5358 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5359 .endd
5360 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5361 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5362 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5363 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5364 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5365
5366
5367
5368 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5369 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5370 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5371 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5372 It starts with the line
5373 .code
5374 begin acl
5375 .endd
5376 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5377 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5378 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5379
5380 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5381 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5382 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5383 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5384 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5385 result of the ACL processing.
5386 .code
5387 acl_check_rcpt:
5388 .endd
5389 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5390 ACL, and names it.
5391 .code
5392 accept hosts = :
5393 .endd
5394 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5395 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5396 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5397 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5398 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5399 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5400
5401 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5402 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5403 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5404 manner.
5405 .code
5406 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5407 domains = +local_domains
5408 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5409
5410 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5411 domains = !+local_domains
5412 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5413 .endd
5414 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5415 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5416 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5417 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5418 in Internet mail addresses.
5419
5420 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5421 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5422 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5423 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5424 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5425 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5426 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5427 policy of being as safe as possible.
5428
5429 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5430 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5431 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5432 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5433 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5434 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5435
5436 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5437 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5438 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5439 have to modify this rule.
5440
5441 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5442 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5443 common convention of local parts constructed as
5444 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5445 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5446 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5447 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5448 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5449 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5450
5451 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5452 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5453 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5454 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5455 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5456 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5457 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5458 .code
5459 accept local_parts = postmaster
5460 domains = +local_domains
5461 .endd
5462 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5463 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5464 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5465 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5466 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5467
5468 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5469 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5470 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5471 .code
5472 require verify = sender
5473 .endd
5474 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5475 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5476 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5477 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5478 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5479 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5480 discusses the details of address verification.
5481 .code
5482 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5483 control = submission
5484 .endd
5485 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5486 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5487 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5488 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5489 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5490 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5491 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5492 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5493 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5494 .code
5495 accept authenticated = *
5496 control = submission
5497 .endd
5498 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5499 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5500 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5501 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5502 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5503 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5504 .code
5505 require message = relay not permitted
5506 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5507 .endd
5508 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5509 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5510 .code
5511 require verify = recipient
5512 .endd
5513 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5514 fails, the address is rejected.
5515 .code
5516 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5517 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5518 # $dnslist_text
5519 # dnslists = black.list.example
5520 #
5521 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5522 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5523 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5524 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5525 .endd
5526 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5527 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5528 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5529 line.
5530 .code
5531 # require verify = csa
5532 .endd
5533 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5534 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5535 records.
5536 .code
5537 accept
5538 .endd
5539 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5540 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5541 .code
5542 acl_check_data:
5543 .endd
5544 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5545 of this ACL are commented out:
5546 .code
5547 # deny malware = *
5548 # message = This message contains a virus \
5549 # ($malware_name).
5550 .endd
5551 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5552 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5553 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5554 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5555 .code
5556 # warn spam = nobody
5557 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5558 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5559 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5560 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5561 .endd
5562 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5563 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5564 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5565 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5566 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5567 whatever the spam score.
5568 .code
5569 accept
5570 .endd
5571 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5572
5573
5574 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5575 .cindex "default" "routers"
5576 .cindex "routers" "default"
5577 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5578 by the line
5579 .code
5580 begin routers
5581 .endd
5582 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5583 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5584 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5585 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5586 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5587 .code
5588 # domain_literal:
5589 # driver = ipliteral
5590 # domains = !+local_domains
5591 # transport = remote_smtp
5592 .endd
5593 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5594 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5595 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5596 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5597 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5598 .code
5599 dnslookup:
5600 driver = dnslookup
5601 domains = ! +local_domains
5602 transport = remote_smtp
5603 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5604 no_more
5605 .endd
5606 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5607 domains. This is specified by the line
5608 .code
5609 domains = ! +local_domains
5610 .endd
5611 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5612 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5613 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5614 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5615 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5616 passed on to the following routers.
5617
5618 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5619 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5620 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5621 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5622 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5623
5624 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5625 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5626 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5627 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5628 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5629 the address fails and is bounced.
5630
5631 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5632 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5633 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5634 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5635 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5636 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5637 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5638 out.
5639 .code
5640 system_aliases:
5641 driver = redirect
5642 allow_fail
5643 allow_defer
5644 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5645 # user = exim
5646 file_transport = address_file
5647 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5648 .endd
5649 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5650 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5651 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5652 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5653 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5654 the next router.
5655
5656 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5657 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5658 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5659 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5660 .code
5661 userforward:
5662 driver = redirect
5663 check_local_user
5664 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5665 # local_part_suffix_optional
5666 file = $home/.forward
5667 # allow_filter
5668 no_verify
5669 no_expn
5670 check_ancestor
5671 file_transport = address_file
5672 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5673 reply_transport = address_reply
5674 .endd
5675 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5676 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5677 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5678 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5679 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5680 namely:
5681 .code
5682 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5683 # local_part_suffix_optional
5684 .endd
5685 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5686 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5687 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5688 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5689 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5690 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5691 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5692
5693 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5694 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5695 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5696 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5697
5698 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5699 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5700 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5701 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5702 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5703 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5704 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5705
5706 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5707 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5708 There are two reasons for doing this:
5709
5710 .olist
5711 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5712 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5713 unnecessary work.
5714 .next
5715 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5716 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5717 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5718 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5719 this time.
5720 .endlist
5721
5722 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5723 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5724 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5725 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5726
5727 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5728 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5729 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5730 .code
5731 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5732 .endd
5733 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5734 transport.
5735 .code
5736 localuser:
5737 driver = accept
5738 check_local_user
5739 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5740 # local_part_suffix_optional
5741 transport = local_delivery
5742 .endd
5743 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5744 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5745 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5746 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5747 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5748
5749
5750 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5751 .cindex "default" "transports"
5752 .cindex "transports" "default"
5753 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5754 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5755 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5756 .code
5757 begin transports
5758 .endd
5759 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5760 .code
5761 remote_smtp:
5762 driver = smtp
5763 .endd
5764 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5765 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5766 .code
5767 local_delivery:
5768 driver = appendfile
5769 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5770 delivery_date_add
5771 envelope_to_add
5772 return_path_add
5773 # group = mail
5774 # mode = 0660
5775 .endd
5776 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5777 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5778 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5779 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5780 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5781 show how this can be done.
5782
5783 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5784 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5785 similarly-named options above.
5786 .code
5787 address_pipe:
5788 driver = pipe
5789 return_output
5790 .endd
5791 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5792 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5793 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5794 sender.
5795 .code
5796 address_file:
5797 driver = appendfile
5798 delivery_date_add
5799 envelope_to_add
5800 return_path_add
5801 .endd
5802 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5803 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5804 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5805 .code
5806 address_reply:
5807 driver = autoreply
5808 .endd
5809 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5810 filter files.
5811
5812
5813
5814 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5815 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5816 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5817 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5818 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5819 introduced by the line
5820 .code
5821 begin retry
5822 .endd
5823 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5824 errors:
5825 .code
5826 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5827 .endd
5828 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5829 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5830 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5831 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5832
5833 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5834 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5835 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5836
5837
5838 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5839 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5840 .code
5841 begin rewrite
5842 .endd
5843 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5844 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5845
5846
5847
5848 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5849 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5850 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5851 .code
5852 begin authenticators
5853 .endd
5854 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5855 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5856 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5857 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5858 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5859 to support most MUA software.
5860
5861 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5862 .code
5863 #PLAIN:
5864 # driver = plaintext
5865 # server_set_id = $auth2
5866 # server_prompts = :
5867 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5868 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5869 .endd
5870 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5871 .code
5872 #LOGIN:
5873 # driver = plaintext
5874 # server_set_id = $auth1
5875 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5876 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5877 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5878 .endd
5879
5880 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
5881 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
5882 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
5883 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
5884 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
5885 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
5886 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
5887 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
5888
5889 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
5890 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
5891 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
5892 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
5893
5894 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
5895 usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
5896 covers both.
5897
5898 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
5899
5900
5901
5902 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5903 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5904
5905 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
5906
5907 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
5908 .cindex "PCRE"
5909 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5910 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5911 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5912 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5913 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
5914 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
5915
5916 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5917 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
5918 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
5919 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
5920 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
5921 case-insensitive.
5922
5923 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5924 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5925 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5926 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5927 .code
5928 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5929 .endd
5930 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5931 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
5932 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5933 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5934 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5935 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
5936 matched.
5937
5938 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5939 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
5940 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
5941 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
5942 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
5943 match anywhere in the subject string.
5944
5945 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5946 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5947 .code
5948 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5949 .endd
5950 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
5951 You need to use:
5952 .code
5953 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5954 .endd
5955 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
5956 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
5957
5958
5959
5960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5962
5963 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
5964 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
5965 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
5966 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
5967 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
5968 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
5969
5970 .olist
5971 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
5972 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
5973 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
5974 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
5975 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
5976 .next
5977 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
5978 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
5979 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
5980 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
5981 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5982 .endlist
5983
5984 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
5985 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
5986 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
5987 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
5988 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
5989 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
5990
5991 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
5992 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
5993 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
5994 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
5995 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
5996 .code
5997 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
5998 domains = lsearch;/some/file
5999 .endd
6000 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6001 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6002 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6003 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6004 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6005 .code
6006 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6007 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6008 .endd
6009 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6010 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6011
6012 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6013 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6014 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6015 .code
6016 domain1:
6017 domain2:
6018 .endd
6019 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6020 matches the list item.
6021
6022 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6023 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6024 .code
6025 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6026 .endd
6027 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6028 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6029 causes a second lookup to occur.
6030
6031 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6032 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6033 lookup is permitted.
6034
6035
6036 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6037 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6038 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6039 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6040
6041 .ilist
6042 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6043 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6044 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6045 .next
6046 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6047 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6048 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6049 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6050 .endlist
6051
6052 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6053 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6054 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6055 .code
6056 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6057 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6058 .endd
6059 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6060 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6061 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6062
6063
6064
6065
6066 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6067 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6068 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6069 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6070
6071 .ilist
6072 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6073 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6074 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6075 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6076 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6077 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6078 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6079 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6080 be found in several places:
6081 .display
6082 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6083 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6084 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6085 .endd
6086 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6087 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6088 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6089 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6090 .next
6091 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6092 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6093 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6094 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6095 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6096 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6097 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6098
6099 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6100 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6101 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6102 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6103 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6104 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6105 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6106 .next
6107 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6108 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6109 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6110 .cindex "Courier"
6111 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6112 .cindex "dmbnz lookup type"
6113 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6114 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6115 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6116 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6117 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6118 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6119 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6120 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6121 .next
6122 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6123 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6124 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6125 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6126 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6127 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6128 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6129 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6130 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6131 .next
6132 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6133 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6134 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6135 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6136 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6137 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6138 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6139 .code
6140 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6141 192.168.0.0/16 data for 192.168.0.0/16
6142 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6143 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6144 .endd
6145 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6146 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6147 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6148 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6149 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6150
6151 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6152 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6153 lookup types support only literal keys.
6154
6155 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6156 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6157 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6158 .next
6159 .cindex "linear search"
6160 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6161 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6162 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6163 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6164 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6165 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6166 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6167 in the file is used.
6168
6169 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6170 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6171 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6172 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6173 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6174 colon, for example:
6175 .code
6176 baduser: :fail:
6177 .endd
6178 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6179 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6180 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6181 wildcarding of any kind.
6182
6183 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6184 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6185 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6186 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6187 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6188 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6189 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6190 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6191 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6192
6193 .next
6194 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6195 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6196 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6197 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6198 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6199 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6200 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6201 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6202
6203 .next
6204 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6205 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6206 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6207 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6208 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6209 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6210 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6211 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6212 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6213
6214 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6215 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6216 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6217 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6218
6219 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6220 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6221
6222 .olist
6223 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6224 .code
6225 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6226 *fish data for anythingfish
6227 .endd
6228 .next
6229 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6230 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6231 .code
6232 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6233 .endd
6234 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6235 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6236 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6237 .code
6238 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6239 .endd
6240 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6241 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6242 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6243 .code
6244 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6245 .endd
6246
6247 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6248 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6249 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6250 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6251 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6252
6253 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6254 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6255 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6256 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6257 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6258
6259 .next
6260 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6261 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6262 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6263 example:
6264 .code
6265 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6266 .endd
6267 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6268 .endlist olist
6269
6270 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6271 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6272 be followed by optional colons.
6273
6274 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6275 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6276 lookup types support only literal keys.
6277 .endlist ilist
6278
6279
6280 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6281 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6282 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6283 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6284 many of them are given in later sections.
6285
6286 .ilist
6287 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6288 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6289 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6290 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6291 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6292 .next
6293 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6294 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6295 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6296 .next
6297 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6298 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6299 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6300 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6301 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6302 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6303 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6304 .next
6305 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6306 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6307 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6308 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6309 .next
6310 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6311 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6312 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6313 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6314 .next
6315 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6316 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6317 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6318 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6319 .next
6320 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6321 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6322 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6323 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6324 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6325 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6326 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6327 password value. For example:
6328 .code
6329 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6330 .endd
6331 .next
6332 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6333 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6334 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6335 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6336
6337 .next
6338 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6339 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6340 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6341 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6342
6343 .next
6344 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6345 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6346 .next
6347 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6348 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6349 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6350 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6351 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6352 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6353 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6354 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6355 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6356 .code
6357 require condition = \
6358 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6359 .endd
6360 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6361 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6362 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6363 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6364 .endlist
6365
6366
6367
6368 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6369 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6370 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6371 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6372 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6373 options such as a list of local domains.
6374
6375 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6376 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6377 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6378 or may give up altogether.
6379
6380
6381
6382 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6383 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6384 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6385 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6386 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6387 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6388 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6389 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6390
6391 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6392 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6393 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6394
6395 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6396 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6397 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6398
6399 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6400 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6401 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6402 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6403 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6404 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6405 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6406 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6407 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6408 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6409 .code
6410 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6411 .endd
6412 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6413 looks up these keys, in this order:
6414 .code
6415 jane@eyre.example
6416 *@eyre.example
6417 *
6418 .endd
6419 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6420 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6421 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6422 Exim move on to try the next key.
6423
6424
6425
6426 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6427 .cindex "partial matching"
6428 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6429 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6430 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6431 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6432 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6433 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6434 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6435 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6436 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6437 a key in a DBM file is
6438 .code
6439 *.dates.fict.example
6440 .endd
6441 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6442 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6443 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6444 file.
6445
6446 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6447 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6448 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6449
6450 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6451 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6452 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6453 partial matching keys
6454 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6455 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6456 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6457
6458 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6459 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6460 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6461 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6462 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6463 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6464 remains.
6465
6466 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6467 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6468 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6469 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6470 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6471 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6472 .code
6473 2250.dates.fict.example
6474 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6475 *.dates.fict.example
6476 *.fict.example
6477 .endd
6478 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6479 finishes.
6480
6481 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6482 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6483 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6484 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6485 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6486 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6487 .code
6488 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6489 .endd
6490 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6491 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6492 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6493 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6494 .code
6495 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6496 .endd
6497 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6498 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6499
6500 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6501 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6502 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6503
6504 .ilist
6505 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6506 .next
6507 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6508 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6509 .next
6510 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6511 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6512 for &"*"& on its own.
6513 .next
6514 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6515 .endlist
6516
6517
6518 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6519 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6520 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6521 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6522 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6523 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6524 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6525
6526 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6527 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6528 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6529 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6530 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6531
6532
6533
6534
6535 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6536 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6537 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6538 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6539 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6540 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6541 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6542
6543 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6544 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6545 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6546 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6547 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6548 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6549
6550 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6551 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6552 complete.
6553
6554
6555
6556
6557 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6558 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6559 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6560 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6561 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6562 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6563 .code
6564 [name=$local_part]
6565 .endd
6566 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6567 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6568 .code
6569 [name="$local_part"]
6570 .endd
6571 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6572 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6573 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6574 of the following form is provided:
6575 .code
6576 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6577 .endd
6578 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6579 .code
6580 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6581 .endd
6582 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6583 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6584 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6585
6586
6587
6588
6589 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6590 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6591 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6592 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6593 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6594 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6595 an expansion string could contain:
6596 .code
6597 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6598 .endd
6599 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6600 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6601 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6602 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6603
6604 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6605 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6606 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6607 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6608 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6609 .code
6610 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6611 .endd
6612 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6613 altered and nothing is added.
6614
6615 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6616 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6617 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6618 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6619 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6620
6621 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6622 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6623 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6624 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6625 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6626 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6627 .code
6628 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6629 .endd
6630 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6631 white space is ignored.
6632
6633 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6634 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6635 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6636 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6637 the pseudo-type MXH:
6638 .code
6639 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6640 .endd
6641 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6642 returned.
6643
6644 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6645 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6646 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6647 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6648 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6649 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6650 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6651 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6652 .code
6653 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6654 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6655 .endd
6656 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6657 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6658 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6659
6660 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6661 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6662 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6663 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6664 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6665 such a list.
6666
6667 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6668 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6669 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6670 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6671 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6672 result of a successful lookup such as:
6673 .code
6674 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6675 .endd
6676 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6677 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6678 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6679
6680
6681 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6682 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6683 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6684 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6685 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6686 .code
6687 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6688 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6689 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6690 .endd
6691 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6692 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6693 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6694 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6695
6696 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6697 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6698 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6699
6700 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6701 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6702 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6703 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6704 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6705 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6706 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6707 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6708 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6709 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6710 .code
6711 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6712 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6713 .endd
6714 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6715 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6716
6717
6718
6719
6720 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6721 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6722 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6723 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6724 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6725 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6726 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6727 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6728 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6729 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6730 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6731 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6732 .code
6733 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6734 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6735 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6736 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6737 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6738 .endd
6739 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6740 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6741
6742 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6743 the way they handle the results of a query:
6744
6745 .ilist
6746 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6747 gives an error.
6748 .next
6749 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6750 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6751 .next
6752 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6753 from all of them are returned.
6754 .endlist
6755
6756
6757 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6758 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6759 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6760 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6761
6762
6763 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6764 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6765 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6766 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6767 .code
6768 data = ${lookup ldap \
6769 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6770 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6771 .endd
6772 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6773 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6774 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6775 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6776
6777
6778 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6779 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6780 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6781 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6782 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6783 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6784
6785 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6786 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6787 the string:
6788 .code
6789 * => \2A
6790 ( => \28
6791 ) => \29
6792 \ => \5C
6793 .endd
6794 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6795 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6796 .code
6797 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
6798 .endd
6799 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6800 .code
6801 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6802 .endd
6803 yields
6804 .code
6805 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6806 .endd
6807 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6808 .code
6809 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6810 .endd
6811 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6812 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6813 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6814 .code
6815 , + " \ < > ;
6816 .endd
6817 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6818 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6819 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6820 .code
6821 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6822 .endd
6823 yields
6824 .code
6825 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6826 .endd
6827 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6828 .code
6829 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6830 .endd
6831 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6832 authentication below.
6833
6834
6835 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6836 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6837 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6838 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6839 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6840 by starting it with
6841 .code
6842 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6843 .endd
6844 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6845 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6846 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6847 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6848 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6849 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6850 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6851 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6852 failures, and timeouts.
6853
6854 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6855 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6856 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6857 doubled. For example
6858 .code
6859 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6860 .endd
6861 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6862 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6863 the local host) is used.
6864
6865 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6866 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6867 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6868 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6869 not available.
6870
6871 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6872 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6873 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
6874 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6875 .code
6876 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6877 .endd
6878 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6879 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6880 .code
6881 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6882 .endd
6883 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
6884 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6885 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6886 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6887 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
6888 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6889 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6890 backup host.
6891
6892 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
6893 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6894 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
6895
6896 .ilist
6897 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
6898 interface.
6899 .next
6900 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
6901 .endlist
6902
6903
6904 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6905 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
6906
6907
6908
6909 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
6910 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
6911 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6912 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6913 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
6914 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6915 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6916 them. The following names are recognized:
6917 .display
6918 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
6919 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
6920 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
6921 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
6922 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
6923 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
6924 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
6925 .endd
6926 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
6927 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
6928 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
6929 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
6930
6931 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
6932 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6933 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6934 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6935 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6936 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6937 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6938 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
6939 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6940
6941 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6942 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6943
6944
6945 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6946 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
6947 .code
6948 ${lookup ldap
6949 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6950 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6951 {$value}fail}
6952 .endd
6953 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
6954 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
6955 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
6956 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
6957
6958 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
6959 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
6960 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
6961
6962 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
6963 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
6964 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
6965 quoting has two advantages:
6966
6967 .ilist
6968 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
6969 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
6970 .next
6971 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
6972 .endlist
6973
6974 For example, a setting such as
6975 .code
6976 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
6977 .endd
6978 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
6979
6980 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
6981 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
6982 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
6983 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
6984 .code
6985 PASS=${quote:$3}
6986 .endd
6987 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
6988 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
6989 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6990
6991
6992
6993 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
6994 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
6995 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
6996 as a sequence of values, for example
6997 .code
6998 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
6999 .endd
7000 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7001 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7002 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7003 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7004 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7005 directory.
7006
7007 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7008 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7009 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7010
7011 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7012 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7013 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7014 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7015 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7016 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7017 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7018
7019 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7020 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7021 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7022 .code
7023 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7024 value1.1, value1.2
7025
7026 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7027 value two
7028
7029 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7030 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7031
7032 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7033 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7034 .endd
7035 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7036 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7037 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7038 results of LDAP lookups.
7039
7040
7041
7042
7043 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7044 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7045 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7046 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7047 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7048 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7049 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7050 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7051 .code
7052 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7053 .endd
7054 might return the string
7055 .code
7056 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7057 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7058 .endd
7059 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7060 .code
7061 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7062 .endd
7063 would just return
7064 .code
7065 Martin Guerre
7066 .endd
7067 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7068 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7069 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7070
7071
7072
7073 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7074 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7075 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7076 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7077 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7078 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7079 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7080 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7081 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7082 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7083 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7084 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7085 might be
7086 .code
7087 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7088 {$value}fail}
7089 .endd
7090 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7091 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7092 .code
7093 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7094 {$value}}
7095 .endd
7096 might be
7097 .code
7098 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7099 .endd
7100 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7101 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7102 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7103 .code
7104 Mister X
7105 .endd
7106 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7107 with a newline between the data for each row.
7108
7109
7110 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7111 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7112 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7113 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7114 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7115 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7116 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7117 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7118 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7119 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7120 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7121 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7122 information.
7123 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7124 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7125 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7126 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7127 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7128 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7129 .code
7130 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7131 .endd
7132 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7133 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7134 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7135 .code
7136 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7137 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7138 .endd
7139 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7140 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7141 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7142 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7143 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7144 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7145
7146 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7147 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7148 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7149 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7150 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7151 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7152 characters are not special.
7153
7154 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7155 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7156 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7157 done by starting the query with
7158 .display
7159 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7160 .endd
7161 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7162 .olist
7163 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7164 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7165 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7166 taken from there.
7167 .next
7168 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7169 .endlist
7170 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7171 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7172 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7173
7174 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7175 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7176 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7177 like this:
7178 .code
7179 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7180 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7181 master/db/name/pw
7182 .endd
7183 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7184 .code
7185 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7186 .endd
7187 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7188 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7189 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7190 .code
7191 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7192 .endd
7193
7194
7195 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7196 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7197 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7198 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7199 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7200 .display
7201 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7202 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7203 .endd
7204 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7205 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7206
7207 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7208 the queries.
7209
7210 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7211 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7212
7213 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7214 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7215 is zero because no rows are affected.
7216
7217
7218 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7219 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7220 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7221 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7222 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7223 looks like this:
7224 .code
7225 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7226 .endd
7227 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7228 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7229 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7230
7231 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7232 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7233 affected.
7234
7235 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7236 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7237 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7238 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7239 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7240 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7241 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7242 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7243 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7244 .code
7245 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7246 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7247 .endd
7248 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7249 .code
7250 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7251 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7252 .endd
7253 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7254 quote, which it doubles.
7255
7256 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7257 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7258 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7259 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7260 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7261 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7262 option.
7263 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7264 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7265
7266
7267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7268 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7269
7270 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7271 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7272 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7273 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7274 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7275 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7276 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7277 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7278 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7279
7280 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7281 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7282 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7283 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7284
7285
7286
7287 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7288 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7289 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7290 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7291 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7292 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7293 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7294 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7295
7296
7297 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7298 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7299 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7300
7301 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7302 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7303 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7304 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7305 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7306 .code
7307 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7308 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7309 .endd
7310 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7311 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7312 senders based on the receiving domain.
7313
7314
7315
7316
7317 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7318 .cindex "list" "negation"
7319 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7320 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7321 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7322 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7323 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7324 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7325
7326 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7327 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7328 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7329 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7330 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7331 .code
7332 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7333 .endd
7334 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7335 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7336 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7337 .code
7338 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7339 .endd
7340 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7341 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7342 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7343
7344 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7345 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7346 item.
7347
7348
7349
7350 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7351 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7352 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7353 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7354 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7355 file names are not allowed,
7356 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7357 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7358 lines:
7359
7360 .ilist
7361 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7362 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7363 .next
7364 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7365 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7366 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7367 .code
7368 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7369 .endd
7370 .endlist
7371
7372 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7373 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7374 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7375 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7376
7377 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7378 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7379 .code
7380 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7381 .endd
7382 and the file contains the lines
7383 .code
7384 !a.b.c
7385 *.b.c
7386 .endd
7387 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7388 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7389
7390
7391
7392 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7393 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7394 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7395 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7396 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7397 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7398 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7399 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7400
7401 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7402 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7403 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7404 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7405
7406
7407
7408
7409 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7410 .cindex "named lists"
7411 .cindex "list" "named"
7412 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7413 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7414 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7415 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7416 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7417 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7418 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7419 .code
7420 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7421 .endd
7422 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7423 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7424 configured with the line
7425 .code
7426 domains = +local_domains
7427 .endd
7428 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7429 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7430 .code
7431 dnslookup:
7432 driver = dnslookup
7433 domains = ! +local_domains
7434 transport = remote_smtp
7435 no_more
7436 .endd
7437 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7438 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7439 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7440 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7441 .code
7442 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7443 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7444 .endd
7445 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7446 .code
7447 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7448 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7449 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7450 .endd
7451 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7452 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7453 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7454 .code
7455 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7456 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7457 .endd
7458 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7459 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7460 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7461 .code
7462 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7463 .endd
7464 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7465 referenced lists if you can.
7466
7467 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7468 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7469 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7470 .code
7471 domains = +local_domains
7472 .endd
7473 on several of your routers
7474 or in several ACL statements,
7475 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7476 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7477 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7478 the same each time they are referenced.
7479
7480 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7481 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7482 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7483 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7484
7485
7486
7487 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7488 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7489 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7490 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7491 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7492 write
7493 .code
7494 ALIST = host1 : host2
7495 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7496 .endd
7497 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7498 .code
7499 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7500 .endd
7501 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7502 list, and write
7503 .code
7504 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7505 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7506 .endd
7507 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7508 .code
7509 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7510 .endd
7511
7512
7513 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7514 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7515 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7516 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7517 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7518 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7519 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7520 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7521 message. For example:
7522 .code
7523 domainlist special_domains = \
7524 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7525 .endd
7526 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7527 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7528 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7529 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7530 same list each time.
7531
7532 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7533 cache the result anyway. For example:
7534 .code
7535 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7536 .endd
7537 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7538 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7539
7540
7541
7542 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7543 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7544 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7545 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7546 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7547
7548 .ilist
7549 .cindex "primary host name"
7550 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7551 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7552 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7553 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7554 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7555 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7556 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7557 differ only in their names.
7558 .next
7559 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7560 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7561 .cindex "domain literal"
7562 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7563 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7564 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7565 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7566 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7567 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7568 .next
7569 .cindex "@mx_any"
7570 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7571 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7572 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7573 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7574 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7575 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7576 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7577 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7578 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7579 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7580 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7581
7582 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7583 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7584 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7585 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7586 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7587
7588 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7589 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7590 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7591 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7592 on a router). For example:
7593 .code
7594 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7595 .endd
7596 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7597 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7598
7599 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7600 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7601 contain negative items.
7602
7603 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7604 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7605 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7606 .code
7607 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7608 an.other.domain : ...
7609 .endd
7610 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7611 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7612 .code
7613 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7614 an.other.domain ? ...
7615 .endd
7616 .next
7617 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7618 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7619 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7620 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7621 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7622 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7623 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7624 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7625 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7626 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
7627
7628 .next
7629 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7630 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7631 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7632 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7633 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7634 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7635 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7636 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7637 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7638
7639 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7640 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7641 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7642 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7643 expression by expansion, of course).
7644 .next
7645 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7646 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7647 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7648 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7649 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7650 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7651 .code
7652 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7653 .endd
7654 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7655 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7656 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7657 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7658 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7659 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7660 other statements in the same ACL.
7661
7662 .next
7663 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7664 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7665 .code
7666 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7667 .endd
7668 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7669 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7670
7671 .next
7672 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7673 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7674 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7675 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7676 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7677 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7678 expansion variable.
7679 .next
7680 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7681 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7682 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7683 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7684 .code
7685 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7686 where domain = '$domain';
7687 .endd
7688 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7689 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7690 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7691 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7692 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7693 .next
7694 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7695 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7696 between the pattern and the domain.
7697 .endlist
7698
7699 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7700 .code
7701 domainlist funny_domains = \
7702 @ : \
7703 lib.unseen.edu : \
7704 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7705 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7706 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7707 nis;domains.byname : \
7708 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7709 .endd
7710 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7711 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7712 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7713 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7714 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7715 patterns earlier.
7716
7717
7718
7719 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7720 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7721 .cindex "list" "host list"
7722 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7723 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7724 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7725 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7726 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7727 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7728 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7729
7730
7731 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7732 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7733 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7734 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7735 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7736 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7737 not used.
7738
7739 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7740 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7741 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7742
7743
7744
7745 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7746 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7747 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7748 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7749 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7750 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7751 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7752 concerns.)
7753
7754 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7755 inspecting its IP address:
7756
7757 .ilist
7758 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7759 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7760 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7761 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7762 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7763 with the IP address of the subject host.
7764
7765 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7766 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7767 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7768 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7769 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7770
7771 .next
7772 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7773 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7774 domain name, as just described.
7775
7776 .next
7777 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7778 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7779 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7780 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7781 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7782 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7783 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7784 that can never match a client host.
7785
7786 .next
7787 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7788 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7789 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7790 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7791 .code
7792 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7793 accept hosts = @[]
7794 .endd
7795 .next
7796 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7797 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7798 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7799 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7800 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7801 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7802 significant end of the address.
7803
7804 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7805 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7806 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7807 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7808 .code
7809 192.168.23.236/31
7810 .endd
7811 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7812 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7813 matches.
7814
7815 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7816 .code
7817 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7818 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7819 .endd
7820 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7821 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7822 For example:
7823 .code
7824 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7825 .endd
7826 could make use of a file containing
7827 .code
7828 172.16.0.0/12
7829 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7830 .endd
7831 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7832 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7833 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7834 .code
7835 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7836 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7837 .endd
7838 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7839 list.
7840 .endlist
7841
7842
7843
7844 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7845 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7846 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7847 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7848 address, the pattern takes this form:
7849 .display
7850 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7851 .endd
7852 For example:
7853 .code
7854 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7855 .endd
7856 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7857 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7858 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7859 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
7860 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7861 returned by the lookup is not used.
7862
7863 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
7864 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
7865 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7866 patterns of this form:
7867 .display
7868 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7869 .endd
7870 For example:
7871 .code
7872 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7873 .endd
7874 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
7875 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7876 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7877 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7878 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
7879
7880 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
7881 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
7882 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
7883 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
7884 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
7885 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
7886 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
7887 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
7888 addresses are always used.
7889
7890 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
7891 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
7892 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
7893 configurations.
7894
7895 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
7896 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
7897 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7898 case the IP address is used on its own.
7899
7900
7901
7902 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
7903 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
7904 .cindex "unknown host name"
7905 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
7906 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7907 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7908 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7909 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
7910 above.)
7911
7912 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7913 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7914 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7915 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7916 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7917 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7918 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7919
7920 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7921 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7922
7923 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7924 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
7925 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7926 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
7927 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
7928 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
7929 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
7930 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
7931 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
7932
7933 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7934 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7935
7936 .cindex "host" "alias for"
7937 .cindex "alias for host"
7938 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7939 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7940
7941 .ilist
7942 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7943 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
7944 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
7945 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7946 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7947 expression.
7948 .next
7949 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
7950 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
7951 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7952 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
7953 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
7954 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
7955 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
7956 example,
7957 .code
7958 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
7959 .endd
7960 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
7961 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
7962 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
7963 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
7964 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
7965 .code
7966 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
7967 .endd
7968 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
7969 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
7970 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
7971 required.
7972 .endlist
7973
7974
7975
7976
7977 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
7978 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
7979 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
7980 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
7981 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
7982 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
7983
7984 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
7985 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
7986
7987 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
7988 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
7989 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
7990 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
7991 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
7992 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
7993
7994 .ilist
7995 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
7996 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
7997 .code
7998 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
7999 .endd
8000 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8001 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8002
8003 .next
8004 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8005 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8006 example:
8007 .code
8008 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8009 192.168.4.5
8010 .endd
8011 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8012 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8013 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8014 .endlist
8015
8016 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8017 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8018 list.
8019
8020
8021 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8022 "SECTtemdnserr"
8023 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8024 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8025 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8026 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8027 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8028 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8029 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8030 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8031 host lists such as whitelists.
8032
8033
8034
8035 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8036 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8037 .cindex "unknown host name"
8038 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8039 If a pattern is of the form
8040 .display
8041 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8042 .endd
8043 for example
8044 .code
8045 dbm;/host/accept/list
8046 .endd
8047 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8048 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8049 is not used.
8050
8051 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8052 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8053 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8054 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8055 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8056 lookup, both using the same file.
8057
8058
8059
8060 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8061 If a pattern is of the form
8062 .display
8063 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8064 .endd
8065 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8066 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8067 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8068 .code
8069 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8070 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8071 .endd
8072 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8073 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8074 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8075 operator.
8076
8077 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8078 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8079 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8080
8081 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8082 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8083 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8084 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8085 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8086 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8087
8088
8089
8090 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8091 "SECTmixwilhos"
8092 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8093 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8094 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8095 ACL you could have:
8096 .code
8097 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8098 .endd
8099 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8100 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8101 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8102 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8103 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8104 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8105
8106 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8107 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8108 .code
8109 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8110 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8111 .endd
8112 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8113 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8114
8115
8116
8117
8118
8119 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8120 .cindex "list" "address list"
8121 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8122 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8123 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8124 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8125 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8126 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8127 using this option setting:
8128 .code
8129 senders = :
8130 .endd
8131 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8132 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8133 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8134 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8135
8136 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8137 example:
8138 .code
8139 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8140 .endd
8141 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8142 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8143 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8144 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8145 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8146 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8147 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8148 .code
8149 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8150 *@+hostile_domains:\
8151 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8152 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8153 .endd
8154 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8155 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8156 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8157 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8158 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8159
8160 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8161 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8162 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8163 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8164 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8165 .code
8166 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8167 .endd
8168
8169 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8170 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8171 senders:
8172
8173 .ilist
8174 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8175 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8176 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8177 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8178 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8179 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8180 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8181 .code
8182 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8183 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8184 .endd
8185 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8186 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8187
8188 .next
8189 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8190 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8191 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8192 example:
8193 .code
8194 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8195 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8196 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8197 .endd
8198 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8199 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8200 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8201 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8202
8203 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8204 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8205 panic log.
8206 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8207 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8208 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8209 default. For example, with this lookup:
8210 .code
8211 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8212 .endd
8213 the file could contains lines like this:
8214 .code
8215 user1@domain1.example
8216 *@domain2.example
8217 .endd
8218 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8219 that are tried is:
8220 .code
8221 nimrod@jaeger.example
8222 *@jaeger.example
8223 *
8224 .endd
8225 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8226 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8227
8228 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8229 .code
8230 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8231 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8232 .endd
8233 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8234 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8235 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8236 .endlist
8237
8238
8239 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8240 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8241 always fails.
8242
8243
8244 .ilist
8245 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8246 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8247 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8248 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8249 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8250 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8251 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8252 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8253 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8254
8255 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8256 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8257 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8258 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8259 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8260 with
8261 .code
8262 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8263 .endd
8264 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8265 .code
8266 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8267 .endd
8268 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8269
8270 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8271 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8272 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8273 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8274 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8275 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8276 .code
8277 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8278 spammer3 : spammer4
8279 .endd
8280 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8281 doubling.
8282
8283 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8284 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8285 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8286 might have entries like
8287 .code
8288 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8289 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8290 *: ^\d{8}$
8291 .endd
8292 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8293 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8294 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8295 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8296
8297 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8298 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8299 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8300
8301 .next
8302 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8303 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8304 can only return a single list of local parts.
8305 .endlist
8306
8307 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8308 in these two examples:
8309 .code
8310 senders = +my_list
8311 senders = *@+my_list
8312 .endd
8313 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8314 example it is a named domain list.
8315
8316
8317
8318
8319 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8320 .cindex "case of local parts"
8321 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8322 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8323 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8324 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8325 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8326 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8327 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8328 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8329 default.
8330
8331 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8332 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8333 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8334 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8335 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8336 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8337 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8338 case-independent.
8339
8340 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8341 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8342 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8343 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8344 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8345 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8346 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8347 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8348
8349
8350
8351 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8352 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8353 .cindex "local part" "list"
8354 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8355 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8356 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8357 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8358 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8359 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8360 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8361 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8362
8363 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8364 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8365 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8366 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8367 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8368 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8369 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8370 types.
8371 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8372
8373
8374
8375
8376 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8377 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8378
8379 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8380 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8381 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8382 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8383
8384 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8385 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8386 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8387 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8388 escape character, as described in the following section.
8389
8390
8391
8392 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8393 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8394 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8395 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8396 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8397 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8398 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8399 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8400
8401 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8402 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8403 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8404 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8405 .code
8406 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8407 .endd
8408 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8409 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8410 string.
8411
8412
8413
8414 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8415 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8416 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8417 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8418 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8419 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8420 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8421 encoding.
8422
8423 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8424 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8425 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8426
8427
8428 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8429 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8430 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8431 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8432 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8433 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8434 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8435 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8436 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8437 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8438 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8439 and &%nhash%&.
8440
8441 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8442 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8443 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8444
8445 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8446 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8447 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8448 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8449 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8450 .code
8451 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8452 .endd
8453 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8454 Exim message identifier. For example:
8455 .code
8456 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8457 .endd
8458 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8459 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8460
8461
8462 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8463 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8464 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8465 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8466 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8467 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8468 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8469 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8470 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8471 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8472 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8473 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8474 being expanded.
8475
8476
8477
8478
8479 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8480 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8481 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8482 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8483 white space is significant.
8484
8485 .vlist
8486 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8487 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8488 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8489 .code
8490 $local_part
8491 ${domain}
8492 .endd
8493 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8494 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8495 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8496 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8497 given, the expansion fails.
8498
8499 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8500 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8501 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8502 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8503 .code
8504 ${lc:$local_part}
8505 .endd
8506 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8507 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8508 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8509 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8510 string easier to understand.
8511
8512 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8513 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8514 expansion item below.
8515
8516 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8517 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8518 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
8519 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8520 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8521 .code
8522 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8523 .endd
8524 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8525 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8526 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8527
8528 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8529 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8530 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8531 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8532 must have the following type:
8533 .code
8534 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8535 .endd
8536 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8537 function should return one of the following values:
8538
8539 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8540 into the expanded string that is being built.
8541
8542 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8543 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8544
8545 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8546 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8547
8548 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8549
8550 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8551 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8552 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8553
8554 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8555 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8556 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8557 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8558 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8559 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8560 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8561 form:
8562 .display
8563 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8564 .endd
8565 .vindex "&$value$&"
8566 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8567 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8568 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8569 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8570 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8571 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8572 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8573 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8574 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8575
8576 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8577 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8578 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8579 yield &"2001"&:
8580 .code
8581 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8582 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8583 .endd
8584 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8585 appear, for example:
8586 .code
8587 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8588 .endd
8589 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8590 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8591
8592
8593 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8594 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8595 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8596 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8597 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8598 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8599 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8600 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8601 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8602 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8603 <&'string3'&> as before.
8604
8605 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8606 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8607 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8608 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8609 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8610 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8611 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8612 provided. For example:
8613 .code
8614 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8615 .endd
8616 yields &"42"&, and
8617 .code
8618 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8619 .endd
8620 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8621 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8622
8623
8624 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8625 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8626 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8627 .vindex "&$item$&"
8628 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8629 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8630 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8631 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8632 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8633 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8634 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8635 .code
8636 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8637 .endd
8638 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8639 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8640
8641
8642 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8643 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8644 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8645 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8646 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8647 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8648
8649 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8650 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8651 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8652 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8653 .code
8654 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8655 .endd
8656 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8657 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8658 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8659 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8660 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8661 .code
8662 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8663 .endd
8664 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8665 letters appear. For example:
8666 .display
8667 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8668 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8669 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8670 .endd
8671
8672 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8673 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8674 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8675 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8676 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8677 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8678 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8679 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8680 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8681 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8682 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8683 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8684 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8685 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8686 .code
8687 $header_reply-to:
8688 .endd
8689 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8690 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8691 lines) may be present.
8692
8693 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8694 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8695
8696 .ilist
8697 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8698 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8699 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8700
8701 .next
8702 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8703 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8704 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8705 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8706 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8707 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8708 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8709 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8710
8711 .next
8712 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8713 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8714 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8715 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8716 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8717 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8718 .endlist ilist
8719
8720 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8721 command of the following form:
8722 .code
8723 headers charset "UTF-8"
8724 .endd
8725 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8726 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8727 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8728 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8729 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8730 ISO-8859-1.
8731
8732 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8733 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8734 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8735 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8736
8737 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8738 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8739 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8740 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8741 router or transport are not accessible.
8742
8743 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8744 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8745 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8746 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8747 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8748 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8749
8750 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8751 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8752 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8753 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8754 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8755 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8756 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8757
8758 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8759 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8760 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8761 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8762 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8763 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8764 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8765 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8766
8767
8768 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8769 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8770 .cindex &%hmac%&
8771 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8772 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8773 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8774 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8775 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8776 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8777 present. For example:
8778 .code
8779 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8780 .endd
8781 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8782 produces:
8783 .code
8784 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8785 .endd
8786 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8787 an Exim configuration:
8788 .code
8789 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8790 .endd
8791 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8792 .code
8793 headers_add = \
8794 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8795 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8796 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8797 .endd
8798 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8799 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8800 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8801 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8802 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8803 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8804
8805
8806 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8807 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8808 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8809 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8810 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8811 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8812 .code
8813 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8814 .endd
8815 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8816 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8817 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8818 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8819 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8820
8821 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8822 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8823 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8824 .code
8825 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8826 .endd
8827 you can use
8828 .code
8829 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8830 .endd
8831
8832 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8833 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8834 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8835 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8836 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8837 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8838 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8839 some of the braces:
8840 .code
8841 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8842 .endd
8843 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8844 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8845 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8846
8847
8848 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8849 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8850 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8851 described in the next item.
8852
8853 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
8854 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8855 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
8856 .cindex "file" "lookups"
8857 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
8858 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8859 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
8860 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
8861 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
8862
8863 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8864 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
8865 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8866 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8867 out by the system administrator.
8868
8869 .vindex "&$value$&"
8870 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8871 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
8872 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8873 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
8874 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8875 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8876 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8877 original lookup fails.
8878
8879 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
8880 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
8881 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
8882 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
8883 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
8884 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
8885 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
8886 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
8887
8888 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
8889 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
8890 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8891 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
8892
8893 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
8894 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
8895 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8896 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8897
8898 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8899 .code
8900 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8901 .endd
8902 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8903 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8904 .code
8905 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8906 {$value}fail}
8907 .endd
8908
8909
8910 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8911 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
8912 .vindex "&$item$&"
8913 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8914 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8915 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
8916 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
8917 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
8918 setting is not included in the output. For example:
8919 .code
8920 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
8921 .endd
8922 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
8923 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
8924 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8925
8926 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8927 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
8928 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
8929 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8930 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
8931 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
8932 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8933 .code
8934 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8935 .endd
8936 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8937 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8938 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8939 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
8940 example,
8941 .code
8942 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8943 .endd
8944 returns the string &"6/33"&.
8945
8946
8947
8948 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
8949 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
8950 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
8951 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8952 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8953 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
8954 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
8955 name of the subroutine, is nine.
8956
8957 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
8958 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
8959 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
8960 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
8961 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
8962 not its contents.
8963
8964 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
8965 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
8966 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
8967
8968 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
8969 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8970
8971
8972 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
8973 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
8974 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
8975 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
8976 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
8977 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
8978 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
8979 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
8980
8981 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
8982 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
8983 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
8984 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
8985 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
8986 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
8987 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
8988 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
8989 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
8990 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
8991
8992 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
8993 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
8994 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
8995 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
8996
8997 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
8998 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
8999 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9000 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9001 is the expansion of the third argument.
9002
9003 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9004 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9005 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9006
9007 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9008 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9009 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9010 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9011 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9012 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9013 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9014 newlines are left in the string.
9015 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9016 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9017 the string expansion fails.
9018
9019 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9020 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9021
9022
9023
9024 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9025 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9026 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9027 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9028 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9029 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9030 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9031 examples:
9032 .code
9033 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9034 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9035 .endd
9036 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9037 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9038 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9039 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9040 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9041 example:
9042 .code
9043 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9044 .endd
9045 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9046 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9047 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9048 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9049 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9050 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9051 .code
9052 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9053 .endd
9054 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9055 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9056 turns them into spaces:
9057 .code
9058 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9059 .endd
9060 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9061 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9062 addition, the following errors can occur:
9063
9064 .ilist
9065 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9066 .next
9067 Failure to connect the socket;
9068 .next
9069 Failure to write the request string;
9070 .next
9071 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9072 .endlist
9073
9074 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9075 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9076 errors occurs. For example:
9077 .code
9078 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9079 {socket failure}}
9080 .endd
9081 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9082 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9083 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9084 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9085 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9086
9087 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9088 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9089
9090
9091 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9092 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9093 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9094 .vindex "&$value$&"
9095 .vindex "&$item$&"
9096 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9097 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9098 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9099 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9100 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9101 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9102 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9103 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9104 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9105 .code
9106 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9107 .endd
9108 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9109 can be found:
9110 .code
9111 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9112 .endd
9113 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9114 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9115 expansion items.
9116
9117 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9118 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9119 expansion item above.
9120
9121 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9122 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9123 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9124 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9125 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9126 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9127 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9128 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9129
9130 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9131 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9132 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9133 .vindex "&$value$&"
9134 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9135 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9136 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9137 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9138 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9139 &$value$&.
9140
9141 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9142 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9143 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9144 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9145
9146 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9147 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9148 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9149 .code
9150 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9151 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9152 ...
9153 endif
9154 .endd
9155 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9156 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9157 commands.
9158
9159 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9160 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9161 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9162 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9163
9164 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9165 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9166
9167
9168 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9169 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9170 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9171 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9172 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9173 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9174 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9175 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9176 .code
9177 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9178 .endd
9179 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9180 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9181 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9182 .code
9183 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9184 .endd
9185 yields &"defabc"&, and
9186 .code
9187 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9188 .endd
9189 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9190 the regular expression from string expansion.
9191
9192
9193
9194 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9195 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9196 .cindex "substring extraction"
9197 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9198 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9199 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9200 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9201 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9202 .code
9203 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9204 .endd
9205 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9206 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9207 omitted.
9208
9209 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9210 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9211 length required. For example
9212 .code
9213 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9214 .endd
9215 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9216 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9217 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9218 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9219
9220 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9221 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9222 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9223 .code
9224 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9225 .endd
9226 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9227 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9228 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9229 .code
9230 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9231 .endd
9232 yields an empty string, but
9233 .code
9234 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9235 .endd
9236 yields &"1"&.
9237
9238 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9239 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9240 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9241 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9242 .code
9243 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9244 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9245 .endd
9246 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9247
9248
9249
9250 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9251 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9252 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9253 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9254 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9255 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9256 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9257 replacement list. For example
9258 .code
9259 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9260 .endd
9261 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9262 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9263 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9264 place.
9265 .endlist
9266
9267
9268
9269 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9270 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9271 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9272 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9273 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9274 following operations can be performed:
9275
9276 .vlist
9277 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9278 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9279 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9280 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9281 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9282 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9283
9284
9285 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9286 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9287 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9288 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9289 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9290 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9291 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9292 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9293 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9294
9295 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9296 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9297 character. For example:
9298 .code
9299 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9300 .endd
9301 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9302 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9303 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9304 processing lists.
9305
9306
9307 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9308 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9309 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9310 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9311 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9312 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9313 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9314 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9315 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9316
9317 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9318 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9319 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9320 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9321 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9322 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9323 string.
9324
9325 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9326 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9327 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9328 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9329 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9330
9331
9332 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9333 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9334 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9335 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9336 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9337 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9338 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9339
9340
9341 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9342 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9343 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9344 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9345 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9346 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9347 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9348 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9349 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9350 C programming language):
9351 .table2 70pt 300pt
9352 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9353 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9354 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9355 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9356 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9357 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9358 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9359 .endtable
9360 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9361 space is permitted before or after operators.
9362
9363 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9364 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9365 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9366 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9367 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9368
9369 A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9370 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9371 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9372
9373 .display
9374 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9375 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9376 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9377 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9378 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9379 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9380 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9381 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9382 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9383 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9384 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9385 .endd
9386
9387 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9388 .code
9389 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9390 condition = \
9391 ${if and { \
9392 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9393 { \
9394 < \
9395 {$recipients_count} \
9396 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9397 } \
9398 }{yes}{no}}
9399 .endd
9400 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9401 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9402
9403
9404 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9405 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9406 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9407 example,
9408 .code
9409 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9410 .endd
9411 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9412 and then re-expands what it has found.
9413
9414
9415 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9416 .cindex "Unicode"
9417 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9418 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9419 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9420 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9421 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9422 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9423 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9424 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9425 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9426
9427 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9428 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9429 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9430 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9431 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9432 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9433 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9434
9435
9436 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9437 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9438 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9439 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9440 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9441 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9442 .code
9443 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9444 .endd
9445 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9446 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9447
9448
9449
9450 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9451 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9452 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9453 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9454 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9455 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9456
9457
9458 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9459 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9460 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9461 .cindex "lower casing"
9462 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9463 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9464 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9465 .code
9466 ${lc:$local_part}
9467 .endd
9468
9469 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9470 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9471 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9472 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9473 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9474 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9475 .code
9476 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9477 .endd
9478 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9479 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9480 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9481
9482
9483 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9484 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9485 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9486 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9487 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9488 empty.
9489
9490
9491 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9492 .cindex "masked IP address"
9493 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9494 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9495 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9496 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9497 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9498 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9499 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9500 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9501 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9502 .code
9503 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9504 .endd
9505 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9506 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9507 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9508 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9509 .code
9510 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9511 .endd
9512 returns the string
9513 .code
9514 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9515 .endd
9516 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9517
9518
9519 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9520 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9521 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9522 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9523 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9524 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9525
9526
9527 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9528 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9529 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9530 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9531 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9532 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9533 .code
9534 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9535 .endd
9536 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9537
9538
9539 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9540 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9541 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9542 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9543 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9544 is an empty string or
9545 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9546 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9547 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9548 respectively For example,
9549 .code
9550 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
9551 .endd
9552 becomes
9553 .code
9554 "ab\"*\"cd"
9555 .endd
9556 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9557 variable or a message header.
9558
9559 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9560 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9561 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9562 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9563 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9564 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9565 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9566
9567
9568 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9569 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9570 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9571 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9572 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9573 .code
9574 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9575 .endd
9576 returns
9577 .code
9578 two%20%5C2A%20two
9579 .endd
9580 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9581 yields an unchanged string.
9582
9583
9584 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9585 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9586 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9587 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9588 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9589 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9590 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9591 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9592 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9593 characters
9594 .code
9595 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9596 .endd
9597 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9598 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9599 characters.
9600
9601
9602 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9603 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9604 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9605 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9606 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9607 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9608 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9609 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9610
9611 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9612 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9613 to use this operator as well.
9614
9615
9616
9617 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9618 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9619 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9620 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9621 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9622 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9623 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9624
9625
9626 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9627 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9628 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9629 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9630 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9631 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9632
9633
9634 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9635 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9636 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9637 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9638 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9639 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9640 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9641 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9642 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9643 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9644 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9645 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9646 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9647
9648 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9649 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9650 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9651
9652 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9653 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9654 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9655 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9656 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9657
9658
9659
9660 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9661 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9662 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9663 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9664 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9665 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9666
9667
9668 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9669 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9670 .cindex "substring extraction"
9671 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9672 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9673 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9674 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9675 .code
9676 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9677 .endd
9678 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9679 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9680
9681 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9682 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9683 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9684 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9685 seconds.
9686
9687 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9688 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9689 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9690 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9691 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9692 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9693 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
9694
9695 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9696 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9697 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9698 .cindex "upper casing"
9699 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9700 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9701 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9702 .endlist
9703
9704
9705
9706
9707
9708
9709 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9710 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9711 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9712 while expanding strings:
9713
9714 .vlist
9715 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9716 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9717 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9718 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9719 condition.
9720
9721 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9722 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9723 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9724 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9725 are:
9726 .display
9727 &`= `& equal
9728 &`== `& equal
9729 &`> `& greater
9730 &`>= `& greater or equal
9731 &`< `& less
9732 &`<= `& less or equal
9733 .endd
9734 For example:
9735 .code
9736 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9737 .endd
9738 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9739 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9740 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9741 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9742 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9743 zero.
9744
9745 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9746 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9747 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9748 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9749 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9750 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9751 false if zero. Leading whitespace is ignored.
9752 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9753
9754 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9755 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9756 For example,
9757 .code
9758 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9759 .endd
9760
9761 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9762 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9763 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9764 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9765 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9766 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9767 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9768 included in the binary.
9769
9770 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9771 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9772 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9773 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9774 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9775 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9776 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9777 string in LDAP form is:
9778 .code
9779 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9780 .endd
9781 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9782 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9783 .code
9784 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9785 .endd
9786 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9787 supported:
9788
9789 .ilist
9790 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9791 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9792 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9793 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9794 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9795 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9796 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9797 comparison fails.
9798
9799 .next
9800 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9801 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9802 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9803 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9804 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9805 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9806
9807 .next
9808 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
9809 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
9810 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9811 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9812 whatever its length.
9813
9814 .next
9815 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
9816 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
9817 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
9818 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9819 .endlist
9820 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
9821 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9822 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
9823 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9824 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
9825 support &[crypt16()]&.
9826
9827 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
9828 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
9829 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
9830 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
9831 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
9832
9833 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
9834 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
9835 Exim is seen as very low priority.
9836
9837 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
9838 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
9839 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
9840 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
9841 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9842
9843 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
9844 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
9845 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
9846 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9847 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
9848 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
9849 .code
9850 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9851 .endd
9852 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
9853 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9854
9855 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
9856 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9857 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
9858 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9859 exists in the message. For example,
9860 .code
9861 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9862 .endd
9863 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
9864 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
9865
9866 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9867 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9868 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9869 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9870 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
9871 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
9872 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9873 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
9874 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
9875
9876 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
9877 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
9878 .cindex "file" "existence test"
9879 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
9880 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9881 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9882 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
9883 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9884
9885 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
9886 .cindex "delivery" "first"
9887 .cindex "first delivery"
9888 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
9889 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
9890 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9891 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9892
9893
9894 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
9895 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
9896 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
9897 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
9898 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
9899 .vindex "&$item$&"
9900 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
9901 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
9902 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
9903 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
9904 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
9905 .ilist
9906 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
9907 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
9908 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
9909 .next
9910 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
9911 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
9912 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
9913 .endlist
9914 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
9915 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
9916 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
9917 list separator is changed to a comma:
9918 .code
9919 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
9920 .endd
9921 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
9922 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
9923
9924
9925 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9926 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9927 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9928 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9929 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
9930 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
9931 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9932 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
9933 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
9934 case-independent.
9935
9936 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9937 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9938 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9939 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9940 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
9941 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
9942 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9943 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
9944 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
9945 case-independent.
9946
9947 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9948 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9949 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9950 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
9951 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
9952 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
9953 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
9954 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
9955 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
9956 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
9957 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
9958
9959 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
9960 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
9961 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
9962 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
9963 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
9964
9965 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
9966 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
9967 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
9968 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
9969 .code
9970 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
9971 .endd
9972 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
9973
9974 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
9975 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
9976 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
9977 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
9978 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
9979 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
9980 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
9981 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
9982 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
9983 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
9984 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
9985 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
9986 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
9987 this can be used.
9988
9989
9990 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9991 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9992 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9993 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9994 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
9995 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
9996 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9997 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
9998 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
9999 case-independent.
10000
10001 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10002 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10003 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10004 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10005 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10006 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10007 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10008 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10009 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10010 case-independent.
10011
10012
10013 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10014 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10015 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10016 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10017 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10018 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10019 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10020 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10021 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10022 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10023 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10024 For example,
10025 .code
10026 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10027 .endd
10028 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10029 backslashes is also required.
10030
10031 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10032 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10033 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10034 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10035 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10036 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10037
10038 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10039 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10040 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10041 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10042 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10043 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10044 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10045 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10046
10047 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10048 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10049 See &*match_local_part*&.
10050
10051 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10052 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10053 See &*match_local_part*&.
10054
10055 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10056 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10057 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10058 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10059 address or an empty string. The second (after expansion) is a restricted host
10060 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10061 .code
10062 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10063 .endd
10064 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10065
10066 .ilist
10067 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10068 .next
10069 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10070 .next
10071 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10072 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10073 in a single test such as
10074 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10075 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10076 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10077 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10078 .code
10079 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10080 .endd
10081 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10082 .next
10083 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10084 .next
10085 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10086 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10087 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10088 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10089 masks. For example:
10090 .code
10091 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10092 .endd
10093 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10094 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10095 address mask, for example:
10096 .code
10097 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10098 .endd
10099 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10100 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10101 .code
10102 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10103 .endd
10104 .endlist ilist
10105
10106 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10107
10108 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10109 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10110 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10111 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10112 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10113 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10114 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10115 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10116 example is:
10117 .code
10118 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10119 .endd
10120 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10121 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10122 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10123 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10124 .code
10125 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10126 .endd
10127 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10128 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10129 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10130 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10131 caselessly.
10132
10133 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10134 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10135 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10136 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10137
10138 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10139 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10140 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10141 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10142 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10143 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10144 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10145 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10146 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10147 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10148 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10149 .code
10150 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10151 .endd
10152 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10153 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10154
10155 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10156 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10157 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10158 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10159 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10160 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10161 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10162
10163 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10164 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10165 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10166 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10167 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10168 .code
10169 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10170 .endd
10171 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10172 .code
10173 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10174 .endd
10175 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10176 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10177 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10178 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10179 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10180 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10181 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10182 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10183
10184
10185 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10186 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10187 .cindex "Cyrus"
10188 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10189 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10190 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10191 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10192 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10193 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10194
10195 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10196 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10197 building Exim. For example:
10198 .code
10199 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10200 .endd
10201 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10202 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10203 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10204 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10205
10206 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10207 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10208 configuration, you might have this:
10209 .code
10210 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10211 .endd
10212 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10213 .code
10214 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10215 .endd
10216 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10217 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10218 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10219 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10220 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10221 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10222
10223
10224 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10225 .cindex "Radius"
10226 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10227 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10228 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10229 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10230 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10231 support.
10232
10233 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10234 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10235 this library, you need to set
10236 .code
10237 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10238 .endd
10239 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10240 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10241 .code
10242 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10243 .endd
10244 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10245 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10246 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10247
10248 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10249 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10250 the authentication is successful. For example:
10251 .code
10252 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10253 .endd
10254
10255
10256 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10257 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10258 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10259 .cindex "Cyrus"
10260 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10261 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10262 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10263 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10264 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10265 by a process that is not running as root.
10266
10267 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10268 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10269 building Exim. For example:
10270 .code
10271 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10272 .endd
10273 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10274 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10275 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10276
10277 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10278 two are mandatory. For example:
10279 .code
10280 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10281 .endd
10282 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10283 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10284 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10285 .endlist vlist
10286
10287
10288
10289 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10290 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10291 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10292 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10293 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10294 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10295 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10296
10297
10298 .vlist
10299 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10300 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10301 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10302 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10303 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10304 For example,
10305 .code
10306 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10307 .endd
10308 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10309 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10310 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10311
10312 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10313 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10314 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10315 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10316 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10317 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10318 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10319 parsed but not evaluated.
10320 .endlist
10321 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10322
10323
10324
10325
10326 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10327 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10328 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10329 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10330 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10331
10332 .vlist
10333 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10334 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10335 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10336 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10337 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10338 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10339 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10340 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10341 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10342 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10343 matching condition.
10344
10345 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10346 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10347 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10348 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10349 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10350 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10351 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10352 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10353 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10354 during subsequent delivery.
10355
10356 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10357 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10358 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10359 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10360 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10361 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10362 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10363 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10364 delivery.
10365
10366 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10367 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10368 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10369 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10370 be preserved by coding like this:
10371 .code
10372 warn !verify = sender
10373 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10374 .endd
10375 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10376 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10377 failure.
10378
10379 .vitem &$address_data$&
10380 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10381 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10382 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10383 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10384 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10385 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10386 user filter files.
10387
10388 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10389 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10390 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10391 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10392 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10393 from the child's routing.
10394
10395 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10396 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10397 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10398 address.
10399
10400 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10401 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10402 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10403
10404 .vitem &$address_file$&
10405 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10406 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10407 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10408 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10409 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10410 .code
10411 /home/r2d2/savemail
10412 .endd
10413 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10414 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10415 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10416 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10417 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10418 to the relevant file.
10419
10420 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10421 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10422 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10423 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10424
10425 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10426 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10427 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10428 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10429
10430 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10431 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10432 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10433 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10434 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10435 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10436 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10437 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10438 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10439 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10440 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10441 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10442 command line option.
10443
10444
10445
10446
10447 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10448 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10449 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10450 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10451 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10452 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10453 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10454 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10455 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10456 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10457 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10458
10459 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10460 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10461 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10462 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10463 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10464
10465
10466 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10467 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10468 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10469 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10470 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10471 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10472 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10473 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10474 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10475 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10476 an undefined mechanism.
10477
10478 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10479 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10480 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10481 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10482 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10483 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10484
10485 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10486 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10487 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10488 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10489 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10490 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10491 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
10492
10493 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10494 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10495 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10496 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10497 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10498
10499 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10500 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10501 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10502 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10503 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10504
10505 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10506 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10507 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10508 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10509 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10510 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10511 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10512
10513 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10514 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10515 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10516 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10517 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10518 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10519 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10520
10521 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10522 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10523 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10524
10525 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10526 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10527 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10528 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10529 compilations of the same version of the program.
10530
10531 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10532 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10533 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10534 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10535 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10536
10537 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10538 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10539 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10540 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10541 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10542
10543 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10544 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10545 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10546 &$dnslist_value$&
10547 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10548 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10549 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10550 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10551 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10552 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10553 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10554 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10555 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10556
10557 .vitem &$domain$&
10558 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10559 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10560 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10561 case for &$domain$&.
10562
10563 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10564 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10565 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10566 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10567
10568 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10569 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10570 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10571 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10572 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10573 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10574
10575 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10576 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10577 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10578
10579 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10580
10581 .ilist
10582 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10583 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10584 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10585 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10586 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10587 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10588 the &(smtp)& transport.
10589
10590 .next
10591 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10592 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10593 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10594 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10595
10596 .next
10597 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10598 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10599 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10600 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10601 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10602 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10603
10604 .next
10605 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10606 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10607 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10608 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10609 .endlist
10610
10611
10612 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10613 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10614 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10615 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10616 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10617 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10618 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10619 used.
10620
10621 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10622 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10623 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10624 to nothing.
10625
10626 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10627 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10628 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10629
10630 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10631 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10632 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10633
10634 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10635 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10636 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10637
10638 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10639 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10640 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10641 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10642 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10643
10644 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10645 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10646 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10647 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10648 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10649
10650 .vitem &$home$&
10651 .vindex "&$home$&"
10652 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10653 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10654 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10655 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10656 by a setting on the transport itself.
10657
10658 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10659 of the environment variable HOME.
10660
10661 .vitem &$host$&
10662 .vindex "&$host$&"
10663 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10664 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10665 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10666 to local and remote transports.
10667
10668 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10669 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10670 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10671 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10672 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10673 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10674 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10675 is connected.
10676
10677 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10678 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10679 client is connected.
10680
10681
10682 .vitem &$host_address$&
10683 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10684 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10685 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10686 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10687
10688 .vitem &$host_data$&
10689 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10690 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10691 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10692 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10693 .code
10694 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10695 message = $host_data
10696 .endd
10697 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10698 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10699 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10700 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10701 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10702 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10703 variables is set to &"1"&.
10704
10705 .ilist
10706 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10707 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10708
10709 .next
10710 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10711 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10712 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10713 .endlist ilist
10714
10715 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10716 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10717 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10718 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10719 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10720 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10721 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10722 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10723 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10724 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10725
10726 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10727 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10728 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10729
10730
10731 .vitem &$inode$&
10732 .vindex "&$inode$&"
10733 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10734 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10735 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10736 a unique name for the file.
10737
10738 .vitem &$interface_address$&
10739 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10740 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10741
10742 .vitem &$interface_port$&
10743 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10744 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10745
10746 .vitem &$item$&
10747 .vindex "&$item$&"
10748 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10749 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
10750 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10751 empty.
10752
10753 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
10754 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10755 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10756 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10757 lookup.
10758
10759 .vitem &$load_average$&
10760 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
10761 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10762 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10763 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10764
10765 .vitem &$local_part$&
10766 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
10767 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10768 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
10769 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
10770 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
10771
10772 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10773 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
10774 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
10775 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
10776 once.
10777
10778 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10779 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10780 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
10781 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
10782 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
10783 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
10784
10785 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
10786 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
10787 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
10788 &$address_pipe$&).
10789
10790 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
10791 local part of the recipient address.
10792
10793 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10794 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
10795 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
10796
10797 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
10798 the addresses
10799 .code
10800 "abc:xyz"@test.example
10801 abc\:xyz@test.example
10802 .endd
10803 the value of &$local_part$& is
10804 .code
10805 abc:xyz
10806 .endd
10807 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
10808 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
10809 have:
10810 .code
10811 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
10812 .endd
10813 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
10814 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
10815 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
10816
10817 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
10818 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
10819 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
10820 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
10821 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
10822 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
10823 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
10824
10825 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
10826 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
10827 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
10828 variable expands to nothing.
10829
10830 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
10831 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10832 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10833 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10834 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10835
10836 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
10837 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10838 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10839 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10840 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10841
10842 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
10843 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
10844 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
10845 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
10846
10847 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
10848 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
10849 See &$local_user_uid$&.
10850
10851 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
10852 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
10853 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
10854 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
10855 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
10856 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
10857 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
10858 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
10859
10860 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
10861 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
10862 This contains the expanded value of the
10863 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
10864 been read.
10865
10866 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
10867 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
10868 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10869 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
10870 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10871 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
10872
10873 .vitem &$log_space$&
10874 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
10875 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
10876 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
10877 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
10878 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
10879 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
10880
10881
10882 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
10883 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
10884 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
10885 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
10886 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
10887 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
10888 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
10889 variable is empty.
10890
10891 .vitem &$malware_name$&
10892 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
10893 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10894 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
10895 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
10896
10897 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
10898 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
10899 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
10900 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
10901 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
10902 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
10903 character(s).
10904
10905 .vitem &$message_age$&
10906 .cindex "message" "age of"
10907 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
10908 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
10909 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
10910 delivery attempt.
10911
10912 .vitem &$message_body$&
10913 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10914 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10915 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10916 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
10917 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
10918 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
10919 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
10920 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
10921 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
10922
10923 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
10924 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
10925 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
10926 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
10927 zeros are always converted into spaces.
10928
10929 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
10930 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10931 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10932 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
10933 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
10934 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
10935 &$message_body$&.
10936
10937 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
10938 .cindex "body of message" "size"
10939 .cindex "message body" "size"
10940 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
10941 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
10942 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
10943 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
10944 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
10945
10946 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
10947 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
10948 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10949 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
10950 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
10951 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
10952 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
10953 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
10954
10955 .vitem &$message_headers$&
10956 .vindex &$message_headers$&
10957 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
10958 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
10959 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
10960 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
10961
10962 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
10963 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
10964 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
10965 contents of header lines is done.
10966
10967 .vitem &$message_id$&
10968 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
10969
10970 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
10971 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
10972 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
10973 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
10974 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
10975 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
10976 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
10977 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
10978 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
10979 from the body is not counted. Here is an example of the use of this variable in
10980 a DATA ACL:
10981 .code
10982 deny message = Too many lines in message header
10983 condition = \
10984 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
10985 .endd
10986 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
10987 message has not yet been received.
10988
10989 .vitem &$message_size$&
10990 .cindex "size" "of message"
10991 .cindex "message" "size"
10992 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
10993 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
10994 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
10995 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
10996 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
10997 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
10998 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
10999 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11000 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11001
11002 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11003 While running an ACL at the time of an SMTP RCPT command, &$message_size$&
11004 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11005 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11006
11007 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11008 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11009 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11010 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11011
11012 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11013 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11014 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11015
11016 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11017 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11018 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11019 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11020 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11021 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11022 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11023 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11024 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11025 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11026
11027 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11028 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11029 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11030
11031 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11032 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11033 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11034 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11035 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11036 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11037 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11038 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11039 the original address.
11040
11041 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11042 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11043 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11044 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11045 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11046
11047 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11048 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11049 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11050
11051 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11052 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11053 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11054 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11055 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11056 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11057 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11058 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11059 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11060
11061 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11062 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11063 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11064 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11065 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11066 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11067 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11068 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11069 user.
11070
11071 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11072 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11073 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11074 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11075
11076 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11077 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11078 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11079 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11080
11081 .vitem &$pid$&
11082 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11083 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11084 This variable contains the current process id.
11085
11086 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11087 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11088 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11089 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11090 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11091 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11092 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11093 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11094 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11095 variable"& error if encountered.
11096
11097 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11098 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11099 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11100 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11101 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11102 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11103 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11104
11105
11106 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11107 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11108 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11109 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11110
11111 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11112 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11113 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11114 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11115
11116 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11117 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11118 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11119 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11120
11121 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11122 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11123 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11124
11125 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11126 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11127 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11128 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11129
11130 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11131 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11132 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11133 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11134 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11135
11136 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11137 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11138 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11139 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11140 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11141 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11142
11143 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11144 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11145 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11146 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11147 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11148
11149 .vitem &$received_count$&
11150 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11151 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11152 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11153 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11154 delivering.
11155
11156 .vitem &$received_for$&
11157 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11158 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11159 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11160 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11161 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11162
11163 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11164 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11165 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11166 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11167 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11168 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11169 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11170 option.
11171
11172 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11173 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11174 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11175 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11176 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11177 time.
11178
11179 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11180 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11181 &(smtp)& transport).
11182
11183 .vitem &$received_port$&
11184 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11185 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11186
11187 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11188 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11189 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11190 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11191 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11192 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11193 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11194 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11195 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11196
11197 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11198 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11199 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11200 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11201 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11202 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11203
11204 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11205 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11206 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11207
11208 .vitem &$received_time$&
11209 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11210 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11211 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11212
11213 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11214 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11215 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11216 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11217 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11218 .display
11219 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11220 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11221 .endd
11222 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11223 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11224 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11225 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11226
11227 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11228 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11229 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11230 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11231
11232 .ilist
11233 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11234 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11235
11236 .next
11237 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11238
11239 .next
11240 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11241 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11242 MAIL).
11243
11244 .next
11245 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11246 .next
11247
11248 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11249 .endlist
11250
11251 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11252 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11253
11254 .vitem &$recipients$&
11255 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11256 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11257 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11258 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11259 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11260 cases:
11261
11262 .olist
11263 In a system filter file.
11264 .next
11265 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11266 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11267 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11268 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11269 .next
11270 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11271 .endlist
11272
11273
11274 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11275 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11276 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11277 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11278 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11279 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11280
11281
11282 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11283 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11284 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11285 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11286
11287
11288 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11289 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11290 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11291 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11292 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11293 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11294 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11295
11296 .vitem &$return_path$&
11297 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11298 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11299 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11300 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11301 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11302 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11303 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11304 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11305 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11306 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11307 envelope sender.
11308
11309 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11310 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11311 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11312
11313 .vitem &$runrc$&
11314 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11315 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11316 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11317 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11318 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11319 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11320 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11321 another.
11322
11323 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11324 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11325 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11326 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11327 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11328 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11329 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11330 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11331
11332 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11333 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11334 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11335 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11336 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11337 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11338
11339 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11340 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11341 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11342 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11343 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11344 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11345 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11346 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11347
11348 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11349 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11350 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11351
11352 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11353 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11354 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11355
11356 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11357 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11358 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11359 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11360 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11361 this:
11362 .display
11363 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11364 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11365 .endd
11366 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11367 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11368 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11369 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11370
11371 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11372 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11373 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11374 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11375 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11376 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11377 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11378 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11379 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11380 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11381 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11382 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11383 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11384
11385 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11386 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11387 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11388 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11389 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11390 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11391
11392 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11393 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11394 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11395 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11396
11397 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11398 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11399 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11400 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11401 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11402 &$authenticated_id$&.
11403
11404 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11405 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11406 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11407 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11408 other means, this variable is empty.
11409
11410 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11411 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11412 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11413 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11414 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11415 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11416 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11417
11418 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11419 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11420 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11421 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11422
11423 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11424 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11425 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11426 is set to &"1"&.
11427
11428 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11429 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11430 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11431 following are true:
11432
11433 .ilist
11434 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11435 .next
11436 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11437 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11438 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11439 .next
11440 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11441 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11442 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11443 .next
11444 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11445 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11446 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11447 .next
11448 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11449 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11450 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11451 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11452 .code
11453 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11454 .endd
11455 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11456 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11457 .endlist
11458
11459
11460 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11461 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11462 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11463 number that was used on the remote host.
11464
11465 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11466 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11467 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11468 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11469 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11470 called Exim.
11471
11472 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11473 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11474 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11475 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11476
11477 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11478 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11479 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11480 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11481 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11482 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11483 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11484 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11485 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11486 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11487 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11488 the parentheses.
11489
11490 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11491 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11492 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11493 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11494 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11495
11496 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11497 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11498 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11499 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11500 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11501
11502 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11503 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11504 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11505 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11506 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11507 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11508 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11509
11510 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11511 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11512 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11513 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11514 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11515
11516 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11517 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11518 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11519 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11520 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11521 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11522
11523 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11524 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11525 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11526 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11527 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11528 .code
11529 MAIL FROM:<>
11530 MAIL FROM: <>
11531 .endd
11532 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11533 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11534 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11535 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11536
11537 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11538 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11539 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11540 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11541 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11542 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11543 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11544
11545 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11546 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11547 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11548 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11549 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11550 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11551 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11552 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11553 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11554 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11555 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11556
11557 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11558 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11559 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11560 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11561 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11562 message is junk mail.
11563
11564 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11565 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11566 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11567 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11568
11569
11570 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11571 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11572 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11573
11574 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11575 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11576 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11577 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11578 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11579 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11580
11581 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11582 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11583 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11584 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11585 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11586 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11587 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11588 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11589 .code
11590 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11591 .endd
11592 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11593
11594
11595 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11596 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11597 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11598 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11599 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11600 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11601
11602 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11603 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11604 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11605 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11606
11607 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11608 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11609 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11610 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11611 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11612 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11613 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11614 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11615
11616 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11617 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11618 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11619 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11620 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11621 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11622
11623 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11624 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11625 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11626 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11627 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11628 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11629 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11630 deliveries.
11631
11632 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11633 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11634 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11635 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11636
11637 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11638 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11639 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11640
11641 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11642 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11643 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11644 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11645 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11646 values for those that are behind (west).
11647
11648 .vitem &$tod_log$&
11649 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11650 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11651 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11652
11653 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11654 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11655 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11656 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11657 flag.
11658
11659 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11660 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11661 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11662 -0500.
11663
11664 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11665 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11666 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11667 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11668
11669 .vitem &$value$&
11670 .vindex "&$value$&"
11671 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11672 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11673 &*reduce*& expansion.
11674
11675 .vitem &$version_number$&
11676 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11677 The version number of Exim.
11678
11679 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11680 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11681 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11682 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11683
11684 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11685 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11686 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11687 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11688 .endlist
11689 .ecindex IIDstrexp
11690
11691
11692
11693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11694 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11695
11696 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11697 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11698 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11699 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11700 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11701 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11702 the line
11703 .code
11704 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
11705 .endd
11706 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11707
11708
11709 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11710 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11711 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11712 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11713 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11714 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11715 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11716 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11717 a newly created Perl interpreter.
11718
11719 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11720 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11721 should usually be something like
11722 .code
11723 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11724 .endd
11725 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11726 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11727 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11728 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11729 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11730 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11731 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11732 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11733 two ways:
11734
11735 .ilist
11736 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11737 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11738 a startup when Exim is entered.
11739 .next
11740 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11741 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11742 .endlist
11743
11744 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11745 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11746
11747
11748 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11749 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11750 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11751 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
11752 forms:
11753 .code
11754 ${perl{foo}}
11755 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
11756 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
11757 .endd
11758 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
11759 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
11760 with an error message of the form
11761 .code
11762 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
11763 .endd
11764 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
11765 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
11766 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
11767 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
11768 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
11769 that was passed to &%die%&.
11770
11771
11772 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
11773 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
11774 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
11775 the Perl code
11776 .code
11777 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
11778 .endd
11779 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
11780 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
11781 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
11782
11783 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
11784 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
11785 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
11786 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
11787
11788 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
11789 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
11790 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
11791 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
11792 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
11793 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
11794 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
11795
11796
11797 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
11798 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
11799 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
11800 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
11801 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
11802 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
11803 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
11804 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
11805 avoided, but the output is lost.
11806
11807 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
11808 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
11809 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
11810 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
11811 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
11812 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
11813 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
11814 .code
11815 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
11816 .endd
11817 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
11818 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
11819 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
11820 as the first subroutine argument.
11821 .ecindex IIDperl
11822
11823
11824 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11825 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11826
11827 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
11828 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
11829 "Starting the daemon"
11830 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
11831 .cindex "interface" "listening"
11832 .cindex "network interface"
11833 .cindex "interface" "network"
11834 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
11835 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
11836 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
11837 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
11838 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
11839 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
11840 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
11841 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
11842 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
11843 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
11844 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
11845
11846 .olist
11847 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
11848 and ports to listen on.
11849 .next
11850 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
11851 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
11852 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
11853 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
11854 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
11855 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
11856 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
11857 as an error situation.
11858 .next
11859 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
11860 for the outgoing connection.
11861 .endlist
11862
11863
11864 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
11865 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
11866 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
11867 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
11868 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
11869
11870 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
11871 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
11872 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
11873 chapter describes how they operate.
11874
11875 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
11876 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
11877
11878
11879
11880 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
11881 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
11882 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
11883 following options:
11884
11885 .ilist
11886 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
11887 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
11888 .next
11889 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
11890 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
11891 .endlist
11892
11893 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
11894 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
11895 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
11896 colons. For example:
11897 .code
11898 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
11899 192.168.23.65 ; \
11900 ::1 ; \
11901 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
11902 .endd
11903 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
11904 in &%local_interfaces%&:
11905
11906 .olist
11907 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
11908 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
11909 .code
11910 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
11911 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
11912 .endd
11913 .next
11914 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
11915 with a colon separator, for example:
11916 .code
11917 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
11918 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
11919 .endd
11920 .endlist
11921
11922 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
11923 default setting contains just one port:
11924 .code
11925 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
11926 .endd
11927 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
11928 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
11929 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
11930 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
11931 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
11932
11933
11934
11935 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
11936 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
11937 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
11938 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
11939 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
11940 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11941 .code
11942 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
11943 .endd
11944 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
11945 .code
11946 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
11947 .endd
11948 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
11949
11950
11951
11952 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
11953 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
11954 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
11955 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
11956 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
11957 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
11958 exim.
11959
11960 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
11961 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
11962 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
11963 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
11964 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11965 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
11966 .code
11967 -oX 1225
11968 .endd
11969 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
11970 whereas
11971 .code
11972 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
11973 .endd
11974 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
11975 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
11976 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
11977
11978
11979
11980 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
11981 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
11982 .cindex "smtps protocol"
11983 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
11984 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
11985 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
11986 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
11987 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
11988 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
11989 common use of this option is expected to be
11990 .code
11991 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
11992 .endd
11993 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
11994 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
11995 this way when a daemon is started.
11996
11997 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
11998 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
11999 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12000 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12001 connections via the daemon.)
12002
12003
12004
12005
12006 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12007 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12008 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12009 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12010 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12011 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12012 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12013 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12014 .code
12015 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12016 .endd
12017 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12018 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12019 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12020 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12021 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12022 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12023 .code
12024 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12025 .endd
12026 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12027 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12028 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12029 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12030 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12031
12032 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12033 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12034 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12035 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12036 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12037 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12038 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12039 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12040 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12041 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12042 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12043 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12044
12045 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12046 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12047 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12048 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12049 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12050
12051
12052
12053 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12054 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12055 .code
12056 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12057 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12058 .endd
12059 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12060 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12061 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12062 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12063
12064 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12065 .code
12066 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12067 .endd
12068 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12069 .code
12070 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12071 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12072 .endd
12073 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12074 IPv4 loopback address only:
12075 .code
12076 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12077 .endd
12078 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12079 .code
12080 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12081 .endd
12082 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12083
12084
12085
12086 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12087 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12088 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12089 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12090 treated as local.
12091
12092 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12093 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12094 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12095 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12096
12097 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12098 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12099 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12100 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12101 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12102 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12103 used for listening. Consider this example:
12104 .code
12105 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12106 192.168.53.235 ; \
12107 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12108
12109 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12110 .endd
12111 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12112 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12113 Exim is routing.
12114
12115 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12116 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12117 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12118 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12119 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12120 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12121 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12122 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12123
12124
12125
12126 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12127 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12128 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12129 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12130 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12131 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12132 details.
12133
12134
12135
12136
12137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12138 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12139
12140 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12141 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12142 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12143 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12144
12145 .ilist
12146 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12147 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12148 .next
12149 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12150 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12151 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12152 .next
12153 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12154 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12155 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12156 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12157 settings.
12158 .endlist
12159
12160 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12161 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12162 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12163 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12164 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12165 listed in more than one group.
12166
12167 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12168 .table2
12169 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12170 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12171 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12172 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12173 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12174 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12175 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12176 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12177 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12178 .endtable
12179
12180
12181 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12182 .table2
12183 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12184 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12185 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12186 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12187 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12188 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12189 .endtable
12190
12191
12192
12193 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12194 .table2
12195 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12196 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12197 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12198 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12199 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12200 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12201 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12202 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12203 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12204 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12205 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12206 .endtable
12207
12208
12209
12210 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12211 .table2
12212 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12213 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12214 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12215 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12216 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12217 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12218 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12219 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12220 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12221 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12222 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12223 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12224 .endtable
12225
12226
12227
12228 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12229 .table2
12230 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12231 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12232 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12233 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12234 .endtable
12235
12236
12237
12238 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12239 .table2
12240 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12241 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12242 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12243 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12244 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12245 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12246 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12247 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12248 .endtable
12249
12250
12251
12252 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12253 .table2
12254 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12255 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12256 .endtable
12257
12258
12259
12260 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12261 .table2
12262 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12263 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12264 .endtable
12265
12266
12267
12268 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12269 .table2
12270 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12271 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12272 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12273 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12274 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12275 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12276 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12277 .endtable
12278
12279
12280
12281 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12282 .table2
12283 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12284 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12285 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12286 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12287 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12288 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12289 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12290 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12291 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12292 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12293 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12294 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12295 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12296 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12297 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12298 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12299 connection"
12300 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12301 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12302 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12303 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12304 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12305 .endtable
12306
12307
12308
12309 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12310 .table2
12311 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12312 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12313 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12314 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12315 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12316 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12317 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12318 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12319 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12320 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12321 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12322 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12323 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12324 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12325 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12326 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12327 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12328 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12329 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12330 words""&"
12331 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12332 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12333 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12334 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12335 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12336 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12337 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12338 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12339 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12340 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12341 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12342 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12343 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12344 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12345 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12346 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12347 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12348 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12349 .endtable
12350
12351
12352
12353 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12354 .table2
12355 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12356 item"
12357 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12358 item"
12359 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12360 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12361 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12362 .endtable
12363
12364
12365
12366 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12367 .table2
12368 .row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12369 .row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12370 .row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12371 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12372 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12373 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12374 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12375 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12376 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12377 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12378 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12379 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12380 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12381 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12382 .endtable
12383
12384
12385
12386 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12387 .table2
12388 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12389 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12390 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12391 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12392 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12393 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12394 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12395 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12396 .endtable
12397
12398
12399
12400 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12401 .table2
12402 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12403 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12404 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12405 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12406 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12407 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12408 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12409 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12410 .endtable
12411
12412
12413
12414
12415 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12416 .table2
12417 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12418 .endtable
12419
12420
12421
12422
12423
12424 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12425 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12426
12427 .table2
12428 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12429 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12430 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12431 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12432 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12433 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12434 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12435 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12436 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12437 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12438 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12439 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12440 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12441 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12442 connection"
12443 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12444 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12445 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12446 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12447 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12448 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12449 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12450 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12451 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12452 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12453 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12454 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12455 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12456 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12457 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12458 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12459 .endtable
12460
12461
12462
12463 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12464 .table2
12465 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12466 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12467 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12468 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12469 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12470 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12471 .endtable
12472
12473
12474
12475 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12476 .table2
12477 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12478 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12479 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12480 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12481 words""&"
12482 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12483 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12484 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12485 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12486 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12487 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12488 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12489 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12490 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12491 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12492 .endtable
12493
12494
12495
12496 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12497 .table2
12498 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12499 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12500 directory"
12501 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12502 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12503 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12504 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12505 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12506 .endtable
12507
12508
12509
12510 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12511 .table2
12512 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12513 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12514 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12515 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12516 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12517 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12518 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12519 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12520 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12521 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12522 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12523 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12524 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12525 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12526 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12527 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12528 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12529 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12530 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12531 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12532 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12533 .endtable
12534
12535
12536
12537 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12538 .table2
12539 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12540 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12541 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12542 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12543 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12544 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12545 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12546 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12547 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12548 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12549 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12550 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12551 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12552 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12553 .endtable
12554
12555
12556
12557 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12558 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12559 &dagger;.
12560
12561 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12562 .cindex "8BITMIME"
12563 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12564 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12565 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12566 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12567 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12568 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12569
12570 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12571 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12572 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12573 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12574 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12575 further details.
12576
12577 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12578 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12579 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12580 SMTP messages.
12581
12582 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12583 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12584 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12585 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12586 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12587
12588 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12589 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12590 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12591 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12592 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12593
12594 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12595 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12596 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12597 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12598
12599 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12600 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12601 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12602 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12603 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12604
12605 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12606 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12607 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12608 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12609
12610 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12611 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12612 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12613 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12614
12615 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12616 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12617 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12618 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12619 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12620
12621
12622 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12623 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12624 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12625 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12626
12627 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12628 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12629 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12630 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12631 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12632
12633 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12634 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12635 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12636 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12637 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12638
12639 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12640 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12641 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12642 further details.
12643
12644 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12645 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12646 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12647 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12648
12649 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12650 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12651 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12652 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12653
12654 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12655 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12656 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12657 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12658
12659 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12660 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12661 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12662 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12663
12664 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12665 .cindex "admin user"
12666 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12667 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12668 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12669 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12670 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12671 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12672 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12673
12674 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12675 .cindex "domain literal"
12676 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12677 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12678 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12679 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12680
12681 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12682 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12683 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12684 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12685 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12686 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12687 the local host's IP addresses.
12688
12689
12690 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12691 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12692 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12693 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12694 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12695 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12696 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12697 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12698 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12699
12700 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12701 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12702 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12703 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12704 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12705 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12706 experiment if they wish.
12707
12708 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12709 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12710 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12711 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12712 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12713 suitable setting is:
12714 .code
12715 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12716 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12717 .endd
12718 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12719 .code
12720 dns_check_names_pattern =
12721 .endd
12722 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12723
12724
12725 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12726 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12727 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12728 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12729 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12730 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12731 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12732 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12733 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12734 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12735 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12736
12737 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12738 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12739 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12740 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
12741 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
12742 which Exim advertises AUTH.
12743
12744 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
12745 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
12746 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
12747 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
12748 .code
12749 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
12750 .endd
12751 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12752 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
12753 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
12754 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
12755
12756
12757 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
12758 .cindex "thawing messages"
12759 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
12760 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
12761 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
12762 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
12763 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
12764 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
12765
12766 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
12767 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
12768 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
12769
12770 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
12771 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
12772 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
12773 .code
12774 sophie:/var/run/sophie
12775 .endd
12776 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
12777 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
12778
12779
12780
12781 .option bi_command main string unset
12782 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
12783 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
12784 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
12785 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
12786 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
12787
12788
12789 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
12790 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
12791 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
12792 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
12793 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
12794 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
12795
12796
12797 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
12798 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
12799 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
12800 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
12801
12802 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
12803 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
12804 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
12805 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
12806 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
12807 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
12808 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
12809 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
12810 point at which the error was detected are returned.
12811 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
12812
12813 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
12814 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
12815 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
12816 &%bounce_return_body%&.
12817
12818
12819 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
12820 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
12821 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
12822 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
12823 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
12824 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
12825 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
12826 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
12827 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
12828
12829 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
12830 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
12831 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
12832 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
12833 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
12834 messages.
12835
12836 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
12837 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
12838 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
12839 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
12840 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
12841 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
12842 connection. A typical setting might be:
12843 .code
12844 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12845 .endd
12846 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
12847 .code
12848 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12849 .endd
12850 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
12851 address.
12852
12853 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
12854 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
12855 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
12856 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
12857 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12858 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12859
12860
12861 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
12862 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
12863 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12864 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12865
12866
12867 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
12868 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
12869 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12870 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12871
12872
12873 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
12874 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
12875 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12876 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12877
12878
12879 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
12880 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
12881 callout verification. The default value is
12882 .code
12883 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
12884 .endd
12885 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
12886
12887
12888 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
12889 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12890
12891
12892 .option check_log_space main integer 0
12893 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12894
12895 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
12896 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
12897 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
12898 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
12899 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
12900 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
12901 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
12902 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
12903 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
12904 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
12905
12906
12907 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
12908 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12909
12910
12911 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
12912 .cindex "checking disk space"
12913 .cindex "disk space, checking"
12914 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
12915 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
12916 message is accepted.
12917
12918 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12919 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12920 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12921 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12922 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
12923 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
12924 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
12925 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
12926
12927
12928 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
12929 either value is greater than zero, for example:
12930 .code
12931 check_spool_space = 10M
12932 check_spool_inodes = 100
12933 .endd
12934 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
12935 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
12936 transit.
12937
12938 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
12939 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
12940 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
12941
12942 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
12943 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
12944 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
12945 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
12946 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
12947 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
12948
12949 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
12950 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
12951
12952 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
12953 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
12954 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
12955
12956 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
12957 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
12958 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12959 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
12960 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
12961 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
12962
12963 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
12964 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
12965 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
12966 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
12967 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
12968 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
12969 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
12970
12971 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
12972 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
12973
12974 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
12975 .cindex "warning of delay"
12976 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
12977 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
12978 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
12979 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
12980 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
12981 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
12982 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
12983 with
12984 .code
12985 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
12986 .endd
12987 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
12988 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
12989 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
12990 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
12991 .code
12992 delay_warning = 6h
12993 .endd
12994 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
12995 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
12996 .code
12997 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
12998 .endd
12999
13000 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13001 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13002 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13003 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13004 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13005 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13006 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13007 not sent. The default is:
13008 .code
13009 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13010 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13011 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13012 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13013 } {no}{yes}}
13014 .endd
13015 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13016 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13017 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13018 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13019
13020 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13021 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13022 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13023 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13024 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13025 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13026 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13027 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13028
13029 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13030 .cindex "load average"
13031 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13032 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13033 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13034 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13035 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13036
13037
13038 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13039 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13040 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13041 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13042 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13043 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13044 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13045 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13046
13047 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13048 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13049 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13050 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13051 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13052 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13053 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13054 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13055
13056 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13057 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13058 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13059 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13060
13061
13062 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13063 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13064 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13065 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13066 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13067 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13068 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13069
13070
13071 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13072 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13073 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13074 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13075 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13076 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13077 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13078 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13079 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13080 by a setting such as this:
13081 .code
13082 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13083 .endd
13084 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13085 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13086 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13087 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13088 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13089 options are applied after this global option.
13090
13091 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13092 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13093 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13094 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13095 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13096 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13097 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13098 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13099 value of this option. The default pattern is
13100 .code
13101 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13102 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13103 .endd
13104 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13105 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13106 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13107 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13108 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13109 empty string.
13110
13111 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13112 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13113 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13114
13115 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13116 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13117 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13118 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13119
13120 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13121 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13122 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13123 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13124 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13125 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13126 domain matches this list.
13127
13128 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13129 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13130 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13131
13132
13133 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13134 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13135 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13136 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13137 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13138 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13139 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13140 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13141 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13142 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13143 to set in them.
13144
13145
13146 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13147 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13148
13149
13150 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13151 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13152 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13153 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13154
13155 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13156 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13157 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13158 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13159 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13160 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13161 .code
13162 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13163 .endd
13164 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13165 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13166
13167 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13168 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13169 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13170 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13171 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13172 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13173 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13174 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13175 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13176
13177
13178 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13179 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13180 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13181 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13182 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13183 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13184 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13185 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13186 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13187
13188 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13189 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13190 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13191 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13192 are examined. For example:
13193 .code
13194 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13195 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13196 postmaster@mydomain.example
13197 .endd
13198 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13199 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13200 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13201 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13202 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13203 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13204 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13205
13206
13207 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13208 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13209 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13210 .display
13211 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13212 .endd
13213 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13214 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13215 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13216 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13217 overrides the default.
13218
13219 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13220 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13221 and warning messages. For example:
13222 .code
13223 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13224 .endd
13225 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13226 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13227 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13228 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13229 not used.
13230
13231
13232 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13233 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13234 .cindex "Exim group"
13235 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13236 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13237 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13238 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13239 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13240 security issues.
13241
13242
13243 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13244 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13245 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13246 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13247 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13248 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13249 other place.
13250 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13251 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13252 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13253 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13254
13255
13256 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13257 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13258 .cindex "Exim user"
13259 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13260 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13261 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13262 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13263
13264 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13265 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13266 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13267 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13268
13269
13270 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13271 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13272 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13273 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13274
13275
13276 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13277 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13278
13279 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13280 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13281 .oindex "&%-t%&"
13282 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13283 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13284 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13285 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13286 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13287 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13288 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13289 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13290 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13291 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13292 addresses.
13293
13294
13295 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13296 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13297 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13298 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13299 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13300 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13301 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13302 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13303 retries.
13304
13305 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13306 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13307 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13308 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13309
13310
13311
13312 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13313 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13314 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13315 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13316 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13317 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13318 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13319 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13320 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13321 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13322 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13323 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13324 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13325 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13326 logging that you require.
13327
13328
13329 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13330 .cindex "HP-UX"
13331 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13332 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13333 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13334 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13335 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13336 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13337 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13338 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13339
13340 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13341 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13342 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13343 user's name.
13344
13345 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13346 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13347 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13348 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13349 .code
13350 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13351 gecos_name = $1
13352 .endd
13353
13354 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13355 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13356
13357
13358 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13359 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13360 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13361
13362 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13363 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13364 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13365
13366 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13367 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13368 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13369
13370
13371 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13372 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13373 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13374 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13375 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13376 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13377
13378
13379
13380 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13381 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13382 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13383 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13384 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13385 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13386 sections are rejected.
13387
13388
13389 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13390 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13391 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13392 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13393 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13394 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13395 zero means &"no limit"&.
13396
13397
13398
13399
13400 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13401 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13402 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13403 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13404 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13405 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13406 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13407 if you want to do semantic checking.
13408 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13409 set.
13410
13411
13412 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13413 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13414 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13415 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13416 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13417 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13418 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13419 .code
13420 helo_allow_chars = _
13421 .endd
13422 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13423
13424
13425 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13426 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13427 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13428 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13429 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13430 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13431 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13432 do.
13433
13434
13435 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13436 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13437 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13438 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13439 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13440 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13441 condition &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13442 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13443 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13444 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is
13445 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13446 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13447
13448 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13449 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13450 EHLO command either:
13451
13452 .ilist
13453 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13454 .next
13455 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13456 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13457 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13458 calling host address, or
13459 .next
13460 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13461 available) yields the calling host address.
13462 .endlist
13463
13464 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13465 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13466 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& condition.
13467
13468 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13469 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13470 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13471 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13472 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13473 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13474 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13475 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13476 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13477 error.
13478
13479 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13480 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13481 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13482 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13483 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13484 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13485 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13486 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13487 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13488
13489 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13490 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13491 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13492 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13493 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13494
13495 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13496 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13497 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13498 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13499
13500
13501 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13502 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13503 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13504 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13505 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13506 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13507 default configuration file contains
13508 .code
13509 host_lookup = *
13510 .endd
13511 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13512 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13513
13514 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13515 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13516 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13517
13518 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13519 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13520 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13521 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13522 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and &`verify`& &`=`&
13523 &`reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13524
13525
13526 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13527 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13528 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13529 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13530 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13531 if you want.
13532
13533 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13534 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13535 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13536 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13537
13538
13539
13540 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13541 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13542 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13543 as soon as the connection is made.
13544 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13545 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13546 connections immediately.
13547
13548 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13549 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13550 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13551 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13552 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13553
13554
13555 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13556 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13557 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13558 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13559 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13560 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13561 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13562 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13563 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13564 .code
13565 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13566 .endd
13567 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13568
13569
13570
13571 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13572 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13573 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13574 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13575 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13576 records
13577 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13578 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13579
13580 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13581 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13582 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13583 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13584 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13585 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13586 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13587
13588
13589 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13590 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13591 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13592 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13593 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13594
13595
13596
13597 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13598 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13599 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13600 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13601 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13602 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13603
13604 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13605 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13606 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13607 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13608 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13609 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13610 for frozen messages. For example,
13611 .code
13612 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13613 .endd
13614 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13615 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13616 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13617 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13618 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13619 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13620
13621
13622 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13623 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13624 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13625 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13626 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13627 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13628 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13629 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13630 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13631 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13632
13633
13634 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13635 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13636
13637
13638 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13639 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13640 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13641 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13642 logged.
13643
13644
13645 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13646 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13647 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13648 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13649 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13650 with LDAP support.
13651
13652
13653 .option ldap_version main integer unset
13654 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13655 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13656 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13657 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13658 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13659 has been built with LDAP support.
13660
13661
13662
13663 .option local_from_check main boolean true
13664 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
13665 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
13666 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13667 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
13668 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
13669 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
13670
13671 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
13672 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
13673 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
13674
13675 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
13676 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
13677 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
13678 and the default qualify domain.
13679
13680 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
13681 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
13682 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
13683 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
13684
13685 .cindex "envelope sender"
13686 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
13687 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
13688 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
13689
13690 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
13691 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
13692 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13693
13694
13695
13696
13697 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
13698 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
13699 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
13700 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
13701 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
13702 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
13703 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
13704 example, if
13705 .code
13706 local_from_prefix = *-
13707 .endd
13708 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
13709 .code
13710 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
13711 .endd
13712 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
13713 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
13714 qualify domain.
13715
13716
13717 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
13718 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
13719
13720
13721 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
13722 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
13723 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
13724 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
13725 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
13726 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
13727 &%local_interfaces%& is
13728 .code
13729 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13730 .endd
13731 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
13732 .code
13733 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13734 .endd
13735
13736 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
13737 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
13738 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
13739 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
13740 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
13741 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
13742 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
13743 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
13744
13745
13746
13747 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
13748 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
13749 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13750 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
13751 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
13752 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
13753 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
13754 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13755
13756
13757
13758
13759 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
13760 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
13761 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
13762 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13763 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
13764 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
13765 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
13766 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
13767 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
13768 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
13769 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
13770 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
13771 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
13772 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
13773 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
13774
13775
13776
13777 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
13778 .cindex "log" "file path for"
13779 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
13780 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
13781 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
13782 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
13783 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
13784 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
13785 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
13786 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
13787 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
13788 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
13789 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
13790 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
13791
13792
13793 .option log_selector main string unset
13794 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13795 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
13796 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
13797 minus characters. For example:
13798 .code
13799 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
13800 .endd
13801 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
13802 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
13803
13804
13805 .option log_timezone main boolean false
13806 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
13807 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13808 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13809 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
13810 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
13811 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
13812 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
13813 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
13814 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
13815 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
13816 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
13817 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
13818
13819
13820 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
13821 .cindex "too many open files"
13822 .cindex "open files, too many"
13823 .cindex "file" "too many open"
13824 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
13825 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
13826 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
13827 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
13828 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
13829 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
13830 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
13831 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
13832 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
13833 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
13834 &%lookup_open_max%&.
13835
13836
13837 .option max_username_length main integer 0
13838 .cindex "length of login name"
13839 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
13840 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
13841 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
13842 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
13843 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
13844 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
13845
13846
13847 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
13848 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
13849 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
13850 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13851 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13852 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
13853 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
13854 option is set true, this no longer happens.
13855
13856
13857 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
13858 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
13859 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
13860 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13861 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13862 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
13863 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
13864
13865
13866 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
13867 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
13868 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
13869 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
13870 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
13871 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
13872 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
13873 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
13874 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
13875 empty string, the option is ignored.
13876
13877
13878 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
13879 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
13880 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
13881 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
13882 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
13883 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
13884 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
13885 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
13886 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
13887 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
13888 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
13889 colons will become hyphens.
13890
13891
13892 .option message_logs main boolean true
13893 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
13894 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
13895 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
13896 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
13897 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
13898 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
13899 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
13900 which is not affected by this option.
13901
13902
13903 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
13904 .cindex "message" "size limit"
13905 .cindex "limit" "message size"
13906 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
13907 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
13908 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
13909 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
13910 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
13911 optionally followed by K or M.
13912
13913 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
13914 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
13915 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
13916 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
13917 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
13918
13919 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
13920 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
13921 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
13922 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
13923 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
13924 message that an individual transport can process.
13925
13926
13927 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
13928 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
13929 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
13930 .code
13931 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
13932 .endd
13933 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
13934 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
13935 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
13936 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
13937 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
13938
13939
13940 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
13941 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
13942 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
13943 contains a full description of this facility.
13944
13945
13946
13947 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
13948 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
13949 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
13950 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
13951 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
13952
13953
13954 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
13955 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
13956 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
13957 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
13958 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
13959 safety precaution.
13960
13961 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
13962 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
13963 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
13964 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
13965 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
13966
13967 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
13968 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
13969 example is
13970 .code
13971 never_users = root:daemon:bin
13972 .endd
13973 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
13974 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
13975 transport driver.
13976
13977
13978 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
13979 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
13980 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
13981 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13982 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
13983
13984
13985 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13986 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
13987 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
13988 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
13989 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
13990 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
13991 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
13992 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
13993 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
13994 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
13995 an ACL.
13996
13997 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
13998 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
13999 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14000 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14001 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14002 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14003 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14004
14005
14006 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14007 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14008 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14009
14010
14011 .option perl_startup main string unset
14012 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14013 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14014
14015
14016 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14017 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14018 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14019 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14020 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14021 PostgreSQL support.
14022
14023
14024 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14025 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14026 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14027 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14028 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14029 to the host name:
14030 .code
14031 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14032 .endd
14033 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14034 spool directory.
14035 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14036 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14037 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14038
14039
14040 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14041 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14042 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14043 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14044 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14045 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14046 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14047 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14048 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14049
14050
14051 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14052 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14053 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14054 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14055 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14056 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14057 volume of mail. Use with care!
14058
14059
14060 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14061 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14062 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14063 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14064 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14065 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14066 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14067 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14068 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14069 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14070
14071 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14072 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14073 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14074 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14075 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14076 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14077
14078
14079 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14080 .cindex "printing characters"
14081 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14082 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14083 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14084 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14085 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14086 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14087 characters.
14088
14089 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14090 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14091 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14092 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14093 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14094 standards.
14095
14096
14097 .option process_log_path main string unset
14098 .cindex "process log path"
14099 .cindex "log" "process log"
14100 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14101 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14102 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14103 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14104 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14105 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14106 different spool directories.
14107
14108
14109 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14110 .oindex "&%-M%&"
14111 .oindex "&%-R%&"
14112 .oindex "&%-q%&"
14113 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14114 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14115 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14116
14117
14118 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14119 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14120 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14121 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14122 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14123 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14124 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14125 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14126 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14127
14128 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14129 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14130 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14131 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14132 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14133 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14134 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14135
14136
14137 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14138 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14139 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14140
14141
14142
14143 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14144 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14145 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14146 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14147 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14148 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14149 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14150 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14151
14152
14153 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14154 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
14155 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14156 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14157 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14158
14159
14160 .option queue_only main boolean false
14161 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14162 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14163 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14164 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14165 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14166 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14167
14168 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14169 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14170 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14171 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14172
14173
14174 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14175 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14176 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14177 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14178 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14179 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14180 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14181 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14182 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14183 .code
14184 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14185 .endd
14186 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14187 &_/some/file_& exists.
14188
14189
14190 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14191 .cindex "load average"
14192 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14193 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14194 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14195 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14196 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14197 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14198 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14199 false.
14200
14201 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14202 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14203 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14204 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14205
14206
14207 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14208 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14209 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14210 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14211 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14212 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14213 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14214 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14215 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14216 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14217 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14218 re-evaluated for each message.
14219
14220
14221 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14222 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14223 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14224 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14225 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14226 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14227
14228
14229 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14230 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14231 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14232 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14233 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14234 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14235 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14236 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14237 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14238 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14239 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14240 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14241 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14242
14243
14244
14245 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14246 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14247 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14248 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14249 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14250 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14251 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14252 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14253 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14254
14255 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14256 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14257 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14258 the daemon's command line.
14259
14260 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14261 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14262 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14263 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14264 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14265 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14266 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14267 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14268 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14269 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14270 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14271 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14272 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14273 &%queue_domains%&.
14274
14275
14276 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14277 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14278 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14279 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14280 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14281 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14282 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14283
14284 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14285 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14286 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14287 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14288 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14289 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14290 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14291 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14292 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14293 header lines. The default setting is:
14294
14295 .code
14296 received_header_text = Received: \
14297 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14298 {${if def:sender_ident \
14299 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14300 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14301 by $primary_hostname \
14302 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14303 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14304 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14305 ${if def:sender_address \
14306 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14307 id $message_exim_id\
14308 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14309 .endd
14310
14311 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14312 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14313 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14314 header lines such as the following:
14315 .code
14316 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14317 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14318 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14319 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14320 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14321 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14322 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14323 .endd
14324 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14325 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14326 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14327 message was accepted.
14328
14329
14330 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14331 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14332 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14333 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14334 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14335 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14336 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14337 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14338
14339
14340 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14341 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14342 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14343 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14344 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14345 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14346 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14347 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14348 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14349 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14350 option was not set.
14351
14352
14353 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14354 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14355 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14356 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14357 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14358 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14359 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14360 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14361 done.
14362
14363 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14364 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14365 RCPT commands in a single message.
14366
14367
14368 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14369 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14370 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14371 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14372 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14373 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14374 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14375
14376
14377 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14378 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14379 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14380 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14381 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14382 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14383 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14384 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14385 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14386 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14387 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14388 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14389 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14390 tagged with its process id.
14391
14392 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14393 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14394 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14395 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14396 is received.
14397
14398 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14399 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14400 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14401 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14402 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14403 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14404 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14405 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14406 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14407 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14408 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14409
14410 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14411 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14412 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14413 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14414
14415
14416 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14417 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14418 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14419 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14420 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14421 .code
14422 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14423 .endd
14424 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14425 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14426
14427
14428 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14429 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14430 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14431 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14432 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14433 past failures.
14434
14435
14436 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14437 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14438 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14439 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14440 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14441 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14442 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14443 the default value.
14444
14445
14446 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14447 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14448 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14449 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14450 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14451 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14452 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14453 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14454 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14455 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14456
14457
14458 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14459 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14460
14461
14462 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14463 .cindex "RFC 1413"
14464 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14465 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14466 in the list.
14467
14468 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14469 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14470 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14471 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14472 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14473
14474
14475 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14476 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14477 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14478 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14479 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14480 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14481 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14482 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14483 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14484 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14485
14486
14487 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14488 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14489 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14490 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14491 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14492 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14493 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14494 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14495 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14496 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14497 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14498
14499
14500
14501 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14502 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14503 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14504 .cindex "inetd"
14505 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14506 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14507 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14508 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14509 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14510 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14511
14512 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14513 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14514 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14515 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14516
14517
14518 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14519 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14520 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14521 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14522 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14523 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14524 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14525 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14526
14527 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14528 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14529 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14530 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14531 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14532 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14533 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14534 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14535
14536
14537 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14538 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14539 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14540 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14541 live with.
14542
14543
14544 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14545 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14546
14547 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14548 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14549 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14550 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14551 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14552 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14553 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14554 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14555 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14556 seen).
14557
14558
14559 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14560 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14561 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14562 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14563 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14564 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14565 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14566 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14567 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14568 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14569 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14570
14571 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14572 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14573 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14574 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14575 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14576 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14577
14578
14579
14580 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14581 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14582 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14583 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14584 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14585 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14586 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14587 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14588 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14589 to all messages received in the same connection.
14590
14591 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14592 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14593 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14594 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14595
14596
14597 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14598 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14599
14600 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14601 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14602 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14603 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14604 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14605 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14606 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14607 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14608 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14609 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14610 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14611 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14612 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14613
14614
14615 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14616 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14617 .cindex "host" "reserved"
14618 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14619 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14620 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14621 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14622 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
14623 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
14624 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
14625 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
14626 individual host.
14627
14628 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
14629 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
14630 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
14631 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
14632
14633
14634 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
14635 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
14636 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
14637 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14638 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
14639 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
14640 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
14641 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
14642 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
14643
14644 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
14645 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
14646 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
14647 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
14648
14649 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
14650 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
14651 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
14652 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
14653 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
14654 For example:
14655 .code
14656 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
14657 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
14658 .endd
14659
14660 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
14661 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
14662 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
14663 &%helo_data%& value.
14664
14665 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
14666 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
14667 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
14668 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
14669 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
14670 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
14671 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
14672 .code
14673 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
14674 $version_number $tod_full
14675 .endd
14676 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
14677 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
14678 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
14679 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
14680 multiline response).
14681
14682
14683 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
14684 .cindex "checking disk space"
14685 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14686 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14687 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
14688 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
14689 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
14690 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
14691 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
14692
14693
14694 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
14695 .cindex "connection backlog"
14696 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
14697 .cindex "backlog of connections"
14698 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
14699 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
14700 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
14701 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
14702 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
14703 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14704 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14705 attacks by SYN flooding.
14706
14707
14708 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
14709 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
14710 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
14711 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14712 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14713 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14714 fewer, but they still exist.
14715
14716 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14717 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14718 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
14719 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
14720 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
14721 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
14722 does detect many instances.
14723
14724 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
14725 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
14726 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
14727 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
14728
14729
14730
14731 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
14732 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
14733 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14734 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
14735 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
14736 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
14737 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
14738 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
14739 example:
14740 .code
14741 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
14742 $sender_host_address
14743 .endd
14744 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
14745 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
14746 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
14747 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
14748 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
14749 the command.
14750
14751
14752 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
14753 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
14754 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
14755 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
14756 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
14757
14758
14759 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
14760 .cindex "load average"
14761 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
14762 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
14763 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
14764 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
14765 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
14766 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
14767
14768
14769
14770 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
14771 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
14772 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
14773 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
14774 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
14775 .code
14776 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
14777 .endd
14778 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
14779 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
14780 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
14781 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
14782 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
14783
14784 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
14785 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
14786 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
14787 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
14788 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
14789 not count towards the limit.
14790
14791
14792
14793 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
14794 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
14795 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
14796 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
14797 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
14798 that subvert web
14799 clients
14800 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
14801 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
14802
14803
14804
14805 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14806 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
14807 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
14808 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
14809 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
14810 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
14811 recipients.
14812
14813 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
14814 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
14815 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
14816 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
14817
14818 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
14819 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
14820 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
14821 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
14822 values:
14823
14824 .ilist
14825 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
14826 .next
14827 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
14828 fractional parts are allowed here.
14829 .next
14830 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
14831 .next
14832 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
14833 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
14834 .endlist
14835
14836 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
14837 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
14838 .code
14839 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
14840 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
14841 .endd
14842 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
14843 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
14844 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
14845 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
14846
14847
14848 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
14849 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14850
14851
14852 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
14853 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14854
14855
14856 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
14857 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
14858 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
14859 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
14860 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
14861 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
14862 the message is abandoned.
14863 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
14864 .code
14865 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
14866 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
14867 .endd
14868 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
14869 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
14870
14871
14872 .oindex "&%-os%&"
14873 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
14874 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
14875 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
14876 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
14877 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
14878
14879
14880 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14881 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
14882 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
14883
14884
14885 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
14886 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
14887 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
14888 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
14889 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
14890 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
14891 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
14892 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
14893 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
14894 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
14895 .code
14896 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
14897 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
14898 .endd
14899
14900 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
14901 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
14902 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
14903 The default value is
14904 .code
14905 127.0.0.1 783
14906 .endd
14907 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
14908
14909
14910
14911 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
14912 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
14913 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
14914 .cindex "directories, multiple"
14915 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
14916 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
14917 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
14918 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
14919 arrival of the message.
14920
14921 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
14922 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
14923 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
14924 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
14925 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
14926
14927 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
14928 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
14929 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
14930 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
14931 automatically deleted.
14932
14933 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
14934 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
14935 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
14936 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
14937 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
14938 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
14939 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
14940 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
14941 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
14942
14943
14944 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
14945 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
14946 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
14947 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
14948 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
14949 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
14950 &$primary_hostname$&.
14951
14952 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
14953 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
14954 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
14955 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
14956 as failures in the configuration file.
14957
14958 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
14959 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
14960
14961 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
14962 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
14963 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
14964 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
14965
14966 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
14967 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
14968 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
14969 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
14970 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
14971 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
14972
14973 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
14974 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
14975 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
14976 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
14977 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
14978 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
14979 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
14980
14981
14982 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
14983 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
14984 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
14985 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
14986 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
14987 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
14988 domain causes a syntax error.
14989 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
14990 syntax checking.
14991
14992
14993 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
14994 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
14995 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
14996 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
14997 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
14998 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
14999 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15000 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15001 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15002 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15003 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15004 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15005
15006
15007 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15008 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15009 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15010 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15011 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15012 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15013 details of Exim's logging.
15014
15015
15016
15017 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15018 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15019 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15020 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15021 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15022
15023
15024
15025 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15026 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15027 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15028 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15029 details of Exim's logging.
15030
15031
15032 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15033 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15034 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15035 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15036 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15037 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15038 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15039 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15040 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15041 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15042 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15043
15044
15045 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15046 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15047 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15048 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15049 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15050 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15051
15052
15053 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15054 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15055 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15056 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15057 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15058
15059 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15060 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15061 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15062 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15063 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15064
15065 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15066 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15067 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15068 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15069 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15070 contains the pipe command.
15071
15072
15073 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15074 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15075 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15076 is used in a system filter.
15077
15078 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15079 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15080 If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
15081 process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
15082 process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15083 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15084 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15085 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15086 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15087
15088 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15089 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15090 transport option overrides. Normally you should set &%system_filter_user%& if
15091 your system filter generates these kinds of delivery.
15092
15093
15094 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15095 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15096 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15097 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15098 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15099 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15100 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15101 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15102 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15103 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15104 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15105 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15106 TCP_NODELAY.
15107
15108
15109 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15110 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15111 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15112 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15113 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15114 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15115 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15116 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15117 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15118 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15119
15120 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15121 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15122 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15123
15124
15125 .option timezone main string unset
15126 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15127 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15128 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15129 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15130 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15131 .code
15132 timezone = UTC
15133 .endd
15134 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15135 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15136 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15137 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15138 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15139 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15140
15141
15142 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15143 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15144 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15145 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15146 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15147 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15148 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15149 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15150
15151
15152 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15153 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15154 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15155 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15156 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15157 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15158 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15159
15160 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15161 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15162 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15163 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15164
15165
15166 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15167 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15168 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15169 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15170 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15171
15172
15173 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15174 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15175 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15176 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15177 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15178 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15179
15180
15181 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15182 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15183 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15184 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15185 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15186
15187
15188
15189 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15190 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15191 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15192 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15193 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15194 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15195 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15196
15197
15198 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15199 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15200 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15201 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15202 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15203 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15204 TLS session.
15205
15206
15207 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15208 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15209 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15210 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15211 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15212 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15213 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15214 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15215 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15216 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15217 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15218
15219
15220 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15221 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15222 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15223 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15224
15225
15226 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15227 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15228 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15229 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15230 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15231 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15232 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15233 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15234 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15235
15236
15237 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15238 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15239 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15240 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15241 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15242 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15243 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15244 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15245
15246 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15247 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15248 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15249 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15250 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15251 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15252 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15253
15254 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15255 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15256 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15257 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15258 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15259 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15260 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15261 certificate"&.
15262
15263 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15264 certificates.
15265
15266
15267 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15268 .cindex "trusted groups"
15269 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15270 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15271 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15272 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15273 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15274 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15275 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15276 are trusted.
15277
15278 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15279 .cindex "trusted users"
15280 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15281 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15282 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15283 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15284 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15285 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15286 Exim user are trusted.
15287
15288 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15289 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15290 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15291 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15292 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15293 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15294 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15295 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15296 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15297 &%-F%& option.
15298
15299 .option unknown_username main string unset
15300 See &%unknown_login%&.
15301
15302 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15303 .cindex "trusted users"
15304 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15305 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15306 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15307 .cindex "envelope sender"
15308 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15309 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15310 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15311 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15312 is used) is ignored.
15313
15314 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15315 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15316 .code
15317 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15318 .endd
15319 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15320 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15321 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15322 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15323 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15324 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15325 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15326 followed by a hyphen
15327 by a setting like this:
15328 .code
15329 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15330 .endd
15331 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15332 restriction, you can use
15333 .code
15334 untrusted_set_sender = *
15335 .endd
15336 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15337 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15338 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15339 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15340 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15341 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15342 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15343 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15344
15345 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15346 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15347 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15348 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15349 sender address.
15350
15351
15352 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15353 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15354 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15355 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15356 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15357 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15358 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15359 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15360 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15361 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15362 .code
15363 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15364 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15365 .endd
15366 The pattern can be seen by running
15367 .code
15368 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15369 .endd
15370 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15371 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15372 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15373 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15374 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15375 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15376
15377
15378 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15379 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15380
15381
15382 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15383 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15384 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15385 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15386 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15387 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15388 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15389 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15390
15391
15392 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15393 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15394 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15395 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15396 .ecindex IIDconfima
15397 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15398
15399
15400
15401
15402 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15403 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15404
15405 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15406 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15407 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15408 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15409 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
15410
15411 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15412 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15413 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15414 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15415 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15416
15417
15418
15419 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15420 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15421 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15422 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15423 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15424 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15425 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15426
15427 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15428 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15429 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15430 routers, and the eventual transport.
15431
15432 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15433 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15434 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15435 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15436 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15437
15438 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15439 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15440 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15441 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15442 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15443
15444 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15445 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15446 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15447 .code
15448 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15449 .endd
15450 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15451 .code
15452 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15453 .endd
15454 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15455 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15456
15457 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15458 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15459 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15460 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15461 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15462 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15463 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15464
15465
15466
15467 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15468 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
15469 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15470 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15471 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15472 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15473 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15474 routing.
15475
15476
15477
15478 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15479 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15480 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15481 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15482 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15483 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15484 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15485 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15486 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15487 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15488 you could put:
15489 .code
15490 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15491 .endd
15492 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15493 and
15494 .code
15495 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15496 .endd
15497 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15498 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15499 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15500 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15501
15502
15503 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15504 .cindex "case of local parts"
15505 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15506 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15507 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15508 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15509 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15510 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15511 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15512 more details.
15513
15514 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15515 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15516 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15517 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15518 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15519 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15520 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15521 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15522 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15523
15524 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15525 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15526 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15527 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15528
15529
15530
15531 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15532 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
15533 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15534 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15535 .vindex "&$home$&"
15536 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15537 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15538 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15539 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15540 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15541 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15542 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15543 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15544 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15545 the router is skipped.
15546
15547 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15548 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15549 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15550 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15551 setting to achieve this. For example:
15552 .code
15553 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15554 .endd
15555 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15556 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15557 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15558
15559
15560
15561 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15562 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15563 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15564 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15565 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15566 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15567 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15568 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15569
15570 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15571 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15572
15573 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15574 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15575 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15576 .code
15577 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15578 .endd
15579 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15580 .code
15581 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15582 .endd
15583 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15584 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15585 be specified using &%condition%&.
15586
15587
15588
15589 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15590 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15591 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15592 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15593 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15594 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15595 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15596 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15597 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15598 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15599 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15600 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15601
15602
15603
15604 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
15605 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15606 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15607 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15608 transport option of the same name.
15609
15610
15611 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
15612 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
15613 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
15614 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15615 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15616 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
15617 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
15618 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
15619
15620
15621
15622 .option driver routers string unset
15623 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15624 to be used.
15625
15626
15627
15628 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
15629 .cindex "envelope sender"
15630 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
15631 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
15632 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
15633 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
15634 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
15635 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
15636 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
15637
15638 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15639 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
15640 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
15641 setting.
15642
15643 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15644 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15645 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15646 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15647
15648 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
15649 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
15650 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15651 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
15652 settings:
15653 .code
15654 errors_to =
15655 errors_to = ""
15656 .endd
15657 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15658 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15659 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15660 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
15661 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
15662
15663 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15664 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15665 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15666 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15667 setting &%return_path%&.
15668
15669 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
15670 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
15671 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
15672
15673
15674
15675 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
15676 .cindex "address" "testing"
15677 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
15678 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
15679 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
15680 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15681 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15682 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
15683 on for the system alias file.
15684 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15685 are evaluated.
15686
15687 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15688 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15689 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
15690
15691
15692
15693 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
15694 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
15695 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
15696 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
15697
15698
15699
15700 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
15701 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15702 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
15703
15704
15705
15706 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
15707 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15708 verifying a sender, verification fails.
15709
15710
15711
15712 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
15713 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
15714 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
15715 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
15716 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
15717 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
15718 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
15719 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
15720 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
15721
15722 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
15723 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
15724 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
15725 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
15726 transport for further details.
15727
15728
15729 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
15730 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
15731 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15732 .cindex "transport" "local"
15733 .cindex "router" "setting group"
15734 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15735 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
15736 process.
15737 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15738 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15739 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
15740 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
15741 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15742
15743
15744
15745 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
15746 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
15747 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
15748 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15749 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15750 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15751 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
15752 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
15753 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
15754 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
15755 &"see"& the added header lines.
15756
15757 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
15758 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
15759 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
15760 failures are treated as configuration errors.
15761
15762 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15763 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15764
15765 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
15766 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
15767 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15768 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
15769 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
15770 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
15771 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
15772 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
15773 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
15774 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
15775
15776
15777
15778 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
15779 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
15780 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
15781 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15782 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15783 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15784 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
15785 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
15786 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
15787 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
15788 &"see"& the original header lines.
15789
15790 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
15791 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
15792 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
15793 errors.
15794
15795 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15796 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15797
15798 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15799 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
15800 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
15801 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
15802
15803
15804 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
15805 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
15806 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
15807 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
15808 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
15809 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
15810 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
15811 like
15812 .code
15813 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
15814 .endd
15815 by setting
15816 .code
15817 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
15818 .endd
15819 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
15820 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
15821 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
15822 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
15823 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
15824 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
15825
15826 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
15827 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
15828 .code
15829 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
15830 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
15831 .endd
15832 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
15833 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
15834
15835 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
15836 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
15837 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
15838 domain that is being routed.
15839
15840 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
15841 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
15842 checked.
15843
15844 .option initgroups routers boolean false
15845 .cindex "additional groups"
15846 .cindex "groups" "additional"
15847 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15848 .cindex "transport" "local"
15849 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
15850 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
15851 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
15852 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
15853 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15854
15855
15856
15857 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
15858 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
15859 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
15860 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
15861 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
15862 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
15863 evaluated.
15864
15865 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
15866 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
15867 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
15868 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
15869 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
15870 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
15871 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
15872 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
15873 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
15874
15875 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15876 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
15877 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
15878 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
15879 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
15880 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
15881 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
15882 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
15883 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
15884 the relevant transport.
15885
15886 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
15887 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
15888 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
15889 callout.
15890
15891 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
15892 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
15893 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
15894 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
15895 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
15896 .code
15897 real_localuser:
15898 driver = accept
15899 local_part_prefix = real-
15900 check_local_user
15901 transport = local_delivery
15902 .endd
15903 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
15904 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
15905 .code
15906 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
15907 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
15908 .endd
15909
15910 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
15911 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
15912 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
15913 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
15914
15915
15916 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
15917 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
15918
15919
15920
15921 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
15922 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
15923 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
15924 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
15925 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
15926 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
15927 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
15928 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
15929 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
15930 &%username-foo%&.
15931
15932
15933 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
15934 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
15935
15936
15937
15938 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
15939 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
15940 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
15941 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
15942 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15943 are evaluated, and
15944 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
15945 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
15946 example:
15947 .code
15948 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
15949 .endd
15950 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
15951 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
15952 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
15953 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
15954 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
15955 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
15956 each virtual domain:
15957 .code
15958 postmaster:
15959 driver = redirect
15960 local_parts = postmaster
15961 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
15962 .endd
15963
15964
15965 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
15966 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
15967 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
15968 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
15969 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
15970 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
15971 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
15972 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
15973 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
15974 redirect addresses.
15975
15976
15977
15978 .option more routers boolean&!! true
15979 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
15980 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
15981 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
15982 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
15983 delivery to be deferred.
15984
15985 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
15986 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
15987 .oindex "&%self%&"
15988 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
15989 means of the setting
15990 .code
15991 self = pass
15992 .endd
15993 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
15994 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
15995 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
15996
15997 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
15998 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
15999 controls what happens next.
16000
16001
16002 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16003 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16004 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16005 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16006 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16007 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16008 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16009 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16010
16011 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16012 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16013 applies to all of them.
16014
16015
16016
16017 .option pass_router routers string unset
16018 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16019 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16020 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16021 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16022 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16023 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16024 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16025 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16026 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16027 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16028
16029
16030
16031 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16032 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16033 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16034 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16035 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16036 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16037
16038 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16039 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16040 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16041 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16042
16043
16044
16045 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16046 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16047 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16048 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16049 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16050 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16051 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16052
16053 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16054 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16055 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16056 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16057
16058 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16059 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16060 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16061 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16062 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16063
16064 .cindex "NFS"
16065 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16066 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16067 unavailable.
16068
16069 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16070 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16071 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16072 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16073 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16074 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16075 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16076 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16077
16078 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16079 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16080 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16081 operates as follows:
16082
16083 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16084 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16085 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16086 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16087 used. For example:
16088 .code
16089 require_files = mail:/some/file
16090 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16091 .endd
16092 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16093 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16094
16095 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16096 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16097 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16098 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16099
16100 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16101 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16102 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16103 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16104 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16105
16106 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16107 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16108 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16109 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16110 check again in that process.
16111
16112 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16113 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16114 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16115 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16116 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16117 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16118 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16119 .code
16120 require_files = +/some/file
16121 .endd
16122 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16123 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16124 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16125
16126
16127
16128 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16129 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16130 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16131 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16132 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16133 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16134 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16135 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16136 latter kind.
16137
16138 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16139 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16140 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16141 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16142 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16143 same name.
16144
16145 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16146 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16147 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16148
16149
16150
16151 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16152 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16153 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16154 .vindex "&$home$&"
16155 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16156 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16157 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16158 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16159 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16160 cause the router to defer.
16161
16162 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16163 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16164 place.
16165 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16166 are evaluated.)
16167 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16168 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16169
16170 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16171 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16172 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16173 of these values that is set:
16174
16175 .ilist
16176 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16177 .next
16178 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16179 .next
16180 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16181 .next
16182 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16183 .endlist
16184
16185 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16186 router, but not for the transport.
16187
16188
16189
16190 .option self routers string freeze
16191 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16192 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16193 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16194 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16195 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16196 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16197 of remote hosts.
16198 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16199 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16200 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16201 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16202 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16203
16204 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16205 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16206 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16207 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16208 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16209 cases:
16210
16211 .vlist
16212 .vitem &%defer%&
16213 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16214
16215 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16216 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16217 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16218 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16219
16220 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16221 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16222 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16223 rewritten.
16224
16225 .vitem &%pass%&
16226 .oindex "&%more%&"
16227 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16228 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16229 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16230 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16231 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16232 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16233 combination
16234 .code
16235 self = pass
16236 no_more
16237 .endd
16238 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16239 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16240 be passed to the next router.
16241
16242 .vitem &%fail%&
16243 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16244
16245 .vitem &%send%&
16246 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16247 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16248 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16249 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16250 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16251 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16252 .endlist
16253
16254
16255
16256 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16257 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16258 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16259 address matches something on the list.
16260 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16261 are evaluated.
16262
16263 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16264 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16265 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16266 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16267 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16268 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16269 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16270 matters.
16271
16272
16273 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16274 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16275 .cindex "packet radio"
16276 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16277 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16278 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16279 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16280 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16281 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16282 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16283 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16284
16285 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16286 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16287 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16288 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16289 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16290 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16291 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16292 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16293 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16294 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16295 .code
16296 translate_ip_address = \
16297 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16298 {$value}fail}}
16299 .endd
16300 The file would contain lines like
16301 .code
16302 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16303 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16304 .endd
16305 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16306 are doing.
16307
16308
16309
16310 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16311 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16312 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16313 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16314 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16315 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16316 delivery is deferred.
16317
16318 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16319 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16320 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16321
16322
16323
16324 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16325 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16326 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16327 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16328 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16329 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16330 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16331 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16332 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16333 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16334 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16335 environment.
16336
16337
16338
16339
16340 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16341 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16342 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16343 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16344 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16345 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16346 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16347 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16348 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16349 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16350
16351 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16352 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16353 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16354 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16355 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16356
16357 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16358 environment.
16359
16360
16361
16362
16363 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16364 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16365 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16366 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16367 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16368 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16369 delivery to be deferred.
16370
16371 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16372 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16373 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16374 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16375 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16376 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16377
16378 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16379 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16380 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16381 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16382 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16383 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16384 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16385 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16386
16387 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16388 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16389 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16390 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16391 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16392 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16393 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16394 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16395 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16396 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16397
16398 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16399 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16400 subsequent routers.
16401
16402
16403 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16404 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16405 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16406 .cindex "transport" "local"
16407 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16408 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16409 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16410 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16411 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16412 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16413 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16414 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16415 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16416 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16417 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16418 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16419
16420
16421
16422 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16423 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16424 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16425
16426
16427 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16428 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16429 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
16430 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16431 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16432 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16433 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16434 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16435 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16436
16437 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16438 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16439 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16440 user or group.
16441
16442
16443 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16444 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16445 addresses
16446 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16447 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16448 are evaluated.
16449
16450
16451 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16452 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16453 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16454 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16455 are evaluated.
16456 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16457 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16458
16459
16460
16461
16462
16463
16464 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16465 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16466
16467 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16468 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16469 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16470 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16471 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16472 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16473 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16474 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16475 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16476 .code
16477 localusers:
16478 driver = accept
16479 domains = mydomain.example
16480 check_local_user
16481 transport = local_delivery
16482 .endd
16483 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16484 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16485 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16486 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16487
16488
16489
16490
16491
16492
16493 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16494 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16495
16496 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16497 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16498 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16499 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16500 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16501 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16502
16503 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16504 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16505 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16506 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16507 records.
16508
16509 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16510 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16511 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16512 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16513 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16514 generic option, the router declines.
16515
16516 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16517 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16518 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16519
16520 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16521 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16522 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16523 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16524 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16525 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16526
16527
16528 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16529 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16530 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16531 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16532 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16533 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16534
16535 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16536 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16537 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16538 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16539 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16540 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16541 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16542 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16543 case routing fails.
16544
16545
16546
16547
16548 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16549 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16550 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16551
16552 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16553 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16554 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16555 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16556 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16557 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16558 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16559
16560
16561 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16562 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16563 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16564 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16565 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16566 required. For example,
16567 .code
16568 check_srv = smtp
16569 .endd
16570 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16571 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16572 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16573 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16574 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16575 normal way.
16576
16577 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16578 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16579 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16580 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16581 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16582 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16583
16584 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16585 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16586 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16587 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16588 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16589 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16590 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16591 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16592
16593 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16594 when there is a DNS lookup error.
16595
16596
16597
16598 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16599 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16600 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16601 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16602 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16603 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16604 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
16605 setting:
16606 .code
16607 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16608 .endd
16609 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16610 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16611 the address record.
16612
16613
16614 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16615 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16616 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16617 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16618
16619
16620
16621
16622 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
16623 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16624 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
16625 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16626 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16627 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16628 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
16629 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
16630 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
16631 &'resolv.conf'&.
16632
16633
16634
16635 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
16636 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
16637 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
16638 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16639 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16640 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
16641 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
16642 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
16643 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
16644 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
16645 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
16646
16647 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16648 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16649 sense.
16650
16651 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16652 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16653 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16654 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16655 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16656 header rewriting.
16657
16658
16659 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
16660 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
16661 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
16662 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16663 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16664 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16665 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16666 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16667
16668 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16669 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
16670 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
16671 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
16672 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16673 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16674 without processing them independently,
16675 provided the following conditions are met:
16676
16677 .ilist
16678 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
16679 &%headers_remove%&.
16680 .next
16681 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
16682 the domain.
16683 .endlist
16684
16685
16686
16687
16688 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
16689 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16690 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16691 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
16692 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
16693 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
16694 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
16695 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
16696 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
16697 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
16698
16699 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16700 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16701 local wildcard.
16702
16703
16704
16705 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16706 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16707 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
16708 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16709
16710
16711
16712
16713 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
16714 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
16715 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
16716 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
16717 if
16718 .code
16719 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
16720 .endd
16721 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
16722 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
16723 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
16724 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
16725 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
16726 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
16727
16728
16729 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
16730 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
16731 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
16732 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
16733 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
16734
16735 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
16736 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
16737 such as that implied by
16738 .code
16739 domains = @mx_any
16740 .endd
16741 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
16742 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
16743 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
16744 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
16745
16746
16747
16748
16749
16750
16751
16752
16753
16754 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16756
16757 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
16758 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
16759 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
16760 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
16761 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
16762 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
16763 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
16764 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
16765 router handles the address
16766 .code
16767 root@[192.168.1.1]
16768 .endd
16769 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
16770 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
16771 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
16772 .code
16773 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
16774 .endd
16775 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
16776 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
16777
16778 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
16779 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
16780 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
16781 &%self%& option determines what happens.
16782
16783 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
16784 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
16785 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
16786 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
16787
16788
16789
16790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16792
16793 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
16794 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
16795 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
16796 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
16797 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
16798 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
16799 must set
16800 .code
16801 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
16802 .endd
16803 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
16804
16805 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
16806 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
16807 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
16808 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
16809 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
16810 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
16811 must not be specified for it.
16812
16813 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
16814 .option hosts iplookup string unset
16815 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
16816 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
16817 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
16818 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
16819 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
16820
16821
16822 .option optional iplookup boolean false
16823 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
16824 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
16825 delivery to the address is deferred.
16826
16827
16828 .option port iplookup integer 0
16829 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
16830 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
16831 call.
16832
16833
16834 .option protocol iplookup string udp
16835 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
16836 protocols is to be used.
16837
16838
16839 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
16840 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
16841 default value is:
16842 .code
16843 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
16844 .endd
16845 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
16846 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
16847
16848
16849 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
16850 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
16851 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
16852 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
16853 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
16854 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
16855 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
16856 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
16857
16858
16859 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
16860 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
16861 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
16862 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
16863 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
16864 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
16865 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
16866 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
16867 following could be used:
16868 .code
16869 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
16870 reroute = $local_part@$1
16871 .endd
16872
16873 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
16874 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
16875 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
16876 call. It does not apply to UDP.
16877
16878
16879
16880
16881 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16882 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16883
16884 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
16885 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
16886 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
16887 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
16888 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
16889 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
16890 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
16891 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
16892 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
16893 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
16894
16895 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
16896 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
16897 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
16898 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
16899 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
16900 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
16901 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
16902
16903 .vindex "&$host$&"
16904 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
16905 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
16906 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
16907 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
16908 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
16909 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
16910 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
16911 text string.
16912
16913 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
16914 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
16915 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
16916 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
16917 below, following the list of private options.
16918
16919
16920 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
16921
16922 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
16923 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
16924
16925 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
16926 See &%host_find_failed%&.
16927
16928 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
16929 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
16930 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
16931 of the following values:
16932 .code
16933 decline
16934 defer
16935 fail
16936 freeze
16937 ignore
16938 pass
16939 .endd
16940 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
16941 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
16942 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
16943 &%pass_router%&),
16944 .oindex "&%more%&"
16945 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
16946 router only if &%more%& is true.
16947
16948 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
16949 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
16950 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
16951 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
16952
16953 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
16954 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
16955 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
16956
16957
16958 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
16959 .cindex "randomized host list"
16960 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
16961 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
16962 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
16963 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
16964 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
16965 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
16966 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
16967 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
16968
16969 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
16970 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
16971 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
16972 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
16973 .code
16974 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
16975 .endd
16976 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
16977 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
16978 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
16979 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
16980 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
16981
16982
16983 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
16984 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
16985 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
16986 example:
16987 .code
16988 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
16989 .endd
16990 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
16991 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
16992 deferred.
16993
16994
16995 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
16996 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
16997 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
16998 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
16999
17000
17001 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17002 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17003 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17004 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17005 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17006 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17007 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17008 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17009
17010 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17011 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17012 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17013 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17014 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17015 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17016 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17017 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17018
17019
17020
17021
17022 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17023 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17024 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17025 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17026 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17027 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17028 .display
17029 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17030 .endd
17031 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17032 no options:
17033 .code
17034 route_list = \
17035 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17036 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17037 .endd
17038 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17039 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17040 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17041 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17042 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17043 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17044 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17045 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17046 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17047 in a &%route_list%&).
17048
17049 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17050 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17051 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17052 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17053
17054
17055
17056 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17057 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17058 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17059 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17060 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17061 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17062 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17063 like this:
17064 .code
17065 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17066 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17067 .endd
17068 This data can be accessed by setting
17069 .code
17070 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17071 .endd
17072 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17073 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17074 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17075 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17076 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17077
17078
17079
17080
17081 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17082 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17083 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17084 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17085 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17086 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17087 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17088
17089 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17090 variables are set during its expansion:
17091
17092 .ilist
17093 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17094 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17095 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17096 .code
17097 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17098 .endd
17099 .next
17100 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17101 .next
17102 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17103
17104 .next
17105 .vindex "&$value$&"
17106 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17107 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17108 .code
17109 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17110 .endd
17111 .endlist
17112
17113 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17114 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17115
17116
17117
17118 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17119 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17120 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17121 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17122 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17123 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17124
17125 .ilist
17126 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17127 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17128 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17129 .code
17130 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17131 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17132 .endd
17133 .next
17134 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17135 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17136 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17137 number follows. For example:
17138 .code
17139 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17140 .endd
17141 .endlist
17142
17143 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17144 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17145 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17146 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17147 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17148 transport.
17149
17150 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17151 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17152 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17153 records in the DNS. For example:
17154 .code
17155 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17156 .endd
17157 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17158 example:
17159 .code
17160 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17161 .endd
17162 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17163 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17164 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17165 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17166 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17167 happens is controlled by the
17168 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17169 &%self%& option of the router.
17170
17171 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17172 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17173 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17174 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17175 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17176 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17177 defined by MX preferences.
17178
17179 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17180 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17181 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17182
17183 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17184 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17185 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17186 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17187
17188 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17189 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17190 router.
17191
17192 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17193 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17194 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17195
17196 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17197 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17198
17199
17200
17201 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17202 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17203 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17204 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17205 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17206 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17207 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17208
17209 .ilist
17210 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17211 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17212 .next
17213 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17214 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17215 .next
17216 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17217 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17218 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17219 .next
17220 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17221 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17222 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17223 .endlist
17224
17225 For example:
17226 .code
17227 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17228 domain2 host4:host5
17229 .endd
17230 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17231 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17232 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17233 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17234 call.
17235
17236 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17237 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17238 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17239 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17240 function called.
17241
17242
17243
17244 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17245 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17246
17247 .vindex "&$host$&"
17248 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17249 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17250
17251
17252
17253 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17254 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17255 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17256
17257 .ilist
17258 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17259 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17260 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17261 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17262 .code
17263 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17264 .endd
17265 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17266 your first router something like this:
17267 .code
17268 smart_route:
17269 driver = manualroute
17270 domains = !+local_domains
17271 transport = remote_smtp
17272 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17273 .endd
17274 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17275 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17276 they are tried in order
17277 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17278 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17279 .code
17280 smart_route:
17281 driver = manualroute
17282 transport = remote_smtp
17283 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17284 .endd
17285 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17286 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17287 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17288 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17289 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17290 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17291 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17292 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17293
17294 .next
17295 .cindex "mail hub example"
17296 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17297 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17298 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17299 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17300 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17301 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17302 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17303 lookup is easier to manage.
17304
17305 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17306 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17307 example:
17308 .code
17309 hub_route:
17310 driver = manualroute
17311 transport = remote_smtp
17312 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17313 .endd
17314 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17315 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17316 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17317 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17318 domain can be used to find the host:
17319 .code
17320 through_firewall:
17321 driver = manualroute
17322 transport = remote_smtp
17323 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17324 .endd
17325 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17326 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17327 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17328 next router.
17329
17330 .next
17331 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17332 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17333 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17334 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17335 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17336 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17337 .code
17338 save_in_file:
17339 driver = manualroute
17340 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17341 route_list = saved.domain.example
17342 .endd
17343 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17344 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17345 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17346 .code
17347 save_in_file:
17348 driver = manualroute
17349 route_list = \
17350 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17351 *.saved.domain2.example \
17352 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17353 batch_pipe
17354 .endd
17355 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17356 .vindex "&$host$&"
17357 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17358 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17359 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17360 the address if the lookup fails.
17361
17362 .next
17363 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17364 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17365 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17366 one way it can be done:
17367 .code
17368 # Transport
17369 uucp:
17370 driver = pipe
17371 user = nobody
17372 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17373 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17374 return_fail_output = true
17375
17376 # Router
17377 uucphost:
17378 transport = uucp
17379 driver = manualroute
17380 route_data = \
17381 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17382 .endd
17383 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17384 .code
17385 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17386 .endd
17387 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17388 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17389 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17390 .endlist
17391 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17392 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17393
17394
17395
17396
17397
17398
17399
17400
17401 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17402 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17403
17404 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17405 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17406 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17407 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17408 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17409 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17410 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17411 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17412 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17413 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17414 options:
17415 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17416
17417 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17418 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17419 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17420 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17421 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17422
17423
17424 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17425 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17426 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17427 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17428 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17429 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17430
17431
17432 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17433 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17434 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17435 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17436 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17437 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17438 not set, a value for the gid also.
17439
17440 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17441 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17442 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17443 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17444 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17445 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17446 gid.
17447
17448
17449 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17450 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17451 before running the command.
17452
17453
17454 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17455 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17456 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17457 timeout.
17458
17459
17460 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17461 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17462 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17463 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17464 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17465
17466 .ilist
17467 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17468 below).
17469 .next
17470 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17471 &%no_more%& is set.
17472 .next
17473 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17474 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17475 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17476 included in the SMTP response.
17477 .next
17478 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17479 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17480 included in any SMTP response.
17481 .next
17482 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17483 .next
17484 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17485 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17486 .next
17487 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17488 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17489 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17490 .endlist
17491
17492 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17493 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17494 the page):
17495 .code
17496 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17497 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17498 .endd
17499 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17500 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17501 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17502 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17503
17504 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17505 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17506 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17507 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17508 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17509
17510 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17511 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17512 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17513 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17514 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17515
17516 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17517 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17518 variable. For example, this return line
17519 .code
17520 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17521 .endd
17522 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17523 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17524 .ecindex IIDquerou1
17525 .ecindex IIDquerou2
17526
17527
17528
17529
17530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17532
17533 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17534 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17535 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17536 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17537 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17538 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17539 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17540 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17541 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17542 redirected in several different ways:
17543
17544 .ilist
17545 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17546 independently.
17547 .next
17548 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17549 .next
17550 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17551 .next
17552 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17553 .next
17554 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17555 .next
17556 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17557 .next
17558 It can be discarded.
17559 .endlist
17560
17561 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17562 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17563 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17564 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17565
17566
17567
17568 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17569 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17570 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17571 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17572 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17573 aliases, in a configuration like this:
17574 .code
17575 system_aliases:
17576 driver = redirect
17577 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17578 .endd
17579 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17580 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17581 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17582 cause delivery to be deferred.
17583
17584 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17585 &_.forward_& files, like this:
17586 .code
17587 userforward:
17588 driver = redirect
17589 check_local_user
17590 file = $home/.forward
17591 no_verify
17592 .endd
17593 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17594 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17595 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17596 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17597 comments.
17598
17599
17600
17601 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17602 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17603 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17604 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17605
17606 .ilist
17607 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17608 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
17609 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
17610 practice the router may not be able to operate.
17611 .next
17612 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
17613 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17614 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17615 saves some resources.
17616 .endlist
17617
17618
17619
17620
17621
17622
17623 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
17624 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17625 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17626 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
17627 can be interpreted in two different ways:
17628
17629 .ilist
17630 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17631 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
17632 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17633 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17634 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
17635 document is intended for use by end users.
17636 .next
17637 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17638 described in the next section.
17639 .endlist
17640
17641 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
17642 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17643 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17644 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
17645 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
17646
17647
17648
17649 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
17650 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
17651 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17652 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17653 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17654 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17655 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
17656 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17657 commas or newlines.
17658 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17659 quotes.
17660
17661 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17662 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17663 next newline character is ignored.
17664
17665 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17666 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17667 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
17668 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
17669 removed.
17670
17671 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17672 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17673 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
17674 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
17675 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17676 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17677 setting:
17678 .code
17679 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17680 .endd
17681
17682
17683 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
17684 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
17685 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
17686 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
17687 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17688 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17689 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17690 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17691 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17692 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17693 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17694
17695 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
17696 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17697 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17698 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17699 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
17700 .code
17701 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
17702 .endd
17703 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
17704 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
17705 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
17706 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
17707 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
17708 synonymously.
17709
17710 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
17711 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
17712 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
17713 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
17714 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
17715
17716 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
17717 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
17718 contains:
17719 .code
17720 Sam.Reman: spqr
17721 .endd
17722 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
17723 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
17724 this forward file:
17725 .code
17726 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17727 .endd
17728 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
17729 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
17730 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
17731 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
17732 should really contain
17733 .code
17734 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17735 .endd
17736 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
17737 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
17738 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
17739
17740
17741
17742 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
17743 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
17744 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
17745
17746 .ilist
17747 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
17748 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
17749 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
17750 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
17751 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
17752 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17753 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17754
17755 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
17756 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
17757 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
17758 in double quotes, for example:
17759 .code
17760 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
17761 .endd
17762 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
17763 quote just the command. An item such as
17764 .code
17765 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
17766 .endd
17767 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
17768
17769 .next
17770 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
17771 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
17772 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
17773 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
17774 .code
17775 /home/world/minbari
17776 .endd
17777 is treated as a file name, but
17778 .code
17779 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
17780 .endd
17781 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
17782 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
17783 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
17784 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
17785
17786 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17787 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17788
17789 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
17790 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
17791 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
17792 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
17793
17794 .next
17795 .cindex "included address list"
17796 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
17797 If an item is of the form
17798 .code
17799 :include:<path name>
17800 .endd
17801 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
17802 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
17803 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
17804 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
17805 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
17806 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
17807 .code
17808 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
17809 .endd
17810 It must be given as
17811 .code
17812 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
17813 .endd
17814 .next
17815 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
17816 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
17817 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
17818 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
17819 .cindex "black hole"
17820 .cindex "abandoning mail"
17821 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
17822 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
17823 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
17824
17825 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
17826 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
17827 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
17828 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
17829 &_/dev/null_&.
17830
17831 .next
17832 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
17833 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
17834 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
17835 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
17836 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
17837 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
17838 redirection items of the form
17839 .code
17840 :defer:
17841 :fail:
17842 .endd
17843 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies to the
17844 entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored (&':blackhole:'& is
17845 different). Any text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error
17846 text associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
17847 .code
17848 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
17849 .endd
17850 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
17851 of a
17852 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
17853 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
17854 default.
17855 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
17856 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
17857 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
17858
17859 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
17860 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
17861 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
17862 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
17863 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
17864 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
17865 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
17866 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
17867 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
17868 ignored.
17869
17870 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
17871 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
17872 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
17873 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
17874
17875 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
17876 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
17877 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
17878 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
17879 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
17880
17881 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
17882 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
17883 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
17884 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
17885 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
17886 rules still apply.
17887
17888 .next
17889 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
17890 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
17891 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
17892 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
17893 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
17894 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
17895 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
17896 .endlist
17897
17898
17899 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
17900 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17901 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
17902 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
17903 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
17904 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
17905 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
17906 aliasing scheme of the type
17907 .code
17908 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
17909 localpart1: pipe
17910 localpart2: pipe
17911 .endd
17912 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
17913 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
17914 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
17915 such as
17916 .code
17917 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
17918 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
17919 .endd
17920 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
17921 the pipes are distinct.
17922
17923
17924
17925 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
17926 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
17927 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
17928 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
17929 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
17930 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
17931 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
17932 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
17933 can be used to avoid this.
17934
17935
17936 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
17937 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
17938 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
17939 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
17940 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
17941 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
17942 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
17943
17944
17945
17946 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
17947
17948 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
17949 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
17950
17951
17952 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
17953 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
17954 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
17955
17956
17957 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
17958 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
17959 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
17960 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
17961
17962
17963 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
17964 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
17965 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
17966 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
17967 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
17968 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
17969 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
17970
17971 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
17972 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
17973
17974
17975 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
17976 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
17977 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
17978 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
17979 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
17980
17981
17982
17983 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
17984 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
17985 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
17986 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
17987 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
17988 let ordinary users do.
17989
17990
17991
17992 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
17993 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
17994 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
17995 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
17996 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
17997 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
17998
17999 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18000 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18001 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18002 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18003 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18004 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18005 .code
18006 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18007 .endd
18008 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18009 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18010 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18011 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18012 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18013 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18014 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18015 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18016
18017
18018 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18019 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18020 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18021 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18022 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18023 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18024 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18025 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18026
18027
18028
18029 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18030 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18031 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18032 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18033 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18034 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18035
18036
18037 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18038 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18039 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18040 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18041 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18042 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18043
18044 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18045 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18046 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18047 .code
18048 data = #Exim filter\n\
18049 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18050 .endd
18051 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18052 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18053 choice into a newline.
18054
18055
18056 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18057 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18058 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18059 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18060 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18061
18062
18063 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18064 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18065 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18066 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18067 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18068 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18069 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18070 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18071
18072 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18073 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18074 runs a check on the containing directory,
18075 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18076 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18077 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18078 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18079 not, the router declines.
18080
18081
18082 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18083 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18084 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18085 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18086 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18087 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18088 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18089
18090
18091 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18092 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18093 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18094 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18095 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18096
18097
18098 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18099 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18100 redirection list.
18101
18102
18103 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18104 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18105 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18106
18107
18108
18109
18110 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18111 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18112 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18113 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18114 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18115 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18116 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18117 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18118 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18119
18120
18121 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18122 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18123 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18124 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18125 functions.
18126
18127 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18128 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18129 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18130 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18131
18132 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18133 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18134 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18135 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18136 &_.forward_& files).
18137
18138
18139 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18140 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18141 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18142
18143
18144 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18145 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18146 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18147 of the embedded Perl support.
18148
18149
18150 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18151 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18152 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18153
18154
18155 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18156 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18157 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18158
18159
18160 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18161 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18162 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18163 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18164 &%one_time%& is set.
18165
18166
18167 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18168 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18169 to make use of &%run%& items.
18170
18171
18172 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18173 If this option is true, items of the form
18174 .code
18175 :include:<path name>
18176 .endd
18177 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18178
18179
18180 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18181 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18182 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18183 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18184 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18185
18186
18187 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18188 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18189 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18190
18191
18192 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18193 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18194 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18195 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18196 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18197
18198
18199
18200
18201 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18202 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18203 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18204 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18205 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18206 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18207 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18208
18209
18210 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18211 .cindex "EACCES"
18212 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18213 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18214 file did not exist.
18215
18216
18217 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18218 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
18219 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18220 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18221 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18222
18223 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18224 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18225 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18226 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18227 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18228 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18229 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18230 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18231
18232
18233
18234 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18235 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18236 redirection list must start with this directory.
18237
18238
18239 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18240 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18241 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18242
18243
18244 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18245 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18246 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18247 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18248 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18249 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18250 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18251 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18252 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18253 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18254 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18255 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18256 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18257 before they subscribed.
18258
18259 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18260 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18261 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18262 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18263 attempt.
18264
18265 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18266 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18267 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18268 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18269
18270 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18271 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18272 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18273
18274 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18275 &%one_time%&.
18276
18277 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18278 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18279 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18280 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18281 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18282 expansion.
18283
18284
18285 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18286 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18287 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18288 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18289 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18290 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18291 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18292 See &%check_owner%& above.
18293
18294
18295 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18296 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18297 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18298 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18299
18300
18301 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18302 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18303 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18304 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18305 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18306 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18307 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18308
18309
18310 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18311 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18312 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18313 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18314 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18315 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18316 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18317 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18318
18319 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18320 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18321 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18322 addresses.
18323
18324 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18325 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18326 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18327 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18328 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18329 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18330 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18331 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18332 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18333 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18334
18335
18336 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18337 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18338 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18339 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18340 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18341 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18342
18343
18344 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18345 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18346 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18347 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18348 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18349 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18350
18351
18352 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18353 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18354 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18355 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18356 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18357
18358
18359 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18360 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18361 :subaddress part of an address.
18362
18363 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18364 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18365 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18366 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18367
18368
18369 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18370 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18371 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18372 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18373 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18374 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18375 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18376
18377
18378
18379 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18380 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18381 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18382 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18383 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18384 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18385 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18386 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18387 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18388 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18389 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18390 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18391 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18392 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18393 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18394 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18395
18396 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18397 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18398 the following routers.
18399
18400 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18401 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18402 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18403 so it is passed to the following routers.
18404
18405 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18406 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18407 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18408 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18409
18410 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18411 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18412 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18413 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18414 .code
18415 userforward:
18416 driver = redirect
18417 allow_filter
18418 check_local_user
18419 file = $home/.forward
18420 file_transport = address_file
18421 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18422 reply_transport = address_reply
18423 no_verify
18424 skip_syntax_errors
18425 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18426 syntax_errors_text = \
18427 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18428 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18429 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18430 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18431 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18432 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18433 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18434 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18435 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18436 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18437 .endd
18438 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18439 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18440 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18441 .code
18442 real_localuser:
18443 driver = accept
18444 check_local_user
18445 local_part_prefix = real-
18446 transport = local_delivery
18447 .endd
18448 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18449 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18450 .code
18451 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18452 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18453 .endd
18454
18455
18456 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18457 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18458
18459
18460 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18461 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18462 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18463 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18464
18465
18466
18467
18468
18469
18470 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18472
18473 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18474 "Environment for local transports"
18475 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18476 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18477 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18478 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18479 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18480 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18481 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18482
18483 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18484 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18485 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18486 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18487
18488 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18489 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18490 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18491 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18492 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18493
18494
18495
18496 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18497 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18498 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18499 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18500 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18501 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18502 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18503 time.
18504
18505 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18506 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18507 .code
18508 my_transport:
18509 driver = pipe
18510 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18511 .endd
18512 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18513 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18514 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18515 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18516
18517
18518
18519
18520 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18521 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18522 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18523 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18524 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18525 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18526 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18527 group (set by the transport). For example:
18528 .code
18529 # Routers ...
18530 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18531 local_users:
18532 driver = accept
18533 check_local_user
18534 transport = group_delivery
18535
18536 # Transports ...
18537 # This transport overrides the group
18538 group_delivery:
18539 driver = appendfile
18540 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18541 group = mail
18542 .endd
18543 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18544 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18545 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18546 set.
18547
18548 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18549 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18550 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18551 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18552 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18553 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18554
18555 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18556 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18557 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18558 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18559 original gid is also used.
18560
18561 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18562 following that is set is used:
18563
18564 .ilist
18565 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18566 .next
18567 A &%group%& setting of the router;
18568 .next
18569 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18570 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18571 .next
18572 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18573 .next
18574 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18575 the uid is the creator's uid;
18576 .next
18577 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18578 .endlist
18579
18580 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18581 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18582 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18583 The first of the following that is set is used:
18584
18585 .ilist
18586 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18587 .next
18588 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18589 .next
18590 A &%user%& setting of the router;
18591 .next
18592 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18593 .next
18594 The Exim uid.
18595 .endlist
18596
18597 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18598 &%never_users%& list.
18599
18600
18601
18602
18603
18604 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
18605 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18606 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18607 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
18608 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
18609 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18610 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
18611 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
18612 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18613 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18614
18615 .ilist
18616 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18617 .next
18618 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18619 .next
18620 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18621 .next
18622 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18623 .endlist
18624
18625 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18626
18627 .ilist
18628 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
18629 .next
18630 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
18631 .endlist
18632
18633
18634 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18635 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18636 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
18637
18638
18639
18640 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
18641 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18642 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18643 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
18644 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18645 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
18646 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18647 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18648 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18649 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
18650 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
18651 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
18652 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
18653 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
18654
18655
18656
18657
18658
18659
18660
18661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18663
18664 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
18665 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
18666 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
18667 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
18668 The following generic options apply to all transports:
18669
18670
18671 .option body_only transports boolean false
18672 .cindex "transport" "body only"
18673 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
18674 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
18675 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18676 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
18677 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
18678 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
18679 automatically suppress them.
18680
18681
18682 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
18683 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
18684 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18685 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18686 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18687 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18688
18689
18690 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
18691 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18692 deliveries by the transport or for any
18693 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18694 what you are doing.
18695
18696
18697 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
18698 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18699 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18700 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18701 transport is run.
18702 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18703 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18704 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18705 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
18706 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
18707 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
18708 one.
18709
18710
18711 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
18712 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
18713 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
18714 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
18715 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
18716 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
18717 safely be resent to other recipients.
18718
18719
18720 .option driver transports string unset
18721 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
18722 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
18723
18724
18725 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
18726 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
18727 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
18728 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
18729 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
18730 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
18731 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
18732 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
18733 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
18734 resent to other recipients.
18735
18736
18737 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
18738 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
18739 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
18740 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
18741 &%user%& (see below).
18742
18743
18744 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
18745 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
18746 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
18747 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
18748 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
18749 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
18750 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18751 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18752 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18753
18754
18755
18756 .option headers_only transports boolean false
18757 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
18758 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
18759 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
18760 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
18761 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
18762 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
18763 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
18764
18765
18766 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
18767 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18768 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
18769 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
18770 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
18771 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
18772 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18773 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18774 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18775
18776
18777
18778 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
18779 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
18780 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
18781 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
18782 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
18783 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
18784 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
18785 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
18786 example,
18787 .code
18788 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
18789 x@y w@z
18790 .endd
18791 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
18792 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
18793 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
18794 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
18795 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
18796 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
18797 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
18798 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
18799 change envelope recipients at this time.
18800
18801
18802 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
18803 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
18804 .vindex "&$home$&"
18805 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
18806 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
18807 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
18808 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
18809 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
18810 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
18811 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
18812 deferred.
18813
18814
18815 .option initgroups transports boolean false
18816 .cindex "additional groups"
18817 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18818 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
18819 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
18820 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
18821 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
18822
18823
18824 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
18825 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
18826 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
18827 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
18828 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
18829 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
18830 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
18831 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
18832 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
18833 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
18834 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
18835 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
18836 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
18837 delivered.
18838
18839
18840
18841 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
18842 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
18843 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
18844 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
18845 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
18846 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
18847 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
18848 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
18849 that contains
18850 .code
18851 local_part_prefix = *-
18852 .endd
18853 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
18854 is delivered with
18855 .code
18856 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
18857 .endd
18858 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
18859 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
18860 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
18861 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
18862 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
18863
18864
18865 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
18866 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18867 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
18868 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
18869 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
18870 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
18871 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
18872 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
18873 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
18874
18875 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
18876 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
18877 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
18878 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
18879
18880 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
18881 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
18882 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
18883
18884
18885 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
18886 .cindex "envelope sender"
18887 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
18888 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
18889 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
18890 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
18891 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
18892 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
18893 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
18894 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
18895 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
18896
18897 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
18898 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
18899
18900 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
18901 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
18902 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
18903 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
18904 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
18905 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
18906 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
18907
18908 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
18909 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
18910 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
18911 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
18912 &%errors_to%& in a router.
18913
18914
18915
18916 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
18917 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
18918 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
18919 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
18920 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
18921 have easy access to it.
18922
18923 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
18924 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
18925 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
18926 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
18927 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
18928 recipients.
18929
18930
18931 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
18932 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
18933
18934
18935 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
18936 .cindex "shadow transport"
18937 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
18938 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
18939 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
18940
18941 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
18942 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
18943 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
18944 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
18945 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
18946 cause a log line to be written.
18947
18948 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
18949 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
18950 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
18951 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
18952 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
18953 of the form
18954 .code
18955 ST=<shadow transport name>
18956 .endd
18957 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
18958 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
18959 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
18960 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
18961 headers that some sites insist on.
18962
18963
18964 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
18965 .cindex "transport" "filter"
18966 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
18967 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
18968 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
18969 individual users or via a system filter.
18970
18971 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
18972 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
18973 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
18974 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
18975 command must be specified as an absolute path.
18976
18977 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
18978 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
18979 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
18980 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
18981 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
18982 &(pipe)& transports.
18983
18984 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
18985 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
18986 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
18987 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
18988 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
18989
18990 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
18991 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
18992 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
18993 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
18994
18995 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
18996 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
18997 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
18998 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
18999 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19000 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19001
19002 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19003 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19004 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19005 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19006 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19007 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19008 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19009 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19010
19011 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19012 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19013 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19014 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19015 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19016 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19017 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19018 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19019 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19020 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19021
19022 .vindex "&$host$&"
19023 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19024 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19025 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19026 which the message is being sent. For example:
19027 .code
19028 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19029 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19030 .endd
19031
19032 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19033 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19034 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19035 .ilist
19036 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19037 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19038 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19039 example:
19040 .code
19041 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19042 .endd
19043 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19044 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19045 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19046 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19047 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19048 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19049 .next
19050 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19051 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19052 arguments. Consider this example:
19053 .code
19054 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19055 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19056 .endd
19057 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19058 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19059 .code
19060 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19061 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19062 .endd
19063 .endlist
19064
19065 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19066 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19067 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19068 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19069 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19070 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19071 bounced from a transport filter.
19072
19073 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19074 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19075 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19076
19077
19078 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19079 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19080 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19081 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19082 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19083 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19084 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19085 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19086 becomes a temporary error.
19087
19088
19089 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19090 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19091 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19092 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19093 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19094 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19095 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19096 option is not set.
19097
19098 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19099 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19100 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19101
19102 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19103 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19104 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19105 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19106 retry data.
19107 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19108 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19109 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19110
19111
19112
19113
19114
19115
19116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19117 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19118
19119 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19120 "Address batching"
19121 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19122 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19123 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19124 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19125 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19126 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19127 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19128
19129 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19130 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19131 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19132 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19133 local transport, for example:
19134
19135 .ilist
19136 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19137 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19138 recipients saves space.
19139 .next
19140 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19141 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19142 .next
19143 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19144 to a scanner program or
19145 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19146 acceptable.
19147 .endlist
19148
19149 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19150 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19151 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19152
19153 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19154 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19155 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19156 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19157 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19158 to certain conditions:
19159
19160 .ilist
19161 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19162 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19163 batching is possible.
19164 .next
19165 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19166 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19167 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19168 .next
19169 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19170 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19171 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19172 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19173 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19174 from taking place.
19175 .next
19176 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19177 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19178 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19179 be the same.
19180 .endlist
19181
19182 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19183 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19184 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19185 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19186 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19187 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19188 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19189 .code
19190 check_string = "."
19191 escape_string = ".."
19192 .endd
19193 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19194 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19195 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19196
19197 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19198 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19199 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19200 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19201 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19202 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19203
19204 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19205 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19206 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19207 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19208 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19209 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19210 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19211 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19212 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19213
19214
19215
19216
19217 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19219
19220 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19221 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19222 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19223 .cindex "directory creation"
19224 .cindex "creating directories"
19225 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19226 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19227 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19228 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19229 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19230 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19231 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19232 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19233 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19234 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19235
19236 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19237 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19238 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19239 included.
19240
19241 .cindex "quota" "system"
19242 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19243 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19244 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19245
19246 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19247 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19248 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19249 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19250
19251 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19252 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19253 private options.
19254
19255 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19256 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19257 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19258 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19259 option).
19260
19261
19262
19263 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19264 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19265 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19266 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19267 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19268
19269 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19270 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19271 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19272 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19273 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19274 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19275 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19276 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19277 operation. There are two cases:
19278
19279 .ilist
19280 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19281 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19282 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19283 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19284 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19285 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19286 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19287 .next
19288 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19289 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19290 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19291 .endlist
19292
19293
19294 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19295 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19296 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19297 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19298 form:
19299 .code
19300 save folder23
19301 .endd
19302 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19303 .code
19304 require "fileinto";
19305 fileinto "folder23";
19306 .endd
19307 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19308 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19309 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19310 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19311 way of handling this requirement:
19312 .code
19313 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19314 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19315 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19316 {$address_file} \
19317 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19318 }} \
19319 }
19320 .endd
19321 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19322 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19323 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19324
19325 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19326 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19327 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19328 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19329 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19330 path to the transport.
19331
19332 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19333 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19334
19335
19336
19337
19338 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19339 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19340
19341
19342
19343 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19344 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19345 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19346 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19347 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19348 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19349 delivery is deferred.
19350
19351
19352 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19353 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19354 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19355 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19356 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19357 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19358 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19359 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19360
19361
19362 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19363 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19364 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19365 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19366 file.
19367
19368
19369 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19370 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19371
19372
19373 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19374 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19375 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19376 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19377 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19378
19379
19380 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19381 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19382 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19383 process is running.
19384
19385
19386 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19387 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19388 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19389 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19390 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19391 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19392 contains is significant.
19393
19394 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19395 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19396 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19397 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19398 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19399
19400 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19401 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19402 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19403 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19404 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19405 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19406 .code
19407 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19408 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19409 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19410 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19411 .endd
19412 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19413 .cindex "directory creation"
19414 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19415 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19416 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19417
19418 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19419 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19420 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19421 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19422 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19423
19424
19425
19426 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19427 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19428 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19429 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19430 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19431 beneath.
19432
19433 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19434 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19435 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19436 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19437 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19438 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19439 &%file_must_exist%&.
19440
19441
19442 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19443 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19444 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19445 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19446
19447 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19448 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19449 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19450 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19451 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19452
19453
19454 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19455 .cindex "base62"
19456 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19457 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19458 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19459 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19460 .code
19461 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19462 .endd
19463 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19464 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19465 option.
19466
19467
19468 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19469 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19470 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19471
19472
19473 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19474 See &%check_string%& above.
19475
19476
19477 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
19478 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19479 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19480 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19481 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19482 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19483 &%file%&.
19484
19485 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19486 .cindex "locking files"
19487 .cindex "lock files"
19488 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19489 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19490
19491 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19492 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19493 examples:
19494 .code
19495 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19496 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19497 file = $home/inbox
19498 .endd
19499 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19500 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19501 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19502 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19503 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19504 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19505
19506
19507
19508 .option file_format appendfile string unset
19509 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19510 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19511 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19512 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19513 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19514 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19515 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19516 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19517 this added to it:
19518 .code
19519 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19520 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19521 .endd
19522 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19523 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19524 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19525 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19526 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19527 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19528 delivery is deferred.
19529
19530
19531 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19532 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19533 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19534 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19535
19536
19537 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19538 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19539 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19540 .cindex "locking files"
19541 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19542 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19543 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19544 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19545 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19546 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19547 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19548 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19549
19550 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19551 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19552 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19553 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19554
19555 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19556 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19557 retries is
19558 .code
19559 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19560 .endd
19561 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19562 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19563 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19564
19565 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19566 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19567 .code
19568 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19569 .endd
19570
19571 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19572 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19573 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19574 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19575
19576
19577 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19578 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19579 for details of locking.
19580
19581
19582 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19583 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19584 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19585
19586
19587 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19588 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19589 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19590
19591
19592 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19593 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19594 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19595 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19596 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19597
19598
19599 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19600 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19601 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19602 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19603 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19604 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19605 external source that maintains the data.
19606
19607
19608 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
19609 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19610 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19611 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19612 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19613 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19614 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19615 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19616
19617
19618
19619 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
19620 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
19621 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
19622 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
19623 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
19624 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
19625 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19626 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
19627 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
19628 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19629
19630
19631 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
19632 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
19633 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
19634 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
19635 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
19636 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
19637 calculation. The default value is:
19638 .code
19639 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19640 .endd
19641 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
19642 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19643 &_Trash_&
19644 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19645 .code
19646 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19647 .endd
19648 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19649 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
19650 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
19651 directly into that directory.
19652
19653
19654 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
19655 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19656 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19657
19658
19659 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
19660 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19661 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19662
19663
19664 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile boolean false
19665 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
19666 Setting this option true enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
19667 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19668 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
19669 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
19670 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19671
19672 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
19673 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
19674 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
19675 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
19676 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
19677 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
19678 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
19679 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
19680 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
19681 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
19682
19683
19684 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
19685 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
19686 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
19687 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
19688 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
19689 below for further details.
19690
19691
19692 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
19693 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19694 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19695
19696
19697 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
19698 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19699 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19700
19701
19702 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
19703 .cindex "locking files"
19704 .cindex "file" "locking"
19705 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
19706 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
19707 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19708 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
19709 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
19710 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
19711 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
19712
19713 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
19714 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
19715 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
19716 combination:
19717 .code
19718 mbx_format = true
19719 message_prefix =
19720 message_suffix =
19721 .endd
19722 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
19723 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
19724 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
19725 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
19726 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
19727 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
19728 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
19729 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
19730
19731 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
19732 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
19733 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
19734 append messages to it.
19735
19736
19737 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19738 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19739 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
19740 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19741 in which case it is:
19742 .code
19743 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
19744 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
19745 .endd
19746 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19747 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
19748
19749 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19750 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
19751 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19752 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
19753 setting
19754 .code
19755 message_suffix =
19756 .endd
19757 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19758 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
19759
19760 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19761 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
19762 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
19763 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
19764 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
19765 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
19766 value, and this option is ignored.
19767
19768
19769 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
19770 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
19771 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
19772 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
19773 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
19774
19775
19776 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
19777 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
19778 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
19779 on users about incoming mail.
19780
19781
19782 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
19783 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
19784 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
19785 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
19786 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
19787 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
19788 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
19789 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
19790 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
19791
19792 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
19793 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
19794 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
19795
19796 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
19797 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
19798 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
19799 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
19800 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
19801 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
19802
19803 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
19804 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
19805 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
19806 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
19807 be handled.
19808
19809 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
19810
19811 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
19812 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
19813 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
19814 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
19815 system quota failures.
19816
19817 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
19818 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
19819 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
19820 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
19821 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
19822 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
19823 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
19824 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
19825 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
19826 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
19827
19828
19829 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
19830 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
19831 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
19832 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
19833 delivery directory.
19834
19835
19836 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
19837 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
19838 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
19839 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
19840 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
19841 &"no quota"&.
19842
19843
19844 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
19845 See &%quota%& above.
19846
19847
19848 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
19849 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
19850 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
19851 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
19852 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
19853 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
19854 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
19855
19856 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
19857 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
19858 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
19859 the file length to the file name. For example:
19860 .code
19861 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
19862 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
19863 .endd
19864 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
19865 number of lines in the message.
19866
19867 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
19868 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
19869 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
19870
19871
19872
19873 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
19874 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
19875 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
19876 .code
19877 quota_warn_message = "\
19878 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
19879 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
19880 This message is automatically created \
19881 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
19882 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
19883 a warning threshold that is\n\
19884 set by the system administrator.\n"
19885 .endd
19886
19887
19888 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
19889 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
19890 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
19891 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19892 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
19893 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
19894 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
19895 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
19896 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
19897 sign. For example:
19898 .code
19899 quota = 10M
19900 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
19901 .endd
19902 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
19903 percent sign is ignored.
19904
19905 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
19906 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
19907 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
19908 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
19909 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
19910 &'From:'& line, the default is:
19911 .code
19912 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
19913 .endd
19914 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
19915 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
19916 option.
19917
19918 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
19919 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
19920 percentage.
19921
19922
19923 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
19924 .cindex "envelope sender"
19925 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
19926 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
19927 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
19928 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
19929 for details of batch SMTP.
19930
19931
19932 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
19933 .cindex "carriage return"
19934 .cindex "linefeed"
19935 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
19936 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
19937 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
19938 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
19939
19940 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
19941 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
19942 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
19943 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
19944 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
19945 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
19946
19947
19948 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
19949 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
19950 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
19951 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
19952 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
19953 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
19954
19955
19956 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
19957 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
19958 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
19959 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
19960 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
19961
19962 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
19963 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
19964 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
19965 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
19966
19967 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
19968 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
19969 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
19970 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
19971 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
19972 error.
19973
19974 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
19975 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
19976
19977
19978 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
19979 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
19980 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
19981 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
19982 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
19983 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
19984 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
19985
19986 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19987 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
19988 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
19989 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
19990 file corruption.
19991
19992 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
19993 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
19994 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
19995
19996
19997 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
19998 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19999 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20000 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20001 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20002 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20003 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20004 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20005 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20006
20007 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20008 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20009 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20010 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20011
20012
20013
20014
20015 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20016 .cindex "appending to a file"
20017 .cindex "file" "appending"
20018 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20019
20020 .ilist
20021 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20022 return is given.
20023
20024 .next
20025 .cindex "directory creation"
20026 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20027 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20028 &%directory_mode%& option.
20029
20030 .next
20031 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20032 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20033 transport.
20034
20035 .next
20036 .cindex "file" "locking"
20037 .cindex "locking files"
20038 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20039 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20040 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20041
20042 .olist
20043 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20044 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20045 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20046 .next
20047 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20048 .next
20049 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20050 Unlink the hitching post name.
20051 .next
20052 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20053 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20054 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20055 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20056 .next
20057 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20058 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20059 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20060 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20061 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20062 it before trying again.
20063 .endlist olist
20064
20065 .next
20066 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20067 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20068 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20069
20070 .next
20071 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20072 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20073 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20074 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20075 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20076 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20077 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20078 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20079 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20080 checked.
20081
20082 .next
20083 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20084 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20085 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20086 delivery is deferred.
20087
20088 .next
20089 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20090 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20091 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20092 permissions.
20093
20094 .next
20095 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20096 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20097 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20098
20099 .next
20100 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20101 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20102 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20103
20104 .next
20105 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20106 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20107 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20108 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20109 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20110 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20111 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20112 that prevents link following.
20113
20114 .next
20115 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20116 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20117 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20118 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20119 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20120
20121 .next
20122 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20123
20124 .next
20125 .cindex "file" "locking"
20126 .cindex "locking files"
20127 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20128 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20129 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20130 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20131 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20132 .code
20133 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20134 .endd
20135 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20136 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20137 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20138
20139 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20140 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20141 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20142
20143 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20144 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20145 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20146 delivery is deferred.
20147
20148 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20149 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20150 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20151 immediately. It retries up to
20152 .code
20153 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20154 .endd
20155 times (rounded up).
20156 .endlist
20157
20158 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20159 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20160
20161
20162 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20163 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20164 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20165 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20166 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20167 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20168 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20169 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20170 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20171 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20172
20173 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20174 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20175 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20176 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20177 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20178 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20179 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20180
20181 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20182 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20183 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20184 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20185
20186
20187 .cindex "maildir format"
20188 .cindex "mailstore format"
20189 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20190 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20191 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20192 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20193 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20194
20195 .cindex "directory creation"
20196 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20197 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20198 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20199 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20200 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20201 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20202 deferred.
20203
20204
20205
20206 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20207 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20208 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20209 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20210 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20211 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20212 &_new_& subdirectory.
20213
20214 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20215 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20216 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20217 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20218 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20219 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20220 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20221
20222 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20223 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20224 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20225 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20226 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20227 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20228 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20229 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20230
20231 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20232 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20233 folders. Consider this example:
20234 .code
20235 maildir_format = true
20236 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20237 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20238 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20239 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20240 .endd
20241 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20242 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20243 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20244 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20245 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20246 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20247
20248 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20249 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20250 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20251 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20252 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20253
20254 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20255 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20256 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20257
20258 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20259 .cindex "maildir++"
20260 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20261 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20262 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20263 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20264 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20265 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20266 amount of space used.
20267
20268 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20269 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20270 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20271 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20272 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20273 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20274
20275
20276
20277
20278 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20279 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20280 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20281 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20282 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20283 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20284
20285 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20286 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20287 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20288 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20289 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20290 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20291 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20292 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20293 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20294 colon is inserted.
20295
20296
20297
20298 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20299 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20300 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20301 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20302 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20303 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20304 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20305 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20306 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20307
20308 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20309 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20310 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20311 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20312 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20313 need to know the quota.
20314
20315 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20316 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20317
20318 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20319 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20320 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20321 details.
20322
20323
20324 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20325 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20326 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20327 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20328 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20329 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20330 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20331 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20332
20333 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20334 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20335 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20336 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20337 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20338 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20339
20340 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20341 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20342 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20343 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20344 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20345 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20346
20347 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20348 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20349 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20350 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20351
20352
20353 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20354 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20355 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20356 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20357 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20358 .code
20359 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20360 .endd
20361 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20362 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20363 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20364 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20365 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20366
20367
20368
20369
20370
20371
20372 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20373 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20374
20375 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20376 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20377 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20378 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20379 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20380 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20381 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20382 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20383
20384 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20385 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20386 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20387 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20388 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20389
20390
20391 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20392 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20393 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20394 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20395 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20396
20397 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20398 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20399 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20400 transport is run as a consequence of a
20401 &%mail%&
20402 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20403 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20404 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20405 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20406 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20407 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20408
20409 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20410 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20411 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20412 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20413
20414 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20415 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20416 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20417 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20418 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20419 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20420 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20421
20422 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20423 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20424 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20425 the transport defers.
20426 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20427 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20428
20429 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20430 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20431 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20432 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20433
20434 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20435 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20436 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20437 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20438 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20439 problems. They are just discarded.
20440
20441
20442
20443 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20444 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20445
20446 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20447 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20448 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20449
20450
20451 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20452 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20453 when the message is specified by the transport.
20454
20455
20456 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20457 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20458 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20459 string comes first.
20460
20461
20462 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20463 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20464 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20465
20466
20467 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20468 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20469 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20470
20471
20472 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
20473 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20474 specified by the transport.
20475
20476
20477 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20478 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20479 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20480 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20481
20482
20483 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
20484 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20485 the message is specified by the transport.
20486
20487
20488 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20489 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20490 used.
20491
20492
20493 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20494 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20495 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20496 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20497 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20498
20499
20500
20501 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
20502 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20503 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20504 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20505
20506 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20507 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20508 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20509 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20510 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20511 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20512 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20513 infinity.
20514
20515 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20516 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20517 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20518 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20519 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20520
20521 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20522 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20523 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20524 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20525 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20526 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20527
20528
20529 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20530 See &%once%& above.
20531
20532
20533 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20534 See &%once%& above.
20535 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20536
20537
20538 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20539 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20540 specified by the transport.
20541
20542
20543 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
20544 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20545 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20546 configuration option.
20547
20548
20549 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20550 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20551 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20552 automatic responses. For example:
20553 .code
20554 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20555 .endd
20556 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20557 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20558 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20559 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20560 small.
20561
20562
20563
20564 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
20565 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20566 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20567 the text comes first.
20568
20569
20570 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
20571 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20572 when the message is specified by the transport.
20573 .ecindex IIDauttra1
20574 .ecindex IIDauttra2
20575
20576
20577
20578
20579 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20580 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20581
20582 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20583 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20584 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20585 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20586 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20587 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20588 specified command
20589 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20590 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
20591 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20592 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
20593 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
20594 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20595 .code
20596 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
20597 .endd
20598 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
20599 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
20600 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
20601 as follows:
20602
20603 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
20604 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20605
20606
20607 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
20608 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20609 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20610 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20611 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20612
20613
20614 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
20615 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
20616 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
20617 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
20618 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
20619 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
20620 LMTP protocol.
20621
20622 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
20623 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
20624 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
20625 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
20626 in its response to the LHLO command.
20627
20628 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
20629 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
20630 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20631 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20632
20633
20634 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
20635 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
20636 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
20637 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
20638 LMTP transport:
20639 .code
20640 lmtp:
20641 driver = lmtp
20642 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20643 batch_max = 20
20644 user = exim
20645 .endd
20646 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20647 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
20648
20649
20650
20651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20652 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20653
20654 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
20655 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
20656 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
20657 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20658 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
20659 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
20660 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
20661 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
20662 following ways:
20663
20664 .ilist
20665 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20666 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
20667 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
20668 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
20669 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
20670 .next
20671 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20672 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
20673 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
20674 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
20675 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
20676 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
20677 that are routed to the transport.
20678 .next
20679 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20680 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20681 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
20682 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
20683 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
20684 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
20685 the local part that was redirected.
20686 .endlist
20687
20688
20689 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
20690 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
20691 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
20692
20693 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
20694 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
20695 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
20696 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
20697 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
20698 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
20699 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
20700
20701
20702 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
20703 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
20704 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
20705 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
20706 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
20707
20708
20709
20710
20711 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
20712 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
20713 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
20714 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
20715 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
20716 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
20717 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
20718 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
20719 &"local delivery failed"&.
20720
20721 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
20722 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
20723 value is the return code minus 128.
20724
20725 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
20726 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
20727 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
20728 a non-existent command may be the problem.
20729
20730 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
20731 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
20732 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
20733 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
20734 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
20735 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
20736 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
20737 &%temp_errors%&.
20738
20739
20740
20741 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
20742 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
20743 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
20744 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
20745 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
20746 run.
20747
20748 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
20749 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
20750 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
20751 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
20752
20753 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
20754 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
20755 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
20756 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
20757 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
20758 .code
20759 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
20760 .endd
20761 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
20762 arguments. You have to write
20763 .code
20764 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
20765 .endd
20766 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
20767 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
20768 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
20769 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
20770 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
20771 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
20772 example:
20773 .code
20774 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
20775 .endd
20776
20777 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20778 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20779 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20780 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
20781 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
20782 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
20783 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
20784 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
20785 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
20786 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
20787
20788 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
20789 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
20790 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
20791 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
20792 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
20793 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
20794 control what is done with it.
20795
20796 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
20797 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
20798 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
20799 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
20800 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
20801 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
20802 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
20803 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
20804 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
20805 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
20806 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
20807
20808
20809
20810 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
20811 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20812 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
20813 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
20814 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
20815 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
20816 environment.
20817 .display
20818 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
20819 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
20820 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
20821 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
20822 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
20823 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
20824 &`LOGNAME `& see below
20825 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
20826 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
20827 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
20828 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
20829 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
20830 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
20831 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
20832 &`USER `& see below
20833 .endd
20834 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
20835 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
20836 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
20837 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
20838 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
20839 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
20840 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
20841
20842 .cindex "HOST"
20843 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
20844 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
20845 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
20846 the router.
20847
20848 .cindex "HOME"
20849 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
20850 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
20851 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
20852 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
20853
20854
20855 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
20856 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
20857
20858
20859
20860 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
20861 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
20862 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20863 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
20864 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
20865 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
20866 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
20867 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
20868 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
20869 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
20870 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
20871 example, if
20872 .code
20873 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
20874 .endd
20875 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
20876 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
20877 &%use_shell%& is set.
20878
20879
20880 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
20881 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20882
20883
20884 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
20885 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20886 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20887
20888
20889 .option check_string pipe string unset
20890 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
20891 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
20892 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
20893 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
20894 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
20895 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
20896 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
20897 ignored.
20898
20899
20900 .option command pipe string&!! unset
20901 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
20902 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
20903 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
20904 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
20905 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
20906 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
20907
20908
20909 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
20910 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20911 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
20912 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
20913 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
20914 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20915 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
20916
20917
20918 .option escape_string pipe string unset
20919 See &%check_string%& above.
20920
20921
20922 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
20923 .cindex "exec failure"
20924 .cindex "failure of exec"
20925 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
20926 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
20927 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
20928 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
20929 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
20930
20931
20932 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
20933 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
20934 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
20935 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
20936 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
20937 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
20938
20939 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
20940 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
20941
20942 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
20943 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
20944 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
20945 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
20946 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
20947
20948
20949 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
20950 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
20951 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
20952 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
20953 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
20954 Only one of them may be set.
20955
20956
20957
20958 .option log_output pipe boolean false
20959 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
20960 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
20961 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
20962
20963
20964
20965 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
20966 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
20967 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
20968 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
20969 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
20970 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
20971 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
20972 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
20973
20974
20975 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
20976 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20977 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
20978 .code
20979 message_prefix = \
20980 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
20981 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
20982 .endd
20983 .cindex "Cyrus"
20984 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
20985 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20986 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
20987 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
20988 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
20989 setting
20990 .code
20991 message_prefix =
20992 .endd
20993 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20994 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20995
20996
20997 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
20998 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20999 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21000 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21001 .code
21002 message_suffix =
21003 .endd
21004 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21005 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21006
21007
21008 .option path pipe string "see below"
21009 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21010 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21011 .code
21012 /bin:/usr/bin
21013 .endd
21014 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21015 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21016 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21017
21018
21019 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21020 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21021 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21022 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21023 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21024 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21025 accept the message is used.
21026
21027
21028 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21029 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21030 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21031 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21032 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21033 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21034
21035
21036 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21037 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21038 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21039 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21040 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21041 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21042 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21043
21044
21045
21046 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21047 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21048 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21049 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21050 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21051 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21052 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21053 of them may be set.
21054
21055
21056
21057 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21058 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21059 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21060 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21061 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21062 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21063 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21064 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21065 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21066 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21067 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21068 and 73, respectively.
21069
21070
21071 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21072 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21073 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21074 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21075 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21076 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21077 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21078
21079 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21080 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21081 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21082 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21083 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21084 delivery to be deferred.
21085
21086 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21087 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21088
21089
21090 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21091 .cindex "envelope sender"
21092 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21093 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21094 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21095 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21096 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21097
21098 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21099 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21100 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21101 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21102 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21103 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21104 class database.
21105
21106
21107 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21108 .cindex "carriage return"
21109 .cindex "linefeed"
21110 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21111 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21112 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21113 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21114
21115 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21116 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21117 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21118 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21119 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21120
21121
21122 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21123 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21124 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21125 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21126 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21127 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21128 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21129 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21130 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21131 its &%-c%& option.
21132
21133
21134
21135 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21136 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21137 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21138 .cindex "external local delivery"
21139 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21140 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21141 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21142 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21143 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21144 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21145 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21146 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21147 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21148 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21149 .code
21150 # transport
21151 procmail_pipe:
21152 driver = pipe
21153 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21154 return_path_add
21155 delivery_date_add
21156 envelope_to_add
21157 check_string = "From "
21158 escape_string = ">From "
21159 user = $local_part
21160 group = mail
21161
21162 # router
21163 procmail:
21164 driver = accept
21165 check_local_user
21166 transport = procmail_pipe
21167 .endd
21168 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21169 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21170 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21171 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21172 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21173 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21174
21175 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21176 .code
21177 IFS=" "
21178 .endd
21179 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21180 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21181
21182 .cindex "Cyrus"
21183 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21184 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21185 .code
21186 # transport
21187 local_delivery_cyrus:
21188 driver = pipe
21189 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21190 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21191 user = cyrus
21192 group = mail
21193 return_output
21194 log_output
21195 message_prefix =
21196 message_suffix =
21197
21198 # router
21199 local_user_cyrus:
21200 driver = accept
21201 check_local_user
21202 local_part_suffix = .*
21203 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21204 .endd
21205 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21206 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21207 sender.
21208 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21209 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21210
21211
21212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21214
21215 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21216 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21217 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21218 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21219 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21220 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21221 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21222 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21223
21224
21225 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21226 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21227 two ways:
21228
21229 .ilist
21230 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21231 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21232 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21233 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21234 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21235 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21236 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21237 .next
21238 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21239 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21240 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21241 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21242 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21243 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21244 process.
21245 .endlist
21246
21247
21248 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21249 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21250 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21251
21252
21253
21254 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21255 .vindex "&$host$&"
21256 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21257 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21258 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21259 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21260 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21261 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21262 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21263 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21264
21265
21266 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21267 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21268 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21269 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21270 and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21271 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21272 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21273 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21274 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21275 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21276 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21277
21278
21279 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21280 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21281 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21282
21283
21284 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21285 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21286 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21287 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21288 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21289 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21290 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21291 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21292
21293 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21294 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21295 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21296 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21297 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21298 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21299 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21300 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21301 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21302
21303
21304 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21305 .cindex "Cyrus"
21306 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21307 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21308 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21309 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21310 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21311 ignored.
21312
21313 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21314 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21315 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21316 particular connection.
21317
21318 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21319 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21320 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21321 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21322
21323 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21324 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21325 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21326 .code
21327 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21328 .endd
21329 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21330 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21331
21332 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21333 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21334 value.
21335
21336
21337 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21338 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21339 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21340 authenticated as a client.
21341
21342
21343 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21344 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21345 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21346 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21347
21348
21349 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21350 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21351 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21352 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21353 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21354 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21355 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21356
21357
21358 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21359 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21360 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21361 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21362 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21363 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21364 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21365 option.
21366
21367
21368 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21369 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21370 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21371 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21372
21373
21374 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21375 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21376 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21377 cutoff times.
21378
21379 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21380 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21381 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21382 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21383 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21384 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21385
21386 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21387 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21388 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21389 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21390 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21391 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21392 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21393 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21394 to them.
21395
21396
21397 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21398 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21399 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21400 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21401 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21402
21403
21404 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21405 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21406 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21407 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21408 details.
21409
21410
21411
21412 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21413 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21414 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21415 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21416 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21417 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21418 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21419 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21420
21421 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21422 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21423 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21424 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21425 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21426 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21427
21428 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21429 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21430 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21431 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21432 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21433
21434 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21435 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21436 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21437 copy of the message is sent.
21438
21439 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21440 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21441 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21442 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21443 fails"& facility.
21444
21445
21446 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21447 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21448 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21449 zero.
21450
21451 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21452 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21453 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21454 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21455 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21456 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21457
21458 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
21459 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21460 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21461
21462 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
21463 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21464 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21465
21466 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
21467 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21468 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21469
21470 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21471 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21472 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21473 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21474 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21475 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21476 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21477 option is:
21478 .code
21479 $primary_hostname
21480 .endd
21481 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21482 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21483 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21484 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21485 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21486 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21487 interface address, you could use this:
21488 .code
21489 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21490 {$primary_hostname}}
21491 .endd
21492 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21493 callouts.
21494
21495 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21496 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21497 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21498 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21499 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21500 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21501
21502 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21503 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21504 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21505 &%hosts_override%& is set.
21506
21507 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21508 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21509 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21510 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21511 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21512 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21513 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21514
21515 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21516 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21517 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21518 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21519 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21520 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21521 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21522 address are used.
21523
21524 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21525 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21526
21527
21528 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21529 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21530 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21531 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21532 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21533 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21534 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21535 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21536 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21537 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21538
21539
21540 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21541 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21542 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21543 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21544
21545
21546 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21547 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21548 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21549 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21550
21551
21552 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21553 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21554 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21555 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21556 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21557 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21558 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21559 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21560
21561
21562 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
21563 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21564 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
21565 why it exists.
21566
21567
21568
21569 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21570 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
21571 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21572 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
21573 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21574 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21575 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
21576 explanation of when this might be needed.
21577
21578
21579 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
21580 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
21581 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21582 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
21583 &%fallback_hosts%&.
21584
21585
21586 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
21587 .cindex "randomized host list"
21588 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21589 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
21590 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21591 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21592 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21593 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21594 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21595 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21596
21597 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21598 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21599 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21600 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21601 .code
21602 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21603 .endd
21604 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21605 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21606 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
21607
21608 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21609 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
21610 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21611 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21612 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21613 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21614 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21615 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
21616 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21617
21618
21619 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21620 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
21621 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21622 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21623 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21624 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21625
21626 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21627 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
21628 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21629 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21630 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21631 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
21632 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21633
21634 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
21635 .cindex "bind IP address"
21636 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
21637 .vindex "&$host$&"
21638 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21639 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21640 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
21641 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
21642 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
21643 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
21644 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
21645 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
21646 unknown.
21647
21648 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
21649 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
21650 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
21651 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
21652 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21653 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
21654 .code
21655 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
21656 .endd
21657 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
21658 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
21659 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
21660 interface to use if the host has more than one.
21661
21662
21663 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
21664 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
21665 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
21666 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
21667 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
21668 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
21669 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
21670 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
21671 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
21672 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
21673 unreachable hosts.
21674
21675
21676 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
21677 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21678 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
21679 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
21680 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
21681
21682 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
21683 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
21684 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
21685 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
21686 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
21687 permits this.
21688
21689
21690 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
21691 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21692 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
21693 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
21694 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
21695 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
21696 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
21697 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
21698
21699
21700 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
21701 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
21702 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
21703 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
21704 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
21705 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
21706 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
21707 variable that contains an outgoing port.
21708
21709 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
21710 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
21711 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
21712 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
21713 is deferred.
21714
21715
21716
21717 .option protocol smtp string smtp
21718 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
21719 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
21720 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
21721 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
21722 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
21723 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
21724
21725
21726 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
21727 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
21728 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
21729 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
21730 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
21731 addresses is not affected.
21732
21733 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
21734 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
21735 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
21736 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
21737 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
21738 hosts.
21739
21740
21741 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
21742 .cindex "serializing connections"
21743 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
21744 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
21745 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
21746 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
21747 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
21748 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
21749 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
21750
21751 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
21752 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
21753 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
21754 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
21755 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21756 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21757
21758 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
21759 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21760 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21761 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21762 are used for ETRN serialization.
21763
21764
21765 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
21766 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21767 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
21768 .cindex "size" "of message"
21769 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21770 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21771 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
21772 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
21773 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
21774 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
21775 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
21776 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
21777
21778 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
21779 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
21780
21781
21782 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
21783 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
21784 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
21785 .vindex "&$host$&"
21786 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21787 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21788 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
21789 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
21790 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
21791 details of TLS.
21792
21793 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
21794 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
21795 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
21796 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
21797 client.
21798
21799
21800 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
21801 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
21802 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
21803 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
21804 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
21805
21806
21807 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
21808 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
21809 .vindex "&$host$&"
21810 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21811 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21812 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
21813 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
21814 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21815 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
21816 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
21817 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21818
21819
21820 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
21821 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
21822 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
21823 .vindex "&$host$&"
21824 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21825 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
21826 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
21827 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
21828 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21829 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
21830 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
21831 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
21832 ciphers is a preference order.
21833
21834
21835
21836 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
21837 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
21838 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
21839 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
21840 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
21841 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
21842 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
21843 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
21844 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21845 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21846 in clear.
21847
21848
21849 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
21850 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
21851 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
21852 .vindex "&$host$&"
21853 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21854 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
21855 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
21856 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
21857 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
21858 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
21859 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
21860 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21861 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21862
21863
21864
21865
21866 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
21867 "SECTvalhosmax"
21868 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21869 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
21870 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
21871 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
21872 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
21873
21874
21875 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
21876 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
21877 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
21878 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
21879 retrying.
21880
21881 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
21882 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
21883 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
21884
21885 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
21886 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
21887 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
21888 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
21889 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
21890
21891 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
21892 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
21893 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
21894 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
21895 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
21896 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
21897 see below for an exception).
21898
21899 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
21900 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
21901 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
21902 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
21903 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
21904
21905 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
21906 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
21907 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
21908 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
21909 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
21910 reached their retry times.
21911
21912 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
21913 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
21914 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
21915 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
21916 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
21917 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
21918 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
21919 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
21920 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
21921 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
21922 reached.
21923
21924 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
21925 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
21926 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
21927 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
21928 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
21929 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
21930
21931 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
21932 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
21933 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
21934 possible IP addresses have been tried.
21935 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
21936 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
21937
21938
21939
21940
21941
21942 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21943 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21944
21945 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
21946 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
21947 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
21948 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
21949 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
21950 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
21951
21952 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
21953 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
21954 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
21955 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
21956 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
21957 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
21958 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
21959
21960 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
21961 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
21962 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
21963 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
21964
21965
21966 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
21967 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
21968 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
21969 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
21970
21971 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
21972 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
21973 facility; you do not have to use it.
21974
21975 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
21976 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
21977 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
21978 address to which it applies.
21979
21980 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
21981 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
21982 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
21983 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
21984 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
21985 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
21986 rules.
21987
21988 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
21989 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
21990 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
21991 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
21992
21993
21994 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
21995 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
21996 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
21997 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
21998 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
21999 discouraged.
22000
22001 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22002 illustrated by these examples:
22003
22004 .ilist
22005 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22006 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22007 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22008 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22009 .next
22010 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22011 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22012 .endlist
22013
22014
22015
22016 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22017 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22018 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22019 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22020 message's processing.
22021
22022 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22023 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22024 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22025 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22026 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22027 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22028 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22029 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22030 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22031
22032 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22033 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22034 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22035 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22036 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22037 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22038 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22039 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22040 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22041 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22042
22043 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22044 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22045 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22046 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22047 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22048 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22049
22050 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22051 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22052 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22053
22054 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22055 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22056 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22057 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22058 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22059 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22060 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22061 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22062 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22063
22064 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22065 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22066 transport time.
22067
22068
22069
22070
22071 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22072 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22073 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22074 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22075 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22076 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22077 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22078 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22079 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22080 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22081 .code
22082 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22083 .endd
22084 might produce the output
22085 .code
22086 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22087 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22088 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22089 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22090 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22091 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22092 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22093 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22094 .endd
22095 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22096 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22097 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22098 set for a particular transport.
22099
22100
22101 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22102 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22103 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22104 rules in the form
22105 .display
22106 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22107 .endd
22108 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22109 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22110 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22111 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22112
22113 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22114 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22115 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22116 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22117 ignored.
22118
22119 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22120 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22121 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22122
22123 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22124 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22125 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22126 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22127 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22128 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22129 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22130
22131 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22132 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22133 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22134 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22135 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22136 .code
22137 *@* ${lookup ...
22138 .endd
22139 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22140 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22141
22142
22143 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22144 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22145 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22146 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22147 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22148 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22149 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22150 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22151 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22152
22153 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22154 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22155 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22156
22157 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22158 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22159 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22160 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22161 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22162 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22163 of pattern they are set as follows:
22164
22165 .ilist
22166 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22167 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22168 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22169 pattern
22170 .code
22171 *queen@*.fict.example
22172 .endd
22173 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22174 .code
22175 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22176 $1 = hearts-
22177 $2 = wonderland
22178 .endd
22179 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22180 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22181
22182 .next
22183 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22184 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22185 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22186 rewriting rule of the form
22187 .display
22188 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22189 .endd
22190 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22191 .code
22192 $1 = foo
22193 $2 = bar
22194 $3 = baz.example
22195 .endd
22196 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22197 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22198 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22199 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22200 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22201 .endlist
22202
22203
22204 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22205 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22206 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22207 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22208 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22209 .code
22210 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22211 .endd
22212 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22213 &'From:'& headers.
22214
22215 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22216 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22217 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22218 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22219 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22220 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22221 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22222 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22223 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22224 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22225 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22226 entry written to the panic log.
22227
22228
22229
22230 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22231 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22232
22233 .ilist
22234 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22235 c, f, h, r, s, t.
22236 .next
22237 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22238 .next
22239 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22240 .endlist
22241
22242 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22243 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22244
22245
22246
22247 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22248 "SECID154"
22249 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22250 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22251 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22252 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22253 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22254 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22255 .display
22256 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22257 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22258 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22259 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22260 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22261 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22262 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22263 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22264 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22265 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22266 .endd
22267 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22268 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22269 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22270
22271 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22272 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22273
22274
22275 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22276 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22277 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22278 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22279 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22280 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22281 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22282 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22283 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22284
22285 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22286 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22287 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22288 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22289 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22290 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22291 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22292 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22293
22294
22295 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22296 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22297 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22298 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22299
22300 .ilist
22301 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22302 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22303 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22304 .next
22305 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22306 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22307 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22308 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22309 .next
22310 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22311 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22312 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22313 .next
22314 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22315 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22316 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22317 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22318 .code
22319 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22320 .endd
22321 into
22322 .code
22323 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22324 .endd
22325 .cindex "RFC 2047"
22326 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22327 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22328 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22329 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22330 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22331 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22332 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22333 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22334
22335 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22336 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22337 .endlist
22338
22339
22340 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22341 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22342 .code
22343 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22344 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22345 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22346 .endd
22347 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22348 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22349 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22350 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22351 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22352 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22353 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22354 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22355
22356 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22357 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22358 .code
22359 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22360 .endd
22361 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22362 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22363
22364 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22365 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22366 messages that originate outside the local host:
22367 .code
22368 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22369 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22370 .endd
22371 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22372 space.
22373
22374 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22375 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22376 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22377 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22378 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22379 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22380 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22381 components. For example, the rule
22382 .code
22383 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22384 .endd
22385 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22386 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22387 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22388 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22389 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22390 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22391 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22392 .ecindex IIDaddrew
22393
22394
22395
22396
22397
22398 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22399 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22400
22401 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22402 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22403 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22404 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22405 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22406 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22407 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22408 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22409 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22410 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22411 address, domain and error.
22412
22413 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22414 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22415 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22416 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22417 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22418 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22419 log selector is set, the message
22420 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22421 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22422 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22423 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22424
22425 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22426 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22427 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22428 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22429 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22430 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22431 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22432 domain are maintained independently.
22433
22434 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22435 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22436 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22437 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22438 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22439 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22440 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22441 the local address is reached.
22442
22443 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22444 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22445 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22446 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22447 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22448
22449 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22450 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22451 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22452 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22453 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22454 messages that it should now be retaining.
22455
22456
22457
22458 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22459 .cindex "retry" "rules"
22460 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22461 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22462 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22463 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22464 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22465 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22466 message's sender, respectively.
22467
22468
22469 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22470 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22471 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22472 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22473 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22474 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22475 example,
22476 .code
22477 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22478 .endd
22479 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22480 whereas
22481 .code
22482 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22483 .endd
22484 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22485 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22486 part.
22487
22488 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22489 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22490 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22491 expressions work in address lists.
22492 .display
22493 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22494 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22495 .endd
22496
22497
22498 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22499 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22500 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22501 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22502 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22503 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22504 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22505 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22506 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22507
22508 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22509 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22510 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22511 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22512 local transports).
22513
22514 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22515 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22516 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22517 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22518 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22519 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22520 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22521 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22522 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22523 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22524 commands.
22525
22526
22527
22528 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22529 "SECID160"
22530 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22531 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22532 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22533 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22534 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22535 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22536 .code
22537 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22538 MX 6 p.q.r.example
22539 MX 7 m.n.o.example
22540 .endd
22541 and the retry rules are
22542 .code
22543 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22544 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22545 .endd
22546 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22547 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22548 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
22549 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
22550 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
22551 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
22552
22553 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
22554 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22555 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22556 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
22557
22558 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
22559 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
22560 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
22561 .code
22562 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
22563 .endd
22564 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
22565 textual form of the IP address.
22566
22567 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
22568 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
22569 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22570 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22571
22572 .vlist
22573 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
22574 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
22575 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
22576
22577 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
22578 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
22579 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
22580
22581 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
22582 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
22583
22584 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
22585 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
22586 .endlist
22587
22588 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
22589 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
22590 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
22591 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
22592 retry rule of this form:
22593 .code
22594 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22595 .endd
22596 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
22597 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
22598
22599 .vlist
22600 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
22601 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
22602 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
22603 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
22604
22605 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
22606 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22607
22608 .vitem &%refused_A%&
22609 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22610
22611 .vitem &%refused%&
22612 A connection was refused.
22613
22614 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
22615 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22616
22617 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
22618 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22619
22620 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
22621 A connection attempt timed out.
22622
22623 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
22624 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22625 obtained from an MX record.
22626
22627 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
22628 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22629 obtained from an MX record.
22630
22631 .vitem &%timeout%&
22632 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22633
22634 .vitem &%tls_required%&
22635 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
22636 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
22637 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
22638
22639 .vitem &%quota%&
22640 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22641 transport.
22642
22643 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
22644 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
22645 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
22646 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22647 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
22648 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
22649 for four days.
22650 .endlist
22651
22652 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
22653 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
22654 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
22655 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
22656 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
22657 heuristic rules:
22658
22659 .ilist
22660 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
22661 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
22662 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
22663 .next
22664 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
22665 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
22666 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
22667 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
22668 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
22669 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
22670 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
22671 .next
22672 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
22673 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
22674 .endlist
22675
22676 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
22677 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
22678 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
22679 error).
22680
22681
22682
22683 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
22684 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
22685 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
22686 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
22687 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
22688 form:
22689 .display
22690 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
22691 .endd
22692 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
22693 .code
22694 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
22695 .endd
22696 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
22697 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
22698 For example:
22699 .code
22700 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
22701 .endd
22702 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
22703 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
22704 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
22705 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
22706 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
22707
22708 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
22709 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
22710 .code
22711 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
22712 .endd
22713 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
22714 list is never matched.
22715
22716
22717
22718
22719
22720 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
22721 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
22722 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
22723 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
22724 .display
22725 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
22726 .endd
22727 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
22728 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
22729 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
22730 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
22731 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
22732
22733 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
22734 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
22735 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
22736 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
22737 The available algorithms are:
22738
22739 .ilist
22740 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
22741 the interval.
22742 .next
22743 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
22744 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
22745 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
22746 .next
22747 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
22748 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
22749 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
22750 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
22751 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
22752 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
22753 queue processing times.
22754 .endlist
22755
22756 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
22757 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
22758 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
22759 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
22760 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
22761 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
22762 interval is found. The main configuration variable
22763 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
22764 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
22765 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
22766 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
22767 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
22768
22769 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
22770 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
22771 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
22772 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
22773 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
22774 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
22775 time.
22776
22777 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
22778 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
22779 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
22780 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
22781 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
22782 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
22783 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
22784 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
22785 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
22786 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
22787 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
22788 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
22789
22790 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
22791 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
22792 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
22793 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
22794 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
22795 deliveries that have been deferred.
22796
22797
22798 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
22799 Here are some example retry rules:
22800 .code
22801 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
22802 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
22803 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
22804 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22805 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
22806 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
22807 .endd
22808 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
22809 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
22810 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
22811 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
22812 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
22813 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
22814 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
22815 days.
22816
22817 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
22818 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
22819 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
22820 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
22821 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
22822
22823 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
22824 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
22825 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
22826 were not obtained from an MX record.
22827
22828 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
22829 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
22830 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
22831 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
22832 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
22833
22834
22835
22836 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
22837 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
22838 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
22839 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
22840 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
22841 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
22842 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
22843 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
22844 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
22845 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
22846 failing for the first time.
22847
22848 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
22849 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
22850 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
22851 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
22852
22853 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
22854 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
22855 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
22856
22857
22858
22859
22860 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
22861 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
22862 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
22863 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
22864 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
22865 default retry rule:
22866 .code
22867 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
22868 .endd
22869 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
22870 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
22871 failure for the recipient address that counts.
22872
22873 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
22874 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
22875 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
22876 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
22877 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
22878
22879 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
22880 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
22881 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
22882
22883 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
22884 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
22885 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
22886 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
22887 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
22888 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
22889 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
22890 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
22891
22892 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
22893 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
22894 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
22895 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
22896 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
22897 notice.
22898
22899 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22900 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
22901 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22902 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
22903 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
22904 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
22905 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
22906 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
22907 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
22908 true.
22909
22910 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
22911 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
22912 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
22913 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
22914 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
22915 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
22916 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
22917 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
22918 reached.
22919
22920 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
22921 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
22922 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
22923 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
22924 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
22925 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
22926 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
22927 time out the address.
22928
22929 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
22930 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
22931 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
22932 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
22933 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
22934 considered immediately.
22935 .ecindex IIDretconf1
22936 .ecindex IIDregconf2
22937
22938
22939
22940
22941
22942
22943 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22944 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22945
22946 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
22947 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
22948 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
22949 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
22950 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
22951 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
22952 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
22953 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
22954 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
22955 other.
22956
22957 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
22958 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
22959
22960 .ilist
22961 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
22962 the client's EHLO command.
22963 .next
22964 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
22965 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
22966 .next
22967 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
22968 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
22969 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
22970 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
22971 with the AUTH command.
22972 .next
22973 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
22974 .next
22975 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
22976 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
22977 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
22978 connection.
22979 .next
22980 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
22981 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
22982 unauthenticated connection.
22983 .endlist
22984
22985 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
22986 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
22987 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
22988 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
22989 .display
22990 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
22991 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
22992 &`Connected to server.example.`&
22993 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
22994 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
22995 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
22996 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
22997 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
22998 &`250-PIPELINING`&
22999 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
23000 &`250 HELP`&
23001 .endd
23002 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23003 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23004 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23005 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23006 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23007 included by setting
23008 .code
23009 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
23010 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23011 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
23012 AUTH_SPA=yes
23013 .endd
23014 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23015 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23016 the Cyrus SASL authentication library. The third can be configured to support
23017 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23018 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The fourth authenticator
23019 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23020
23021 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23022 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23023 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23024 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23025 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23026 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23027 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23028
23029 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23030 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23031 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23032 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23033 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23034 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23035 .code
23036 cram:
23037 driver = cram_md5
23038 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23039 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23040 client_name = ph10
23041 client_secret = secret2
23042 .endd
23043 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23044 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23045
23046 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23047 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23048 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23049 in Exim.
23050
23051
23052
23053 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23054 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23055 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23056
23057 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23058 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23059 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23060 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23061 encrypted by a setting such as:
23062 .code
23063 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23064 .endd
23065 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23066 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23067 cipher used for the delivery.)
23068
23069
23070 .option driver authenticators string unset
23071 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23072 authenticators is to be used.
23073
23074
23075 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23076 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23077 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23078 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23079 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23080 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23081
23082
23083 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23084 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23085 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23086 mechanism is not advertised.
23087 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23088 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23089 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23090
23091
23092 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23093 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23094 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23095 for details.
23096
23097 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23098 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23099 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23100 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23101 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23102 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23103 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23104 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23105 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23106 the error text.
23107
23108
23109 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23110 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23111 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23112 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23113 out the values of variables.
23114 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23115 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23116
23117
23118 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23119 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23120 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23121 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23122 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23123 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23124 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23125 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23126 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23127
23128
23129 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23130 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23131 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23132 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23133 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23134 remembered for later use.
23135 How it is used is described in the following section.
23136
23137
23138
23139
23140
23141 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23142 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23143 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23144 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23145 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23146 message:
23147
23148 .ilist
23149 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23150 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23151 .next
23152 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23153 .next
23154 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23155 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23156 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23157 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23158 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23159 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23160 given for the MAIL command.
23161 .next
23162 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23163 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23164 authenticated.
23165 .next
23166 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23167 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23168 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23169 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23170 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23171 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23172 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23173 message.
23174 .endlist
23175
23176
23177 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23178 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23179 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23180 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23181
23182 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23183 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23184 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23185 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23186 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23187 ACL is run.
23188
23189
23190
23191 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23192 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23193 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23194 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23195 conditions:
23196
23197 .ilist
23198 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23199 .next
23200 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23201 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23202 .endlist
23203
23204 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23205 the mechanisms are advertised.
23206
23207 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23208 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23209 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23210 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23211 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23212 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23213 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23214 .code
23215 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23216 .endd
23217 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23218
23219 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23220 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23221 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23222 such as:
23223 .code
23224 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23225 .endd
23226 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23227 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23228 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23229
23230 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23231 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23232 command. This is the case if
23233
23234 .ilist
23235 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23236 .next
23237 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23238 .next
23239 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23240 server authenticators.
23241 .endlist
23242
23243
23244 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23245 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23246 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23247
23248 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23249 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23250 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23251 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23252 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23253 rejected with a 504 error.
23254
23255 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23256 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23257 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23258 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23259 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23260 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23261 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23262 no successful authentication.
23263
23264
23265
23266
23267 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23268 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23269 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23270 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23271 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23272 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23273 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23274 script:
23275 .code
23276 use MIME::Base64;
23277 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23278 .endd
23279 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23280 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23281 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23282 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23283 command line to run this script on such data might be
23284 .code
23285 encode '\0user\0password'
23286 .endd
23287 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23288 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23289 whose code value is zero.
23290
23291 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23292 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23293 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23294 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23295
23296 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23297 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23298 example, a command such as
23299 .code
23300 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23301 .endd
23302 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23303
23304 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23305 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23306 .code
23307 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23308 .endd
23309 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23310 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23311 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23312 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23313
23314
23315
23316 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23317 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23318 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23319 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23320 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23321 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23322
23323 .ilist
23324 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23325 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23326 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23327 of the authenticator.
23328 .next
23329 .vindex "&$host$&"
23330 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23331 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23332 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23333 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23334 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23335 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23336 delivery to be deferred.
23337 .next
23338 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23339 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23340 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23341 usual way.
23342 .next
23343 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23344 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23345 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23346 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23347 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23348 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23349 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23350 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23351 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23352 .endlist
23353
23354 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23355 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23356 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23357 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23358 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23359 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23360 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23361 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23362 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23363 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23364 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23365 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23366 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23367
23368
23369
23370
23371
23372
23373 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23374 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23375
23376 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23377 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23378 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23379 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23380 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23381 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23382 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23383 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23384 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23385 connections as you do for login accounts.
23386
23387 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23388 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23389 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23390
23391 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23392 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23393 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23394
23395 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23396 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23397 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23398 given.
23399
23400 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23401 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23402 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23403 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23404 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23405 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23406 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23407
23408 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23409 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23410 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23411 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23412 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23413 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23414 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23415
23416 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23417 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23418 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23419 string expansions that also use them for other things.
23420
23421 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23422 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23423 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23424
23425 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23426 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23427 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23428 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23429 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23430 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23431 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23432 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23433 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23434 string as the error text.
23435
23436 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23437 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23438 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23439
23440
23441
23442 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23443 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23444 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23445 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23446 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23447 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23448 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23449 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23450
23451 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23452 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23453 configured as follows:
23454 .code
23455 fixed_plain:
23456 driver = plaintext
23457 public_name = PLAIN
23458 server_prompts = :
23459 server_condition = \
23460 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23461 server_set_id = $auth2
23462 .endd
23463 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23464 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23465 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23466 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23467
23468 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23469 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23470 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23471 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23472 .code
23473 250-AUTH PLAIN
23474 .endd
23475 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23476 .code
23477 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23478 .endd
23479 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23480 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23481 .code
23482 AUTH PLAIN
23483 .endd
23484 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23485 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23486
23487 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23488 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23489 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23490 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23491 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23492
23493 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23494 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23495 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23496
23497 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23498 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23499 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23500 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23501 This is an incorrect example:
23502 .code
23503 server_condition = \
23504 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
23505 .endd
23506 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
23507 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
23508 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23509 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23510 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23511 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23512 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23513 .code
23514 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23515 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
23516 .endd
23517 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23518 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
23519 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
23520 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
23521 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
23522
23523
23524 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
23525 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
23526 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
23527 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23528 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23529 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23530 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23531 .code
23532 fixed_login:
23533 driver = plaintext
23534 public_name = LOGIN
23535 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23536 server_condition = \
23537 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
23538 server_set_id = $auth1
23539 .endd
23540 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23541 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23542 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23543 strings are used to obtain two data items.
23544
23545 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23546 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
23547 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
23548 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
23549 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23550 .code
23551 login:
23552 driver = plaintext
23553 public_name = LOGIN
23554 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23555 server_condition = ${if and{{
23556 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
23557 ldapauth{user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23558 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
23559 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
23560 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
23561 .endd
23562 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
23563 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
23564 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
23565 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
23566 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
23567 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
23568 uninterpreted string.
23569
23570
23571
23572 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
23573 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23574 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23575 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
23576 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
23577 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
23578
23579
23580
23581
23582 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
23583 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
23584 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
23585
23586 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
23587 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
23588 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
23589 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
23590 usual.
23591
23592 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
23593 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23594 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23595 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23596 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
23597 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
23598 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
23599 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
23600 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
23601 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
23602 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
23603 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
23604
23605 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23606 splitting takes priority and happens first.
23607
23608 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23609 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23610 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23611 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23612 the string.
23613
23614 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23615 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23616 .code
23617 fixed_plain:
23618 driver = plaintext
23619 public_name = PLAIN
23620 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23621 .endd
23622 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23623 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23624 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23625 .code
23626 fixed_login:
23627 driver = plaintext
23628 public_name = LOGIN
23629 client_send = : username : mysecret
23630 .endd
23631 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23632 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23633 prompts.
23634 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
23635 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
23636
23637
23638
23639
23640 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23641 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23642
23643 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
23644 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23645 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
23646 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
23647 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
23648 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
23649 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
23650 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
23651 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
23652 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
23653 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
23654 available in plain text at either end.
23655
23656
23657 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
23658 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
23659 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
23660 authenticator as a server:
23661
23662 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23663 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23664 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
23665 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
23666 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
23667 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
23668 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
23669 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
23670 returned to the client.
23671
23672 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
23673 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
23674 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
23675 numeric variables for other things.
23676
23677 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
23678 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
23679 user name, authentication fails.
23680 .code
23681 fixed_cram:
23682 driver = cram_md5
23683 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23684 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
23685 server_set_id = $auth1
23686 .endd
23687 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23688 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
23689 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
23690 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
23691 .code
23692 lookup_cram:
23693 driver = cram_md5
23694 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23695 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
23696 {$value}fail}
23697 server_set_id = $auth1
23698 .endd
23699 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
23700 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
23701
23702
23703 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
23704 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
23705 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
23706
23707
23708
23709 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
23710 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
23711 computing the response to the server's challenge.
23712
23713
23714 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23715 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
23716 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
23717
23718
23719 .vindex "&$host$&"
23720 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23721 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
23722 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
23723 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
23724 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
23725 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
23726 send the message to the current server.
23727
23728 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
23729 strings, is:
23730 .code
23731 fixed_cram:
23732 driver = cram_md5
23733 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23734 client_name = ph10
23735 client_secret = secret
23736 .endd
23737 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
23738 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
23739
23740
23741
23742 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23744
23745 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
23746 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
23747 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
23748 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
23749 .cindex "Kerberos"
23750 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
23751 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
23752
23753 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
23754 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
23755 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
23756 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
23757 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
23758
23759 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
23760 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
23761 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
23762 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
23763
23764 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
23765 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
23766 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
23767 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
23768 depending on the driver you are using.
23769
23770 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
23771 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
23772 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
23773 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
23774 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
23775 implementation. For example, for Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
23776 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
23777 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
23778 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
23779
23780
23781 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
23782 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
23783 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
23784 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
23785 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
23786 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
23787 things.
23788
23789
23790 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
23791 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
23792 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
23793 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
23794
23795
23796 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
23797 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
23798 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
23799 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
23800 example:
23801 .code
23802 sasl:
23803 driver = cyrus_sasl
23804 public_name = X-ANYTHING
23805 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
23806 server_set_id = $auth1
23807 .endd
23808
23809 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string unset
23810 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
23811
23812
23813 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
23814 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
23815
23816
23817 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
23818 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
23819 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
23820 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
23821 .code
23822 sasl_cram_md5:
23823 driver = cyrus_sasl
23824 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23825 server_set_id = $auth1
23826
23827 sasl_plain:
23828 driver = cyrus_sasl
23829 public_name = PLAIN
23830 server_set_id = $auth2
23831 .endd
23832 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
23833 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
23834 but it is present in many binary distributions.
23835 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
23836 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
23837
23838
23839
23840
23841 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23842 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23843 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
23844 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
23845 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
23846 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
23847 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
23848 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
23849 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
23850 authenticator only. There is only one option:
23851
23852 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
23853
23854 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
23855 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
23856 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
23857 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
23858 .code
23859 dovecot_plain:
23860 driver = dovecot
23861 public_name = PLAIN
23862 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23863 server_set_id = $auth2
23864
23865 dovecot_ntlm:
23866 driver = dovecot
23867 public_name = NTLM
23868 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23869 server_set_id = $auth1
23870 .endd
23871 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
23872 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
23873 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
23874 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
23875 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
23876 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
23877 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
23878 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
23879
23880
23881 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23882 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23883
23884 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
23885 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
23886 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
23887 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
23888 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
23889 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
23890 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
23891 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
23892 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
23893 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
23894 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
23895 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
23896 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
23897 follows:
23898
23899 .ilist
23900 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
23901 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
23902 .next
23903 The server sends back a challenge.
23904 .next
23905 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
23906 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
23907 .endlist
23908
23909 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
23910
23911
23912
23913 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
23914 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
23915 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
23916
23917 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
23918 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
23919 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
23920 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
23921 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
23922 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
23923 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
23924 for other things. For example:
23925 .code
23926 spa:
23927 driver = spa
23928 public_name = NTLM
23929 server_password = \
23930 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
23931 .endd
23932 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
23933 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
23934
23935
23936
23937
23938
23939 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
23940 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
23941 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
23942
23943
23944
23945 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
23946 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
23947
23948
23949 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
23950 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
23951
23952
23953 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
23954 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
23955 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
23956 &'msn.com'&:
23957 .code
23958 msn:
23959 driver = spa
23960 public_name = MSN
23961 client_username = msn/msn_username
23962 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
23963 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
23964 .endd
23965 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
23966 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
23967
23968
23969
23970
23971
23972 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23973 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23974
23975 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
23976 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
23977 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
23978 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
23979 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
23980 .cindex "OpenSSL"
23981 .cindex "GnuTLS"
23982 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
23983 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
23984 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
23985 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
23986 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
23987 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
23988 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
23989 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
23990 certificates are used.
23991
23992 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
23993 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
23994 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
23995 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
23996 between them is encrypted.
23997
23998 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
23999 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24000 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24001 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24002 encryption state.
24003
24004 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24005 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24006 in order to get TLS to work.
24007
24008
24009
24010 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24011 "SECID284"
24012 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24013 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24014 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24015 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24016 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24017 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24018 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24019 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24020 allocated for this purpose.
24021
24022 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24023 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24024 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24025 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24026 .code
24027 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24028 .endd
24029 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24030 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24031 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24032 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24033 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24034 defined elsewhere.
24035
24036 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24037 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24038
24039
24040
24041
24042
24043
24044 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24045 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24046 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24047 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24048 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24049 .code
24050 USE_GNUTLS=yes
24051 .endd
24052 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24053 .code
24054 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
24055 .endd
24056 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24057 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24058
24059 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24060
24061 .ilist
24062 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24063 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24064 .next
24065 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24066 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24067 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24068 .next
24069 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24070 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24071 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24072 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24073 .next
24074 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24075 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24076 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24077 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24078 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24079 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24080 option).
24081 .next
24082 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24083 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24084 .endlist
24085
24086
24087 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24088 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24089 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24090 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24091 &_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24092 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
24093 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24094 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24095 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24096 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24097 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24098
24099 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24100 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24101 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24102 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24103 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24104 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24105 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24106 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24107
24108 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24109 in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24110 externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24111
24112 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24113 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24114 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24115 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24116 .code
24117 # rm -f new-params
24118 # touch new-params
24119 # chown exim:exim new-params
24120 # chmod 0400 new-params
24121 # certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24122 # echo "" >>new-params
24123 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24124 # mv new-params gnutls-params
24125 .endd
24126 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24127 stalling is removed.
24128
24129
24130 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24131 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24132 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24133 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24134 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24135 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24136 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24137 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24138 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24139
24140 .ilist
24141 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24142 .next
24143 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24144 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24145 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24146 SSL v3 algorithms.
24147 .next
24148 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24149 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24150 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24151 algorithms.
24152 .endlist
24153
24154 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24155 &`-`& or &`+`&.
24156 .ilist
24157 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24158 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24159 stated.
24160 .next
24161 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24162 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24163 .next
24164 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24165 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24166 .endlist
24167
24168 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24169 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24170 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24171 not be moved to the end of the list.
24172 .endlist
24173
24174
24175
24176 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24177 "SECTreqciphgnu"
24178 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24179 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24180 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24181 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24182 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24183 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24184 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24185 exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24186 Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24187 function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24188 names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24189 methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24190 cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24191 passed to its control function.
24192
24193 For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24194 to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24195 option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24196 list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24197 contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24198 the same as if just AES were given.
24199
24200 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24201 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24202 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24203 There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24204 &%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24205 restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24206 These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24207
24208 All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24209 behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24210 how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24211 expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24212 can be changed in the usual way.
24213
24214 Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24215 first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24216 default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24217 specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24218 exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24219
24220 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24221 entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24222 exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24223 items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24224 .code
24225 tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24226 .endd
24227 allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24228 .code
24229 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24230 .endd
24231 allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24232
24233 For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24234 (both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24235 the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24236 AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24237
24238 For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24239 includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24240 DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24241
24242 For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24243 MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24244
24245 For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1 and SSL3.
24246 The default list contains TLS1, SSL3.
24247
24248 In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24249 advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24250 client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24251 order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24252 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24253 above.
24254
24255
24256
24257 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24258 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24259 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24260 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24261 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24262 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24263 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24264 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24265
24266 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24267 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24268 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24269 with the error
24270 .code
24271 554 Security failure
24272 .endd
24273 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24274 rejected with a 554 error code.
24275
24276 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
24277 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
24278 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24279 without some further configuration at the server end.
24280
24281 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24282 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24283 .code
24284 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24285 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24286 .endd
24287 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
24288 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
24289 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
24290 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
24291 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
24292 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
24293 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
24294 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
24295 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
24296 the server's certificate.
24297
24298 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24299 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24300 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
24301
24302 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
24303 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
24304 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
24305 transport.
24306
24307 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
24308 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
24309 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
24310 .code
24311 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24312 .endd
24313 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24314 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24315 suites that the server supports. See the command
24316 .code
24317 openssl dhparam
24318 .endd
24319 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
24320 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24321
24322 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24323 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24324 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24325 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24326 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24327
24328 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24329 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24330 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24331 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24332 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
24333 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24334 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
24335 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
24336 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
24337 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
24338 &<<SECID185>>&.)
24339
24340 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
24341 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
24342 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
24343 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
24344 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
24345 documentation for more details.
24346
24347
24348 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
24349 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
24350 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
24351 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24352 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
24353 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
24354 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24355 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24356 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24357 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24358 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24359 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
24360
24361 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24362 directory is used
24363 (OpenSSL only),
24364 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24365 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
24366 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24367 .code
24368 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24369 .endd
24370 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
24371
24372 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
24373 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24374 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24375 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
24376 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24377 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
24378 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24379 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24380 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24381 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24382
24383 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24384 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24385 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24386 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
24387
24388 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24389 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24390 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24391 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
24392 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
24393 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
24394
24395
24396 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
24397 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
24398 .cindex "revocation list"
24399 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
24400 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24401 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24402 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
24403 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
24404 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
24405 CRL in PEM format.
24406
24407
24408 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
24409 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24410 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24411 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24412 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
24413 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24414 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24415 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24416 within the &(smtp)& transport.
24417
24418 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
24419 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24420 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24421 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
24422 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24423
24424 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24425 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24426 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24427 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24428 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24429 usual way.
24430
24431 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
24432 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24433 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24434 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24435 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
24436 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24437 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
24438 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24439 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24440 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24441 unencrypted.
24442
24443 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
24444 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
24445 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24446 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client. &*Note*&:
24447 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
24448 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
24449 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
24450 client.
24451
24452 If &%tls_verify_certificates%& is set, it must name a file or,
24453 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24454 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24455 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24456 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
24457
24458 If
24459 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
24460 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24461 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
24462 alternative hosts, if any.
24463
24464 .vindex "&$host$&"
24465 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24466 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
24467 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
24468 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24469 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24470
24471 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24472 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24473 Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
24474 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
24475 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
24476 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
24477 outgoing connection.
24478
24479
24480
24481 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
24482 "SECTmulmessam"
24483 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
24484 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24485 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24486 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24487 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24488 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24489 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24490 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24491 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24492 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24493 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24494
24495 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24496 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24497 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24498 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24499 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24500 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24501 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24502 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24503 and delay other deliveries to that host.
24504
24505 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24506 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24507 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24508 information is recorded.
24509
24510 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
24511 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24512 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24513
24514
24515
24516
24517 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
24518 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
24519 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24520 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24521 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24522 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24523 to Apache, currently at
24524 .display
24525 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
24526 .endd
24527 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
24528 links to further files.
24529 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
24530 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24531 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24532 .display
24533 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
24534 .endd
24535
24536
24537 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
24538 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
24539 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24540 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24541 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24542 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24543 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24544 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24545 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24546 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24547 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24548 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24549 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24550
24551
24552 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
24553 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
24554 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
24555 with OpenSSL, like this:
24556 .code
24557 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24558 -days 9999 -nodes
24559 .endd
24560 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24561 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
24562 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
24563 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24564 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24565 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24566 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24567
24568 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24569 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24570 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24571
24572 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24573 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
24574 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24575 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
24576 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24577 signed with that self-signed certificate.
24578
24579 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24580 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
24581 Open-source PKI book, available online at
24582 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
24583 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
24584 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
24585
24586
24587
24588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24589 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24590
24591 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
24592 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
24593 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
24594 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
24595 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
24596 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24597 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
24598 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24599 one very small ACL:
24600 .code
24601 begin acl
24602 small_acl:
24603 accept hosts = one.host.only
24604 .endd
24605 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24606 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24607
24608 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24609 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24610 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
24611 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24612 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24613 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24614 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24615 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
24616
24617
24618 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
24619 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
24620 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24621 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
24622 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
24623
24624
24625
24626 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
24627 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
24628 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24629 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24630 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
24631 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24632 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
24633 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
24634 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24635 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24636 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
24637 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24638 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
24639 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
24640 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
24641 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24642 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24643 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
24644
24645 .table2 140pt
24646 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
24647 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
24648 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
24649 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
24650 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
24651 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
24652 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
24653 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
24654 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
24655 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
24656 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
24657 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
24658 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
24659 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
24660 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
24661 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
24662 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
24663 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
24664 .endtable
24665
24666 For example, if you set
24667 .code
24668 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
24669 .endd
24670 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
24671 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
24672 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
24673 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
24674 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
24675 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
24676 testing as possible at RCPT time.
24677
24678
24679 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
24680 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24681 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
24682 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
24683 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
24684 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
24685 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
24686 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
24687 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
24688 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
24689 in any of these ACLs.
24690
24691 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
24692 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
24693 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
24694 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
24695 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
24696 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
24697 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
24698 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
24699 .code
24700 control = suppress_local_fixups
24701 .endd
24702 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
24703 run, it is too late.
24704
24705 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24706 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24707
24708 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
24709 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
24710 temporary error for these kinds of message.
24711
24712
24713 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
24714 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24715 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
24716 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
24717 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
24718 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
24719 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
24720 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
24721 &%smtp_banner%& option.
24722
24723
24724 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
24725 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24726 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24727 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
24728 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
24729 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
24730 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
24731 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
24732 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
24733
24734 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
24735 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
24736 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
24737 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
24738 an EHLO response.
24739
24740
24741 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
24742 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24743 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
24744 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
24745 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
24746 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
24747 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
24748 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
24749 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
24750 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
24751
24752 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
24753 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
24754 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
24755 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
24756 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
24757 associated with the DATA command.
24758
24759 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
24760 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
24761 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
24762 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
24763 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
24764 your resources.
24765
24766
24767 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
24768 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24769 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24770
24771
24772 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
24773 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24774 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
24775 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
24776 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
24777 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
24778
24779 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
24780 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
24781 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
24782 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
24783
24784 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
24785 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
24786
24787 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
24788 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
24789 response to QUIT.
24790
24791 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
24792 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
24793 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
24794 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
24795 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
24796
24797
24798
24799 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
24800 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
24801 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
24802 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
24803 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
24804 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
24805 situation even worse.
24806
24807 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
24808 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
24809 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
24810 and &%warn%&.
24811
24812 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
24813 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
24814 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
24815 connection. The possible values are:
24816 .table2
24817 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
24818 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
24819 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
24820 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
24821 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
24822 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
24823 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
24824 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
24825 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
24826 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
24827 .endtable
24828 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
24829 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
24830 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
24831 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
24832 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
24833 used.
24834
24835
24836 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
24837 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
24838 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
24839 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
24840 .code
24841 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
24842 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
24843 .endd
24844 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
24845 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
24846 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
24847 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
24848 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
24849
24850 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
24851 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
24852 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
24853
24854 .ilist
24855 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
24856 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
24857 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
24858 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
24859 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
24860 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
24861 .code
24862 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
24863 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
24864 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
24865 .endd
24866 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
24867 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
24868 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
24869 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
24870 .next
24871 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
24872 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
24873 matches the string.
24874 .next
24875 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
24876 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
24877 want to have something like
24878 .code
24879 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
24880 .endd
24881 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
24882 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
24883 .endlist
24884
24885
24886
24887
24888 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
24889 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
24890 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
24891 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
24892 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
24893 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
24894 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
24895 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
24896 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
24897
24898 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
24899 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
24900 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
24901
24902
24903 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
24904 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
24905 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
24906 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
24907
24908 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
24909 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
24910 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
24911 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
24912 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
24913 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
24914 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
24915
24916
24917 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
24918 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
24919 recipients; it may create new recipients.
24920
24921
24922
24923 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
24924 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
24925 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
24926 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
24927 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
24928 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
24929
24930 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
24931 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
24932 used to accept or reject anything.
24933
24934 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
24935 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
24936 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
24937 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
24938
24939 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
24940 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
24941 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
24942 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
24943 configuration file.
24944
24945
24946
24947
24948 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
24949 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
24950 .vindex &$domain$&
24951 .vindex &$local_part$&
24952 .vindex &$sender_address$&
24953 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
24954 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
24955 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
24956 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
24957 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
24958 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
24959 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
24960 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
24961
24962 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
24963 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
24964 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
24965 how it is used.
24966
24967 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24968 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
24969 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
24970 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
24971 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
24972 received).
24973
24974 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
24975 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
24976 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
24977 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
24978 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
24979 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
24980 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
24981 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
24982
24983
24984
24985
24986
24987 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
24988 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
24989 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
24990 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
24991 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
24992 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
24993 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
24994 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
24995 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
24996 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
24997 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
24998 unencrypted connections.
24999 .code
25000 acl_check_auth:
25001 accept encrypted = *
25002 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25003 {CRAM-MD5}}
25004 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25005 .endd
25006 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25007 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25008 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25009 option to do this.)
25010
25011
25012
25013 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25014 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25015 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25016 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25017 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25018 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25019 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25020
25021 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25022 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25023 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25024 example:
25025 .code
25026 deny dnslists = list1.example
25027 dnslists = list2.example
25028 .endd
25029 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25030 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25031 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25032 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25033 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25034
25035
25036 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25037 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25038
25039 .ilist
25040 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25041 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25042 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25043 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25044 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25045 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25046 check a RCPT command:
25047 .code
25048 accept domains = +local_domains
25049 endpass
25050 verify = recipient
25051 .endd
25052 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25053 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25054 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25055 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25056 &%endpass%&.
25057
25058 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25059 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25060 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25061 configuration.
25062
25063 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25064 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25065 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25066 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25067 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25068 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25069 .display
25070 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25071 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25072 .endd
25073 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25074 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25075 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25076
25077 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25078 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25079 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25080 of &%endpass%&.
25081
25082
25083 .next
25084 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25085 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25086 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25087 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25088 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25089 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25090 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25091
25092
25093 .next
25094 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25095 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25096 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25097 example,
25098 .code
25099 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25100 .endd
25101 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25102
25103
25104 .next
25105 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25106 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25107 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25108 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25109 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25110 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25111 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25112 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25113 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
25114
25115 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25116 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25117 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25118
25119
25120 .next
25121 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25122 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25123 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25124 .code
25125 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25126 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25127 .endd
25128 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25129 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25130
25131 .next
25132 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25133 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25134 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25135 example, when checking a RCPT command,
25136 .code
25137 require message = Sender did not verify
25138 verify = sender
25139 .endd
25140 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25141 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25142 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25143 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25144
25145 .next
25146 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25147 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25148 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25149 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25150 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25151 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25152 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25153
25154 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25155 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25156 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25157 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25158 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25159
25160 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25161 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25162 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25163 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25164 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25165 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25166 onwards.
25167
25168
25169 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25170 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25171 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25172 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25173 .code
25174 warn !verify = sender
25175 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25176 .endd
25177 .endlist
25178
25179 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25180
25181 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25182 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25183 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25184 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25185 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25186
25187
25188
25189 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25190 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25191 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25192 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25193 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25194 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25195 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25196 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25197 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25198 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25199 .ilist
25200 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25201 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25202 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25203 on the same SMTP connection.
25204 .next
25205 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25206 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25207 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25208 .endlist
25209
25210 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25211 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25212 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25213 .code
25214 accept hosts = whatever
25215 set acl_m4 = some value
25216 accept authenticated = *
25217 set acl_c_auth = yes
25218 .endd
25219 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25220 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25221 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25222
25223 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25224 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25225 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25226 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25227 error is generated.
25228
25229 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25230 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25231
25232
25233 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25234 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25235 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25236 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25237 .code
25238 deny domains = *.dom.example
25239 !verify = recipient
25240 .endd
25241 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25242 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25243 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25244 two statements are equivalent:
25245 .code
25246 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25247 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25248 .endd
25249 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25250 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25251
25252 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25253 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25254 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25255 .code
25256 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25257 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25258 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25259 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25260 .endd
25261 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25262 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25263 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
25264 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
25265 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25266 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25267 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
25268
25269 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25270 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25271 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25272 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
25273 message is handled.
25274
25275 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25276 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25277 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25278 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
25279 .code
25280 require message = Can't verify sender
25281 verify = sender
25282 message = Can't verify recipient
25283 verify = recipient
25284 message = This message cannot be used
25285 .endd
25286 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25287 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
25288 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25289 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25290 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
25291 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25292
25293 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
25294 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25295 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
25296 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25297 .code
25298 deny hosts = ...
25299 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25300 message = Invalid sender from client host
25301 .endd
25302 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25303 by which time Exim has set up the message.
25304
25305
25306
25307 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
25308 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
25309 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25310
25311 .vlist
25312 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25313 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
25314 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
25315 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25316
25317 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25318 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
25319 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
25320 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
25321 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
25322 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
25323 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
25324 write rather ugly lines like this:
25325 .display
25326 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
25327 .endd
25328 Instead, all you need is
25329 .display
25330 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
25331 .endd
25332
25333 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25334 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25335 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25336 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25337 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25338 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25339 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25340 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25341
25342 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25343 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
25344 in several different ways. For example:
25345
25346 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
25347 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
25348 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
25349 . ==== way.
25350
25351 .ilist
25352 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
25353 .code
25354 accept ...some conditions
25355 control = queue_only
25356 .endd
25357 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
25358 other words, when the conditions are all true.
25359
25360 .next
25361 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
25362 .code
25363 accept ...some conditions...
25364 control = queue_only
25365 ...some more conditions...
25366 .endd
25367 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25368 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25369 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
25370 to be relevant.
25371
25372 .next
25373 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
25374 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25375 example:
25376 .code
25377 warn ...some conditions...
25378 control = freeze
25379 accept ...
25380 .endd
25381 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
25382 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
25383 log entry.
25384
25385 .next
25386 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25387 &%require%& verb. For example:
25388 .code
25389 require control = no_multiline_responses
25390 .endd
25391 .endlist
25392
25393 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
25394 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
25395 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
25396 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
25397 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
25398 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
25399 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
25400 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
25401 flushed before the delay is imposed.
25402
25403 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
25404 example:
25405 .code
25406 deny ...some conditions...
25407 delay = 30s
25408 .endd
25409 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25410 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
25411 .code
25412 deny delay = 30s
25413 ...some conditions...
25414 .endd
25415 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
25416 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
25417 .code
25418 warn ...some conditions...
25419 delay = 2m
25420 control = freeze
25421 accept ...
25422 .endd
25423
25424 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
25425 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
25426 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
25427 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
25428 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
25429 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
25430 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
25431
25432
25433 .vitem &*endpass*&
25434 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
25435 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
25436 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
25437 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
25438 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
25439 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
25440 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
25441
25442
25443 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25444 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
25445 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25446 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
25447 .code
25448 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25449 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25450 .endd
25451 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
25452 example:
25453 .display
25454 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
25455 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
25456 .endd
25457 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
25458 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
25459 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
25460 message.
25461
25462 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
25463 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
25464 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
25465 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
25466 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
25467 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
25468 ignored.
25469
25470 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25471 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
25472 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
25473 error message.
25474
25475 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
25476 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
25477 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
25478 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
25479 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
25480 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
25481
25482 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25483 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
25484 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25485 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25486 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
25487 logging rejections.
25488
25489
25490 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
25491 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
25492 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
25493 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
25494 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
25495 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
25496 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
25497 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
25498 .display
25499 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
25500 &` log_reject_target =`&
25501 .endd
25502 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
25503 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
25504 current ACL.
25505
25506
25507 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25508 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
25509 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
25510 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25511 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
25512 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
25513 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
25514 ACLs. For example:
25515 .display
25516 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
25517 &` control = freeze`&
25518 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
25519 .endd
25520 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25521 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25522 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25523 example:
25524 .code
25525 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25526 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25527 .endd
25528
25529
25530 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25531 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25532 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
25533 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
25534 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
25535 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
25536 &%accept%& for details.)
25537
25538 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
25539 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
25540 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
25541 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
25542 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
25543 .code
25544 require message = Host not recognized
25545 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
25546 .endd
25547 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
25548 processed.)
25549
25550 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
25551 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
25552 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
25553 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
25554 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
25555 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
25556 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
25557 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
25558 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
25559 EHLO options.
25560
25561 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
25562 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
25563 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
25564 .code
25565 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
25566 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
25567 .endd
25568 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
25569 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
25570 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
25571 2&'xx'&.
25572
25573 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
25574 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
25575
25576 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
25577 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
25578 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
25579 response.
25580
25581 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25582 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25583 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25584 However, the original message is available in the variable
25585 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25586 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
25587 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25588 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
25589
25590 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
25591 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
25592 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
25593 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
25594 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
25595 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25596 effect.
25597
25598
25599 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
25600 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
25601 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25602 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
25603 .endlist
25604
25605
25606
25607
25608
25609 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
25610 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25611 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
25612
25613 .vlist
25614 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
25615 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
25616 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
25617 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
25618 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
25619 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
25620 not work without it. For example:
25621 .code
25622 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
25623 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
25624 .endd
25625 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
25626 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
25627 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
25628 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
25629 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
25630
25631
25632 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
25633 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
25634 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
25635 .cindex "case of local parts"
25636 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25637 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
25638 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
25639 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
25640 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
25641 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
25642 is encountered.
25643
25644 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
25645 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
25646 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
25647 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
25648 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
25649
25650 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
25651 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
25652 spam score:
25653 .code
25654 warn control = caseful_local_part
25655 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
25656 $acl_m4 + \
25657 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
25658 }
25659 control = caselower_local_part
25660 .endd
25661 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
25662 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
25663
25664 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
25665 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
25666 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
25667 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
25668 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
25669 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
25670 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
25671 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
25672
25673 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25674 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
25675 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
25676 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
25677 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
25678 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
25679 work with.
25680
25681
25682 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
25683 .cindex "fake defer"
25684 .cindex "defer, fake"
25685 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
25686 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
25687 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
25688 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
25689 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
25690
25691 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
25692 .cindex "fake rejection"
25693 .cindex "rejection, fake"
25694 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
25695 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
25696 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
25697 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
25698 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25699 the same SMTP connection.
25700
25701 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
25702 message is supplied, the following is used:
25703 .code
25704 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
25705 550-kept for evaluation.
25706 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
25707 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
25708 .endd
25709 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
25710
25711 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
25712 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
25713 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25714 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25715 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
25716 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
25717 SMTP connection.
25718
25719 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
25720 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
25721 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
25722 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
25723
25724 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
25725 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
25726 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
25727 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25728 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
25729 disables such output flushing.
25730
25731 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
25732 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
25733 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
25734 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25735 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
25736 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
25737
25738 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
25739 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
25740 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
25741 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
25742 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
25743 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
25744 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25745 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
25746 to be useful in production.
25747
25748 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
25749 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
25750 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
25751 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
25752 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
25753
25754 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
25755 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
25756 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
25757 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
25758 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
25759 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
25760
25761 .ilist
25762 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
25763 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
25764 verification failed"&) is sent.
25765 .next
25766 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
25767 line is output.
25768 .endlist
25769
25770 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
25771 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
25772
25773 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
25774 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
25775 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
25776 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
25777 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
25778 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
25779 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
25780
25781 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
25782 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
25783 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
25784 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25785 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25786 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
25787 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
25788 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
25789 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
25790 same SMTP connection.
25791
25792 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
25793 .cindex "message" "submission"
25794 .cindex "submission mode"
25795 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
25796 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
25797 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
25798 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
25799 necessary. For example, it add a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
25800 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
25801 late (the message has already been created).
25802
25803 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
25804 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
25805 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
25806 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
25807 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
25808
25809 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
25810 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
25811 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
25812 complement of &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
25813 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
25814
25815 .ilist
25816 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
25817 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
25818 .next
25819 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
25820 .next
25821 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
25822 .endlist ilist
25823
25824 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
25825 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
25826 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
25827 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
25828 data is read.
25829
25830 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
25831 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
25832 .endlist vlist
25833
25834
25835 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
25836 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
25837
25838 .ilist
25839 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
25840 .next
25841 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`&
25842 &`suppress_local_fixups`&.
25843 .next
25844 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
25845 .next
25846 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&.
25847 .endlist
25848
25849
25850
25851 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
25852 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
25853 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
25854 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25855 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
25856 to an incoming message, as in this example:
25857 .code
25858 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
25859 dialup.mail-abuse.org
25860 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
25861 .endd
25862 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
25863 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
25864 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
25865 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
25866 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
25867 RCPT ACL).
25868
25869 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
25870 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
25871 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
25872 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
25873
25874 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
25875 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
25876 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
25877 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
25878 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
25879 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
25880 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
25881 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
25882 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
25883 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
25884 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
25885
25886 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
25887 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
25888 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
25889 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
25890 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
25891 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
25892 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
25893 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
25894 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
25895
25896 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
25897 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
25898 .display
25899 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25900 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
25901
25902 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
25903 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25904 .endd
25905 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
25906 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
25907 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
25908 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
25909 honoured.
25910
25911 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25912 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
25913 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
25914 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
25915 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
25916 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
25917 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
25918 specifications.
25919
25920 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
25921 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
25922 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
25923 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
25924 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
25925
25926 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
25927 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
25928 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
25929 to be a header name first.) For example:
25930 .code
25931 warn add_header = \
25932 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
25933 .endd
25934 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
25935 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
25936 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
25937 up in reverse order.
25938
25939 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
25940 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
25941 system filter or in a router or transport.
25942
25943
25944
25945
25946 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
25947 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
25948 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
25949 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
25950 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
25951 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25952
25953 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
25954 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
25955 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
25956 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
25957 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
25958 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
25959 The conditions are as follows:
25960
25961
25962 .vlist
25963 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
25964 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
25965 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
25966 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
25967 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
25968 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
25969 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
25970 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
25971 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
25972 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
25973 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
25974
25975 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
25976 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
25977 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
25978 conditions are tested.
25979
25980 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
25981 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
25982 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
25983 for different local users or different local domains.
25984
25985 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
25986 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
25987 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
25988 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
25989 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
25990 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
25991 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
25992 .code
25993 authenticated = *
25994 .endd
25995
25996 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
25997 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
25998 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
25999 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26000 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26001 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26002 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26003 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26004 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26005 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26006 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26007 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26008 negative.
26009
26010 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26011 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26012 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26013 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26014 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26015 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26016 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26017 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26018
26019 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26020 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26021 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26022 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26023 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26024
26025 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26026 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26027 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26028 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26029 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26030 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26031 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26032 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26033 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26034 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26035
26036 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26037 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26038 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26039 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26040 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26041 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26042 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26043 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26044 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26045 &%domains%& test.
26046
26047 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26048 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26049
26050
26051 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26052 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26053 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26054 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26055 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26056 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26057 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26058 .code
26059 encrypted = *
26060 .endd
26061
26062
26063 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26064 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26065 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26066 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26067 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26068 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26069 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26070 .code
26071 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26072 .endd
26073 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26074 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26075 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26076
26077 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26078 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26079 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26080 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26081 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26082 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26083
26084 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26085 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26086 .code
26087 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26088 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26089 .endd
26090 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26091 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26092 statement can then check the IP address.
26093
26094 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
26095 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26096 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26097 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26098 .code
26099 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26100 message = $host_data
26101 .endd
26102 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26103
26104 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26105 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26106 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26107 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26108 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26109 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26110 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26111 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26112 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26113 the next &%local_parts%& test.
26114
26115 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26116 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26117 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26118 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26119 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26120 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26121 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26122
26123 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26124 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26125 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26126 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26127 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26128 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26129 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26130 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26131
26132 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26133 .cindex "rate limiting"
26134 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26135 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26136
26137 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26138 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26139 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26140 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26141 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26142 recipient address against a list of recipients.
26143
26144 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26145 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26146 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26147 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26148 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26149 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26150 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26151
26152 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26153 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26154 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26155 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26156 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26157 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26158 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26159 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26160 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26161 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26162 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26163 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26164 influence the sender checking.
26165
26166 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26167 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26168
26169 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26170 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26171 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26172 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26173 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26174 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26175 .code
26176 senders = :
26177 .endd
26178 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26179 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26180
26181 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26182 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26183 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26184 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26185 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26186 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26187
26188 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26189 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26190 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26191 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26192 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26193 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26194 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26195 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26196 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26197 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26198
26199 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26200 .cindex "CSA verification"
26201 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26202 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26203 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26204
26205 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26206 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26207 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26208 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26209 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26210 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26211 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26212 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26213 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26214 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26215 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26216 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26217 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26218 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26219 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26220
26221 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26222 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26223 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26224 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26225 .code
26226 deny senders = :
26227 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26228 !verify = header_sender
26229 .endd
26230
26231 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26232 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26233 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26234 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
26235 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
26236 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26237 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26238 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
26239 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
26240 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
26241 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
26242 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26243 appropriate.
26244
26245 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
26246 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
26247 .code
26248 To: @
26249 .endd
26250 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
26251 common as they used to be.
26252
26253 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
26254 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26255 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
26256 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
26257 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
26258 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
26259 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
26260 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
26261 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
26262 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
26263 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
26264 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
26265 independently of this condition.
26266
26267 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
26268 option), this condition is always true.
26269
26270
26271 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
26272 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
26273 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
26274 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
26275 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
26276 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
26277 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
26278 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
26279 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
26280
26281 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
26282 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
26283
26284
26285 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
26286 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26287 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
26288 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
26289 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
26290 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26291 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
26292 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
26293 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
26294 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
26295 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
26296 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
26297 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
26298 value for the child address.
26299
26300 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
26301 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26302 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
26303 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
26304 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
26305 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
26306 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
26307 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
26308 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
26309 original IP address.
26310
26311 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
26312 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
26313
26314 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
26315 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26316 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
26317 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
26318 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
26319 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
26320 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
26321 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
26322 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
26323
26324 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26325 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
26326 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
26327 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
26328 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
26329 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
26330 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
26331
26332 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
26333 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
26334 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
26335
26336 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
26337 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26338 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
26339 verified as a sender.
26340 .endlist
26341
26342
26343
26344 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
26345 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26346 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26347 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26348 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
26349 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
26350 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
26351 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
26352 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
26353 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
26354 .code
26355 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
26356 dialups.mail-abuse.org
26357 .endd
26358 the following records are looked up:
26359 .code
26360 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26361 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
26362 .endd
26363 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
26364 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
26365 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
26366 use two separate conditions:
26367 .code
26368 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26369 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26370 .endd
26371 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
26372 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
26373 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
26374 processed.
26375
26376 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
26377 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
26378 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
26379 following special items in the list:
26380 .display
26381 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
26382 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
26383 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
26384 .endd
26385 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
26386 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
26387 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
26388 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
26389 .code
26390 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
26391 .endd
26392 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
26393 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
26394 .code
26395 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26396 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
26397 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26398 .endd
26399 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
26400 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
26401 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
26402 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
26403
26404
26405
26406 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
26407 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
26408 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
26409 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
26410 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
26411 .code
26412 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
26413 .endd
26414 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
26415 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
26416 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
26417 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
26418
26419
26420
26421
26422 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
26423 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
26424 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
26425 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
26426 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
26427 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
26428 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
26429 .code
26430 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
26431 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26432 .endd
26433 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
26434 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
26435 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
26436 up by this example is
26437 .code
26438 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
26439 .endd
26440 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
26441 addresses. For example:
26442 .code
26443 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26444 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26445 .endd
26446 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
26447 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
26448
26449
26450
26451
26452 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
26453 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
26454 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
26455 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
26456 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
26457 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
26458 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
26459 either to double the separators like this:
26460 .code
26461 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
26462 .endd
26463 or to change the separator character, like this:
26464 .code
26465 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
26466 .endd
26467 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
26468 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
26469 occurs. Consider this condition:
26470 .code
26471 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
26472 .endd
26473 The DNS lookups that occur are:
26474 .code
26475 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
26476 a.domain.black.list.tld
26477 .endd
26478 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
26479 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
26480 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
26481 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
26482 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
26483 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
26484 error for a previous item.
26485
26486 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
26487 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
26488 .code
26489 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
26490 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
26491 .endd
26492 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
26493 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
26494 .code
26495 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
26496 $sender_address_domain \
26497 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
26498 see $dnslist_text.
26499 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
26500 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
26501 $sender_address_domain} }} }
26502 .endd
26503 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
26504 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
26505 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
26506 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
26507 .code
26508 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
26509 .endd
26510 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
26511 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
26512
26513 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
26514 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
26515
26516
26517
26518
26519 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
26520 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
26521 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26522 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26523 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26524 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26525 .display
26526 127.1.0.1 RBL
26527 127.1.0.2 DUL
26528 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26529 127.1.0.4 RSS
26530 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26531 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26532 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26533 .endd
26534 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
26535 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
26536 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
26537
26538
26539 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
26540 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
26541 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
26542 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
26543 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
26544 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
26545 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
26546 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
26547 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
26548 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
26549 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
26550 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
26551 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
26552 cases, for example:
26553 .code
26554 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
26555 .endd
26556 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
26557 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
26558 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
26559 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
26560 .code
26561 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
26562 .endd
26563 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
26564 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
26565
26566 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
26567 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
26568 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
26569 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
26570 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
26571 information.
26572
26573 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
26574 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
26575 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
26576 .code
26577 deny hosts = !+local_networks
26578 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26579 at $dnslist_domain
26580 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26581 .endd
26582
26583
26584
26585 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
26586 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
26587 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
26588 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26589 For example,
26590 .code
26591 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26592 .endd
26593 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26594 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
26595 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
26596 describes how multiple records are handled.
26597
26598 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26599 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
26600 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
26601 .code
26602 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26603 .endd
26604 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26605 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26606 first. For example:
26607 .code
26608 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
26609 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
26610 .endd
26611
26612 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
26613 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
26614 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
26615 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
26616 tested. For example:
26617 .code
26618 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
26619 .endd
26620 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
26621 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
26622 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
26623 .code
26624 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26625 .endd
26626 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
26627 an odd number.
26628
26629
26630
26631 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
26632 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
26633 condition. Whereas
26634 .code
26635 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26636 .endd
26637 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26638 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
26639 .code
26640 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26641 .endd
26642 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26643 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
26644 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
26645 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
26646
26647 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
26648 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
26649
26650 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
26651 previous example is precisely equivalent to
26652 .code
26653 deny dnslists = a.b.c
26654 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26655 .endd
26656 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
26657 Consider this example:
26658 .code
26659 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26660 list.dsbl.org : \
26661 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
26662 relays.ordb.org
26663 .endd
26664 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
26665 .code
26666 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26667 list.dsbl.org
26668 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
26669 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
26670 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
26671 .endd
26672 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
26673
26674
26675
26676
26677 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
26678 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
26679 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
26680 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
26681 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
26682 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
26683 .code
26684 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
26685 .endd
26686 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
26687 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
26688 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
26689 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
26690 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
26691 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
26692
26693 .ilist
26694 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
26695 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
26696 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26697 .next
26698 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
26699 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
26700 changed to:
26701 .code
26702 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
26703 .endd
26704 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26705 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
26706 .code
26707 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
26708 .endd
26709 for the condition to be true.
26710 .endlist
26711
26712 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
26713 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
26714 .ilist
26715 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
26716 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
26717 .code
26718 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
26719 .endd
26720 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26721 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26722 .next
26723 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
26724 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
26725 .code
26726 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
26727 .endd
26728 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26729 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
26730 .code
26731 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26732 .endd
26733 for the condition to be false.
26734 .endlist
26735 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
26736 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
26737
26738
26739
26740
26741 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
26742 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
26743 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
26744 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
26745 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
26746 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
26747 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
26748 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
26749 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
26750 lists.
26751
26752 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
26753 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
26754 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
26755 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
26756 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
26757 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
26758 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
26759 .code
26760 reject message = \
26761 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
26762 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
26763 dnslists = \
26764 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
26765 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26766 .endd
26767 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
26768 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
26769 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
26770 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
26771 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
26772 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
26773
26774 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
26775 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
26776 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
26777 .code
26778 reject dnslists = \
26779 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
26780 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
26781 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
26782 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26783 .endd
26784 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
26785 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
26786 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
26787
26788
26789
26790 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
26791 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
26792 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
26793 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
26794 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
26795 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
26796 .code
26797 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
26798 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26799 .endd
26800 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
26801 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
26802 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
26803 .code
26804 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
26805 .endd
26806 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
26807 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
26808
26809 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
26810 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
26811 .code
26812 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
26813 dnslists = some.list.example
26814 .endd
26815
26816 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
26817 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
26818 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
26819 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
26820 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
26821 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
26822 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
26823 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
26824 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
26825 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
26826 .display
26827 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
26828 .endd
26829 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
26830 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
26831
26832 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
26833 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
26834 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
26835 of &'p'&.
26836
26837 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
26838 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
26839 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
26840 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
26841 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
26842 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
26843 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
26844 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
26845 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
26846
26847 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
26848 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
26849 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
26850 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
26851
26852 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
26853 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
26854 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
26855 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
26856 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
26857 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
26858 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
26859 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
26860 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
26861 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
26862
26863 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
26864 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
26865 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
26866 ACL.
26867
26868 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options onto the
26869 lookup key because they alter the meaning of the stored data. This is not true
26870 for the limit &'m'&, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will
26871 still remember clients' past behaviour, but if you alter the other ratelimit
26872 parameters Exim forgets past behaviour.
26873
26874 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to three options. One option
26875 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, and the second specifies how Exim
26876 handles excessively fast clients. The third option can be &`noupdate`&, to
26877 disable updating of the ratelimiting database (see section &<<rearatdat>>&).
26878 The options are separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may
26879 appear in any order.
26880
26881 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
26882 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate.
26883
26884 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
26885 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified.
26886
26887 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. Note that it is
26888 best to use this option in the DATA ACL; if it is used in an earlier ACL it
26889 relies on the SIZE parameter specified by the client in its MAIL command,
26890 which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'&
26891 in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes,
26892 megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
26893
26894 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which
26895 recipients are accepted. To be effective, it would need to be used in
26896 either the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& or the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. In the
26897 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACL, the number of recipients is incremented by one.
26898 In the case of a locally submitted message in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL,
26899 the number of recipients is incremented by the &%$recipients_count%&
26900 for the entire message. Note that in either case the rate limiting
26901 engine will see a message with many recipients as a large high-speed
26902 burst.
26903
26904 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
26905 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate.
26906 This command is essentially an alias of &%per_rcpt%& to make it clear
26907 that the effect is to limit the rate at which individual commands,
26908 rather than recipients, are accepted.
26909
26910 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratophanfas"
26911 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
26912 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
26913 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& options. This is independent of the other
26914 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
26915 rest of the ACL. The default mode is leaky, which avoids a sender's
26916 over-aggressive retry rate preventing it from getting any email through.
26917
26918 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
26919 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
26920 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
26921 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
26922 counter-measures by the ACL until it slows down below the maximum rate. If
26923 the client stops attempting to send email for the time specified in the &'p'&
26924 parameter then its computed rate will decay exponentially to 37% of its peak
26925 value. You can work out the time (the number of smoothing periods) that a
26926 client is subjected to counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this
26927 formula:
26928 .code
26929 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
26930 .endd
26931 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
26932 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
26933 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
26934 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
26935 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
26936 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
26937 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
26938
26939 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
26940 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
26941 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
26942 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
26943 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
26944 message. For example:
26945 .code
26946 # Log all senders' rates
26947 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
26948 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
26949
26950 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
26951 # at the decimal point.
26952 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
26953 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
26954 $sender_rate_limit }s
26955
26956 # Keep authenticated users under control
26957 deny authenticated = *
26958 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
26959
26960 # System-wide rate limit
26961 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
26962 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
26963
26964 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
26965 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
26966 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
26967 messages per $sender_rate_period
26968 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
26969 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
26970 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
26971 .endd
26972 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
26973 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
26974 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
26975 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
26976 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
26977 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
26978 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
26979
26980
26981 .section "Reading ratelimit data without updating" "rearatdat"
26982 .cindex "rate limitint" "reading data without updating"
26983 If the &%noupdate%& option is present on a &%ratelimit%& ACL condition, Exim
26984 computes the rate and checks the limit as normal, but it does not update the
26985 saved data. This means that, in relevant ACLs, it is possible to lookup the
26986 existence of a specified (or auto-generated) ratelimit key without incrementing
26987 the ratelimit counter for that key. In order for this to be useful, another ACL
26988 entry must set the rate for the same key (otherwise it will always be zero).
26989 For example:
26990 .code
26991 acl_check_connect:
26992 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / noupdate
26993 log_message = RATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
26994 (max $sender_rate_limit)
26995 .endd
26996 .display
26997 &'... some other logic and tests...'&
26998 .endd
26999 .code
27000 acl_check_mail:
27001 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd
27002 condition = ${if le{$sender_rate}{$sender_rate_limit}}
27003 logwrite = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27004 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27005 .endd
27006 In this example, the rate is tested and used to deny access (when it is too
27007 high) in the connect ACL, but the actual computation of the remembered rate
27008 happens later, on a per-command basis, in another ACL.
27009
27010
27011
27012 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27013 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27014 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27015 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27016 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27017 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27018 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27019 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27020 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27021 .code
27022 verify = sender/callout
27023 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27024 .endd
27025 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27026 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27027 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27028 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27029 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27030 The available options are as follows:
27031
27032 .ilist
27033 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27034 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27035 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27036 .next
27037 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27038 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27039 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27040 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27041 .next
27042 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27043 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27044 .next
27045 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27046 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27047 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27048 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27049 .endlist
27050
27051 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27052 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27053 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27054 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27055 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27056 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27057 coding like this:
27058 .code
27059 warn !verify = sender
27060 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27061 .endd
27062 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27063 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27064 verification failure.
27065
27066 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27067 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27068
27069 .ilist
27070 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27071 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27072 .next
27073 &%route%&: Routing failed.
27074 .next
27075 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27076 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27077 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27078 .next
27079 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27080 .next
27081 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27082 .endlist
27083
27084 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27085 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27086
27087
27088
27089
27090 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27091 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27092 .cindex "callout" "verification"
27093 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27094 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27095 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27096 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27097 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27098 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27099 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27100 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27101 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27102 sender's domain.
27103
27104 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27105 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27106 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27107 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27108 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27109 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27110
27111 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27112 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27113 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27114 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27115 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27116
27117 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27118 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27119 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27120 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27121 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27122 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27123 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27124 supplies a host list.
27125
27126 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27127 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27128 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27129 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27130 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27131 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27132 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27133
27134 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27135 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27136 following SMTP commands are sent:
27137 .display
27138 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27139 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
27140 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27141 &`QUIT`&
27142 .endd
27143 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27144 set to &"lmtp"&.
27145
27146 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27147 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27148 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27149 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27150 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27151 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27152
27153 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27154 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27155 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27156 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27157 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27158
27159 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27160 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27161 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27162 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
27163 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
27164
27165
27166
27167
27168 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
27169 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
27170 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
27171 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
27172 .code
27173 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
27174 .endd
27175 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
27176 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
27177 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
27178
27179
27180 .vlist
27181 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
27182 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
27183 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
27184 For example:
27185 .code
27186 verify = sender/callout=5s
27187 .endd
27188 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
27189 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
27190 the &%connect%& parameter.
27191
27192
27193 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27194 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
27195 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
27196 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
27197 .code
27198 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
27199 .endd
27200 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
27201
27202 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
27203 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
27204 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
27205 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
27206 updated in this circumstance.
27207
27208 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
27209 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
27210 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
27211 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
27212 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
27213 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
27214
27215
27216 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27217 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
27218 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
27219 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
27220 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
27221 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
27222 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
27223 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
27224 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
27225 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
27226 .code
27227 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
27228 .endd
27229 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
27230
27231
27232 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27233 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
27234 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
27235 For example:
27236 .code
27237 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
27238 .endd
27239 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
27240 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
27241 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
27242 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
27243 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
27244
27245
27246 .vitem &*no_cache*&
27247 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
27248 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
27249 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
27250
27251 .vitem &*postmaster*&
27252 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
27253 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
27254 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
27255 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
27256 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
27257 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
27258 made, until the cache record expires.
27259
27260 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27261 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
27262 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
27263 For example:
27264 .code
27265 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
27266 .endd
27267 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
27268 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
27269 .code
27270 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
27271 .endd
27272 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
27273 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
27274 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
27275 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
27276
27277
27278 .vitem &*random*&
27279 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
27280 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
27281 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
27282 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
27283 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
27284 .code
27285 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
27286 .endd
27287 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
27288 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
27289 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
27290 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
27291 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
27292
27293 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
27294 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
27295 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27296 .code
27297 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
27298 .endd
27299 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
27300 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
27301 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
27302 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
27303 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
27304
27305 .vitem &*use_sender*&
27306 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27307 .code
27308 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
27309 .endd
27310 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
27311 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
27312 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
27313 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
27314 usefulness of callout caching.
27315 .endlist
27316
27317 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
27318 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
27319 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
27320 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
27321 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
27322 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
27323 these circumstances.
27324
27325 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
27326 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
27327 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
27328 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
27329 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
27330 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
27331 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
27332
27333 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
27334 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
27335 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
27336 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
27337
27338
27339
27340
27341 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
27342 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
27343 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
27344 .cindex "caching" "callout"
27345 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
27346 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
27347 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
27348 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
27349 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
27350 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
27351
27352 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
27353 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
27354 is not available.
27355
27356 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
27357 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
27358 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
27359
27360 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
27361 commands up to and including
27362 .code
27363 MAIL FROM:<>
27364 .endd
27365 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
27366 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
27367 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
27368 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
27369 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
27370 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
27371 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
27372
27373 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
27374 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
27375 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
27376 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
27377 will eventually be noticed.
27378
27379 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
27380 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
27381 behaviour will be the same.
27382
27383
27384
27385 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
27386 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
27387 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
27388 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
27389 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
27390 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
27391 you might see:
27392 .code
27393 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
27394 250 OK
27395 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
27396 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
27397 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
27398 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
27399 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
27400 550 Sender verification failed
27401 .endd
27402 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
27403 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
27404 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
27405 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
27406 example:
27407 .code
27408 verify = sender/no_details
27409 .endd
27410
27411 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
27412 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
27413 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
27414 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
27415 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
27416 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
27417 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
27418
27419 .ilist
27420 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
27421 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
27422 verification also fails.
27423 .next
27424 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
27425 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
27426 .endlist
27427
27428 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
27429 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
27430 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
27431 .code
27432 A.Wol: aw123
27433 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
27434 .endd
27435 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
27436 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
27437 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
27438 verification to succeed.
27439
27440 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
27441 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
27442 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
27443 option. For example:
27444 .code
27445 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
27446 .endd
27447 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
27448 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
27449
27450 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
27451 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
27452 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
27453 address and a report is output for each of them.
27454
27455
27456
27457 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
27458 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
27459 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
27460 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
27461 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
27462 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
27463 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
27464 .code
27465 verify = csa
27466 .endd
27467 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
27468 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
27469 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
27470 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
27471 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
27472 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
27473
27474 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
27475 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
27476 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
27477 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
27478
27479 .ilist
27480 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
27481 .next
27482 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
27483 .next
27484 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
27485 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
27486 .next
27487 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
27488 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
27489 .endlist
27490
27491 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
27492 use for the DNS query. The default is:
27493 .code
27494 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
27495 .endd
27496 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
27497 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
27498 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
27499 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
27500 meaningful to say:
27501 .code
27502 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
27503 .endd
27504 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
27505 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
27506 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
27507
27508 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
27509 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
27510 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
27511 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
27512 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
27513 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
27514 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
27515 of legitimate HELO domains.
27516
27517 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
27518 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
27519 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
27520 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
27521 lookup such as:
27522 .code
27523 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
27524 .endd
27525 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
27526 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
27527 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
27528
27529
27530
27531
27532 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
27533 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
27534 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
27535 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
27536 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
27537 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
27538 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
27539 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
27540
27541 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
27542 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
27543 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
27544 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
27545 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
27546 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
27547 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
27548
27549 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
27550 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
27551 like this:
27552 .code
27553 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
27554 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
27555 }{$value}}
27556 .endd
27557 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
27558 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
27559 use this:
27560 .code
27561 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
27562 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
27563 senders = :
27564 recipients = +batv_senders
27565
27566 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
27567 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
27568 senders = :
27569 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
27570 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
27571 !condition = $prvscheck_result
27572 .endd
27573 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
27574 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
27575 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
27576 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
27577 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
27578
27579 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
27580 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
27581 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
27582 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
27583 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
27584 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
27585 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
27586
27587 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
27588 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
27589 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
27590 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
27591 .code
27592 batv_redirect:
27593 driver = redirect
27594 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
27595 .endd
27596 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
27597 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
27598 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
27599 local addresses.
27600
27601 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
27602 can be used:
27603 .code
27604 external_smtp_batv:
27605 driver = smtp
27606 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
27607 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
27608 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
27609 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
27610 {$value}fail}}}
27611 .endd
27612 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
27613
27614
27615
27616 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
27617 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
27618 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
27619 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
27620 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
27621 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
27622 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
27623 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
27624 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
27625 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
27626
27627 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
27628 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
27629 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
27630 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
27631 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
27632 same host is fulfilling both functions,
27633 . ///
27634 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
27635 . ///
27636 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
27637 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
27638 system to arbitrary domains.
27639
27640
27641 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
27642 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
27643 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
27644 example, suppose you want to do the following:
27645
27646 .ilist
27647 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
27648 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
27649 &'my.dom2.example'&.
27650 .next
27651 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
27652 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
27653 .next
27654 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
27655 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
27656 .endlist
27657
27658
27659 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
27660 .code
27661 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
27662 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
27663 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
27664 .endd
27665 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
27666 command:
27667 .code
27668 acl_check_rcpt:
27669 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
27670 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
27671 .endd
27672 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
27673 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
27674 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
27675 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
27676 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
27677 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
27678 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27679
27680
27681
27682 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
27683 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
27684 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
27685 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
27686 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27687
27688 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
27689 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
27690 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
27691 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
27692 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
27693 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
27694 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
27695 .ecindex IIDacl
27696
27697
27698
27699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27701
27702 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
27703 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
27704 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
27705 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
27706 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
27707 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
27708 specification.
27709
27710 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
27711 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
27712 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
27713 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
27714 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
27715
27716 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
27717 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
27718 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
27719
27720 .ilist
27721 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
27722 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
27723 .next
27724 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
27725 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
27726 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
27727 .next
27728 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
27729 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
27730 .next
27731 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
27732 conditions.
27733 .next
27734 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
27735 .endlist
27736
27737 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
27738 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
27739 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
27740
27741 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
27742 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
27743 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
27744 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
27745 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
27746 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
27747
27748 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
27749 temporarily created in a file called:
27750 .display
27751 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
27752 .endd
27753 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
27754 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
27755 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
27756 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
27757 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
27758 .code
27759 control = no_mbox_unspool
27760 .endd
27761 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
27762 same directory by default.
27763
27764
27765
27766 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
27767 .cindex "virus scanning"
27768 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
27769 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
27770 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
27771 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
27772 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
27773 in memory and thus are much faster.
27774
27775 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
27776 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
27777 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
27778 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
27779 .display
27780 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
27781 .endd
27782 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
27783 .code
27784 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
27785 .endd
27786 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
27787 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
27788
27789 .vlist
27790 .vitem &%aveserver%&
27791 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27792 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
27793 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
27794 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
27795 example:
27796 .code
27797 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
27798 .endd
27799
27800 .vitem &%clamd%&
27801 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
27802 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
27803 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
27804 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
27805 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
27806 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
27807 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
27808 .code
27809 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
27810 av_scanner = clamd:192.168.2.100 1234
27811 .endd
27812 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
27813 contributing the code for this scanner.
27814
27815 .vitem &%cmdline%&
27816 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
27817 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
27818 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
27819 type takes 3 mandatory options:
27820
27821 .olist
27822 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
27823 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
27824
27825 .next
27826 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
27827 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
27828 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
27829 the &"trigger"& expression.
27830
27831 .next
27832 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
27833 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
27834 &"name"& expression.
27835 .endlist olist
27836
27837 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
27838 .code
27839 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
27840 .endd
27841 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
27842 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
27843 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
27844 configuration setting:
27845 .code
27846 av_scanner = cmdline:\
27847 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
27848 found in file:'(.+)'
27849 .endd
27850 .vitem &%drweb%&
27851 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
27852 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
27853 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
27854 separated by white space, as in these examples:
27855 .code
27856 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
27857 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
27858 .endd
27859 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
27860 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
27861
27862 .vitem &%fsecure%&
27863 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
27864 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
27865 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
27866 .code
27867 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
27868 .endd
27869 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
27870 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
27871
27872 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
27873 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27874 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
27875 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
27876 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
27877 For example:
27878 .code
27879 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
27880 .endd
27881 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
27882
27883 .vitem &%mksd%&
27884 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
27885 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
27886 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
27887 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
27888 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
27889 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
27890 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
27891 .code
27892 av_scanner = mksd:2
27893 .endd
27894 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
27895
27896 .vitem &%sophie%&
27897 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
27898 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
27899 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
27900 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
27901 client communication. For example:
27902 .code
27903 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
27904 .endd
27905 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
27906 the option.
27907 .endlist
27908
27909 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
27910 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
27911 ACL.
27912
27913 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
27914 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
27915 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
27916 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
27917 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
27918 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
27919 message.
27920
27921 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
27922 use. It can then be one of
27923
27924 .ilist
27925 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
27926 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
27927 recommended usage.
27928 .next
27929 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
27930 the condition fails immediately.
27931 .next
27932 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
27933 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
27934 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
27935 .endlist
27936
27937 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
27938 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
27939 causes the ACL to defer.
27940
27941 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
27942 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
27943 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
27944 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
27945 logging data.
27946
27947 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
27948 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
27949 &%malware%& condition.
27950
27951 Here is a very simple scanning example:
27952 .code
27953 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27954 demime = *
27955 malware = *
27956 .endd
27957 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
27958 .code
27959 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27960 demime = *
27961 malware = */defer_ok
27962 .endd
27963 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
27964 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
27965 .code
27966 av_scanner = $acl_m0
27967 .endd
27968 in the main Exim configuration.
27969 .code
27970 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27971 set acl_m0 = sophie
27972 malware = *
27973
27974 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27975 set acl_m0 = aveserver
27976 malware = *
27977 .endd
27978
27979
27980 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
27981 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
27982 .cindex "spam scanning"
27983 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
27984 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
27985 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
27986 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
27987 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
27988 .code
27989 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
27990 .endd
27991 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
27992 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
27993 nicely, however.
27994
27995 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
27996 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
27997 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
27998 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
27999 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
28000 .code
28001 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
28002 .endd
28003 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
28004 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
28005 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28006 address/port pair:
28007 .code
28008 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28009 .endd
28010 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28011 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28012 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28013 option, separated with colons:
28014 .code
28015 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28016 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28017 192.168.2.12 783
28018 .endd
28019 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28020 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28021 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28022 condition defers.
28023
28024 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28025 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28026
28027 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
28028 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
28029 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
28030 expansion.
28031
28032 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28033 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28034 .code
28035 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28036 spam = joe
28037 .endd
28038 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28039 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28040 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28041 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28042 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28043
28044 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28045 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28046 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28047 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28048 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28049 are not set.
28050
28051 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28052 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28053 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28054
28055
28056 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28057 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28058 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28059 example:
28060 .code
28061 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28062 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28063 spam = nobody
28064 .endd
28065
28066 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28067 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28068 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28069 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28070
28071 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28072 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28073 variables. With the exception of &$spam_score_int$&, these are usable only
28074 within ACLs; their values are not retained with the message and so cannot be
28075 used at delivery time.
28076
28077 .vlist
28078 .vitem &$spam_score$&
28079 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28080 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28081
28082 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28083 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28084 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
28085 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
28086 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in
28087 conditions. This variable is special; its value is saved with the message, and
28088 written to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used during the whole
28089 life of the message on your Exim system, in particular, in routers or
28090 transports during the later delivery phase.
28091
28092 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
28093 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28094 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28095 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28096 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28097
28098 .vitem &$spam_report$&
28099 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28100 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28101 .endlist
28102
28103 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
28104 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
28105 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
28106
28107 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
28108 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
28109 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
28110 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
28111 spam condition, like this:
28112 .code
28113 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28114 spam = joe/defer_ok
28115 .endd
28116 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28117
28118 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28119 condition:
28120 .code
28121 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28122 warn spam = nobody:true
28123 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28124 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28125
28126 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28127 # is over threshold
28128 warn spam = nobody
28129 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28130
28131 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28132 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28133 spam = nobody:true
28134 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28135 .endd
28136
28137
28138
28139 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28140 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28141 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28142 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28143 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28144 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28145 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28146 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28147 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28148 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28149 cases.
28150
28151 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28152 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28153 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28154 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
28155 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
28156 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
28157 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
28158
28159 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
28160 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
28161 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
28162 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
28163 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
28164
28165 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
28166 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
28167 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
28168 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
28169 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
28170 syntax is:
28171 .display
28172 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
28173 .endd
28174 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
28175 the value can be:
28176
28177 .olist
28178 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
28179 .next
28180 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
28181 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
28182 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
28183 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
28184 .next
28185 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
28186 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
28187 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
28188 the full path and file name.
28189 .next
28190 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
28191 filename, and the default path is then used.
28192 .endlist
28193 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
28194 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
28195 a file with its original, proposed filename using
28196 .code
28197 decode = $mime_filename
28198 .endd
28199 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
28200 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
28201 automatically unlinked.
28202
28203 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
28204 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
28205 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
28206 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
28207 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
28208
28209 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
28210 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
28211 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
28212
28213 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
28214 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
28215 available in the MIME ACL:
28216
28217 .vlist
28218 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
28219 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
28220 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
28221 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
28222 contains the empty string.
28223
28224 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
28225 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
28226 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
28227 .code
28228 us-ascii
28229 gb2312 (Chinese)
28230 iso-8859-1
28231 .endd
28232 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
28233 case-insensitively.
28234
28235 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
28236 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
28237 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
28238 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
28239 only used for display purposes.
28240
28241 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
28242 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
28243 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
28244
28245 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
28246 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
28247 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
28248
28249 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
28250 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28251 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
28252 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
28253 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
28254
28255 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
28256 This variable contains the normalized content of the
28257 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
28258 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
28259
28260 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
28261 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
28262 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
28263 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
28264 .code
28265 text/plain
28266 text/html
28267 application/octet-stream
28268 image/jpeg
28269 audio/midi
28270 .endd
28271 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
28272 empty string.
28273
28274 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
28275 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28276 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
28277 containing the decoded data.
28278 .endlist
28279
28280 .cindex "RFC 2047"
28281 .vlist
28282 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
28283 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
28284 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
28285 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
28286 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
28287 found, this variable contains the empty string.
28288
28289 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
28290 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
28291 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
28292 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
28293
28294 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
28295 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
28296 follows:
28297
28298 .olist
28299 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
28300
28301 .next
28302 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
28303 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
28304
28305 .next
28306 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
28307 and the rest are attachments.
28308
28309 .next
28310 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
28311 .endlist olist
28312
28313 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
28314 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
28315 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
28316 .code
28317 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
28318 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
28319 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
28320 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
28321 .endd
28322 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
28323 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
28324 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
28325 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
28326 want to carry out specific actions on them.
28327
28328 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
28329 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
28330 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
28331 decoding is fully recursive.
28332
28333 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
28334 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
28335 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
28336 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
28337 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
28338 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
28339 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
28340 .endlist
28341
28342
28343
28344 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
28345 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
28346 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
28347 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
28348 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
28349
28350 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
28351 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
28352 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
28353 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
28354 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
28355
28356 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
28357 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
28358 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
28359 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
28360 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
28361 32K characters are checked.
28362
28363 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
28364 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
28365 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
28366 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
28367 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
28368 .code
28369 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
28370 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
28371 .endd
28372 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
28373 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
28374 matching regular expression.
28375
28376 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
28377 CPU-intensive.
28378
28379
28380
28381
28382 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
28383 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
28384 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28385 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
28386 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
28387 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
28388 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
28389 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
28390 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
28391 use the &%demime%& condition.
28392
28393 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
28394 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
28395 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
28396 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
28397 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
28398 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
28399
28400 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
28401 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
28402 example:
28403 .code
28404 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
28405 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
28406 .endd
28407 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
28408 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
28409 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
28410 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
28411
28412 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
28413 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
28414 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
28415
28416 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
28417
28418 .vlist
28419 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
28420 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
28421 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
28422 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
28423 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
28424 zero, no error occurred.
28425
28426 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
28427 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
28428 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
28429 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
28430 .endlist
28431
28432 .vlist
28433 .vitem &$found_extension$&
28434 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
28435 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
28436 extension it found.
28437 .endlist
28438
28439 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
28440 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
28441
28442 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
28443 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
28444 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
28445 facility:
28446 .code
28447 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
28448 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
28449 demime = *
28450 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
28451
28452 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
28453 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
28454 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
28455 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
28456
28457 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
28458 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
28459 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
28460 demime = exe:doc
28461 control = freeze
28462 .endd
28463 .ecindex IIDcosca
28464
28465
28466
28467
28468 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28469 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28470
28471 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
28472 "Local scan function"
28473 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
28474 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
28475 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
28476 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
28477 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
28478
28479 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
28480 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
28481 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
28482 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
28483 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
28484
28485 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
28486 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
28487 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
28488 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
28489
28490 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
28491 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
28492 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
28493 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
28494
28495 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
28496 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
28497 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
28498 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
28499 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
28500 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
28501 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
28502 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
28503 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
28504
28505
28506
28507 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
28508 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
28509 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
28510 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
28511 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
28512 directory, so you might set
28513 .code
28514 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
28515 .endd
28516 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
28517 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
28518 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
28519 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
28520 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
28521 _src/local_scan.c_.
28522
28523 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
28524 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
28525 .code
28526 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28527 .endd
28528 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
28529
28530
28531
28532
28533 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
28534 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
28535 You must include this line near the start of your code:
28536 .code
28537 #include "local_scan.h"
28538 .endd
28539 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
28540 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
28541 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
28542 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
28543 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
28544 strings and pointers to character strings:
28545 .code
28546 #define CS (char *)
28547 #define CCS (const char *)
28548 #define CSS (char **)
28549 #define US (unsigned char *)
28550 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
28551 #define USS (unsigned char **)
28552 .endd
28553 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
28554 .code
28555 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
28556 .endd
28557 The arguments are as follows:
28558
28559 .ilist
28560 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
28561 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
28562 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
28563
28564 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
28565 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
28566 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
28567 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
28568 case this changes in some future version.
28569 .next
28570 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
28571 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
28572 .endlist
28573
28574 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
28575
28576 .vlist
28577 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
28578 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
28579 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
28580 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
28581 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
28582 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
28583
28584 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
28585 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28586 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
28587
28588 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
28589 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28590 queued without immediate delivery.
28591
28592 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
28593 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
28594 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
28595 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
28596 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
28597 used.
28598
28599 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
28600 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
28601 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
28602 problem"& is used.
28603
28604 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28605 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
28606 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
28607 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
28608 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
28609 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
28610 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28611
28612 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28613 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
28614 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28615 .endlist
28616
28617 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
28618 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
28619 &%-oe%& command line options.
28620
28621
28622
28623 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
28624 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
28625 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
28626 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
28627 want to do this, you must have the line
28628 .code
28629 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28630 .endd
28631 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
28632 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
28633 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
28634 to define them.
28635
28636 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
28637 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
28638 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
28639 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
28640 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
28641 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
28642 .code
28643 static int my_integer_option = 42;
28644 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
28645
28646 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
28647 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
28648 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
28649 };
28650
28651 int local_scan_options_count =
28652 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
28653 .endd
28654 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
28655 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
28656 .code
28657 begin local_scan
28658 my_integer = 99
28659 my_string = some string of text...
28660 .endd
28661 The available types of option data are as follows:
28662
28663 .vlist
28664 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
28665 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
28666 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
28667 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
28668 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
28669 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
28670 values.)
28671
28672 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
28673 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
28674 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
28675 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
28676
28677 .vitem &*opt_int*&
28678 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
28679 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
28680 Exim.
28681
28682 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
28683 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
28684 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
28685 printed with the suffix K or M.
28686
28687 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
28688 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
28689 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
28690 always output in octal.
28691
28692 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
28693 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
28694 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
28695
28696 .vitem &*opt_time*&
28697 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
28698 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
28699 .endlist
28700
28701 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
28702 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
28703
28704
28705
28706 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
28707 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
28708 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
28709 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
28710 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
28711 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
28712 C variables are as follows:
28713
28714 .vlist
28715 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
28716 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
28717
28718 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
28719 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
28720
28721 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
28722 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
28723 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
28724 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
28725
28726 .ilist
28727 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
28728 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
28729 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
28730
28731 .next
28732 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
28733 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
28734 of debugging bits.
28735 .endlist ilist
28736
28737 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
28738 selected, you should use code like this:
28739 .code
28740 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28741 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28742 .endd
28743 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
28744 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
28745 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
28746
28747 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
28748 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
28749 discussed below.
28750
28751 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
28752 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
28753
28754 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
28755 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
28756
28757 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
28758 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
28759 &%-bh%& command line option.
28760
28761 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
28762 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
28763 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
28764
28765 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
28766 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
28767 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
28768 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
28769
28770 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
28771 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
28772 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
28773
28774 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
28775 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
28776
28777 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
28778 The number of accepted recipients.
28779
28780 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
28781 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
28782 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
28783 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
28784 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
28785 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
28786 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
28787 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
28788 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
28789 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
28790 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
28791 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
28792
28793 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
28794 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
28795
28796 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
28797 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
28798 locally-submitted messages.
28799
28800 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
28801 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
28802 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
28803
28804 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
28805 The name of the sending host, if known.
28806
28807 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
28808 The port on the sending host.
28809
28810 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
28811 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
28812
28813 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
28814 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
28815
28816 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
28817 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
28818 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
28819 .endlist
28820
28821
28822 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
28823 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
28824 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
28825 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
28826 their type to *.
28827
28828
28829 .vlist
28830 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
28831 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
28832
28833 .vitem &*int&~type*&
28834 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
28835 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
28836 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
28837 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
28838 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
28839 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
28840
28841 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
28842 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
28843 internal newlines.
28844
28845 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
28846 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
28847 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
28848 .endlist
28849
28850
28851
28852 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
28853 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
28854
28855 .vlist
28856 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
28857 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
28858
28859 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
28860 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
28861 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
28862 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
28863
28864 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
28865 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
28866 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
28867 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
28868 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
28869 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
28870 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
28871 is NULL for all recipients.
28872 .endlist
28873
28874
28875
28876 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
28877 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
28878 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
28879 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
28880 release:
28881
28882 .vlist
28883 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
28884 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
28885
28886 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
28887 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
28888 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
28889 for the process in &%newumask%&.
28890
28891 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
28892 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
28893 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
28894 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
28895 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
28896
28897 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
28898
28899 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
28900 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
28901 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
28902 return value is as follows:
28903
28904 .ilist
28905 >= 0
28906
28907 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
28908 ending status.
28909
28910 .next
28911 < 0 and > &--256
28912
28913 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
28914 signal number.
28915
28916 .next
28917 &--256
28918
28919 The process timed out.
28920 .next
28921 &--257
28922
28923 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
28924 .endlist
28925
28926 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
28927 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
28928 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
28929 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
28930 forks a subprocess that is running
28931 .code
28932 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
28933 .endd
28934 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
28935 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
28936 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
28937 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
28938
28939 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
28940 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
28941 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
28942 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
28943
28944
28945 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
28946 *sender_authentication)*&
28947 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
28948 that it runs is:
28949 .display
28950 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
28951 .endd
28952 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
28953
28954
28955 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
28956 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
28957 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
28958 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
28959 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
28960 .code
28961 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28962 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28963 .endd
28964
28965 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
28966 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
28967 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
28968 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
28969 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
28970 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
28971 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
28972 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
28973
28974 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
28975 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
28976 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
28977 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
28978 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
28979 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
28980
28981 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
28982 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
28983 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
28984 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
28985
28986 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
28987 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
28988 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
28989 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
28990 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
28991 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
28992 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
28993 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
28994 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
28995 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
28996 .code
28997 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
28998 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
28999 .endd
29000 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
29001 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
29002
29003
29004 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
29005 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29006 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29007 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29008 match the specification, the function does nothing.
29009
29010
29011 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29012 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29013 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29014 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29015 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29016 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29017 .code
29018 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29019 .endd
29020 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29021 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29022 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29023 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29024 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29025 zero-terminated.
29026
29027 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29028 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29029 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29030 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29031 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29032 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29033 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29034 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29035
29036 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29037 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29038 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29039 .display
29040 &`OK `& match succeeded
29041 &`FAIL `& match failed
29042 &`DEFER `& match deferred
29043 .endd
29044 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29045 inability to contact a database.
29046
29047 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29048 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
29049 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29050 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29051 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29052
29053 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29054 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
29055 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29056 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29057 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29058
29059 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29060 uschar&~*list)*&"
29061 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29062 expected to be
29063 .code
29064 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29065 .endd
29066 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29067 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29068 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29069 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29070 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29071 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29072 failed.
29073
29074 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29075 *format,&~...)*&"
29076 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29077 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29078 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29079 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29080 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29081 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29082
29083
29084 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29085 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29086 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29087 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29088
29089 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29090 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29091 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29092 value afterwards. For example:
29093 .code
29094 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29095 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29096 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29097 .endd
29098
29099 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29100 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29101 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29102 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29103 address.
29104 .endlist
29105
29106
29107 .cindex "RFC 2047"
29108 .vlist
29109 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29110 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29111 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29112 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29113 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29114 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29115 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29116 binary string is returned with an error message.
29117
29118 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29119 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29120 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29121
29122 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29123 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29124 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29125 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29126 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29127
29128 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29129 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29130 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29131
29132 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29133 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29134 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29135 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29136 with translation.
29137
29138
29139 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29140 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29141 below.
29142
29143 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29144 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29145 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29146 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29147 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29148 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29149 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29150 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29151 is involved.
29152
29153 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29154 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
29155
29156 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
29157 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
29158 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
29159 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
29160 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
29161 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
29162 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
29163 .code
29164 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
29165 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
29166 .endd
29167 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
29168 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
29169 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
29170 multiple output lines.
29171
29172 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
29173 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
29174 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
29175 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
29176 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
29177 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
29178 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
29179 is an error.
29180
29181 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
29182 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
29183 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
29184 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29185
29186 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
29187 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
29188 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29189
29190 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
29191 See below.
29192
29193 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
29194 See below.
29195
29196 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
29197 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
29198 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
29199 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
29200 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
29201 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
29202 more discussion.
29203 .endlist
29204
29205
29206
29207 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
29208 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
29209 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
29210 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
29211 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
29212 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
29213 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
29214 terminates.
29215
29216 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
29217 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
29218 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
29219 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
29220
29221 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
29222 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
29223 .code
29224 store_pool = POOL_PERM
29225 .endd
29226 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
29227 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
29228 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
29229 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
29230
29231 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
29232 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
29233 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
29234 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
29235 &%store_pool%&.
29236 .ecindex IIDlosca
29237
29238
29239
29240
29241 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29242 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29243
29244 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
29245 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
29246 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
29247 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
29248 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
29249 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
29250 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
29251 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
29252
29253 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
29254 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
29255 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
29256 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
29257 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
29258
29259 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
29260 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
29261 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
29262 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
29263 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
29264 prevent it happening on retries.
29265
29266 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29267 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29268 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
29269 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
29270 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
29271 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
29272 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
29273 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
29274
29275
29276 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
29277 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
29278 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
29279 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
29280 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
29281 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
29282 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
29283 .code
29284 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
29285 system_filter_user = exim
29286 .endd
29287 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
29288 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
29289 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
29290 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
29291 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
29292 by the &%reply%& command.
29293
29294
29295 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
29296 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
29297 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
29298 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
29299
29300 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
29301 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
29302
29303
29304
29305 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
29306 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
29307 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
29308 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
29309 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
29310 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
29311 they cause errors.
29312
29313 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
29314 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
29315 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
29316 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
29317 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
29318 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
29319 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
29320
29321 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
29322 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
29323 succeed, it will not be tried again.
29324 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
29325 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
29326
29327 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
29328 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
29329 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
29330 to which users' filter files can refer.
29331
29332
29333
29334 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
29335 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
29336 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
29337 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
29338 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
29339
29340
29341
29342 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
29343 .cindex "freezing messages"
29344 .cindex "message" "freezing"
29345 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
29346 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
29347 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
29348 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
29349 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
29350 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
29351 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
29352 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
29353 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
29354 .code
29355 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
29356 .endd
29357 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
29358
29359 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
29360 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
29361 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
29362 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
29363 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
29364 run.
29365
29366 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
29367 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
29368 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
29369 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
29370
29371 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
29372 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
29373 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
29374 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
29375 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
29376 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
29377 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
29378 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
29379 message. For example:
29380 .code
29381 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
29382 because it contains attachments that we are \
29383 not prepared to receive."
29384 .endd
29385
29386 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
29387 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
29388 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
29389 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
29390 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
29391 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
29392 use, for example
29393 .code
29394 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
29395 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
29396 .endd
29397 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
29398 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
29399 generated by the filter.
29400
29401 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
29402 &%defer%&,
29403 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
29404 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
29405 as
29406 .code
29407 mail ...
29408 freeze
29409 .endd
29410 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
29411 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
29412 take place.
29413
29414
29415
29416 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
29417 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
29418 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
29419 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
29420 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
29421 .code
29422 headers add <string>
29423 headers remove <string>
29424 .endd
29425 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
29426 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
29427 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
29428 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
29429 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
29430
29431 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
29432 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
29433 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
29434 example:
29435 .code
29436 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
29437 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
29438 X-header-2: ...."
29439 .endd
29440 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
29441 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
29442 space after input continuations is ignored.
29443
29444 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
29445 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
29446 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
29447 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
29448 header with the same name, they are all removed.
29449
29450 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
29451 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
29452 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
29453 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
29454 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
29455 used for all recipients of the message.
29456
29457 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
29458 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
29459 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
29460 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
29461 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
29462 until the message is actually being written (see section
29463 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
29464
29465 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
29466 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
29467 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
29468 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
29469 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
29470 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
29471 modified more than once.
29472
29473 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
29474 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
29475 For example:
29476 .code
29477 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
29478 headers remove "Subject"
29479 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
29480 headers remove "Old-Subject"
29481 .endd
29482
29483
29484
29485 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
29486 .cindex "envelope sender"
29487 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
29488 .code
29489 errors_to <some address>
29490 .endd
29491 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
29492 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
29493 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
29494 might use
29495 .code
29496 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
29497 .endd
29498 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
29499 address if its delivery failed.
29500
29501
29502
29503 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
29504 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29505 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29506 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
29507 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
29508 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
29509 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
29510 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
29511 which implements such a filter:
29512 .code
29513 central_filter:
29514 check_local_user
29515 driver = redirect
29516 domains = +local_domains
29517 file = /central/filters/$local_part
29518 no_verify
29519 allow_filter
29520 allow_freeze
29521 .endd
29522 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
29523 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
29524 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
29525 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
29526
29527 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
29528 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
29529 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
29530 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
29531 normal way.
29532 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
29533 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
29534 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
29535
29536
29537
29538
29539
29540
29541 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29542 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29543
29544 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
29545 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
29546 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
29547 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
29548 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
29549 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
29550 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
29551 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
29552
29553 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
29554 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
29555 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
29556 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
29557 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
29558
29559 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
29560 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
29561 loopback interface specially in any way.
29562
29563 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
29564 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
29565
29566
29567
29568
29569 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
29570 .cindex "message" "submission"
29571 .cindex "submission mode"
29572 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
29573 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
29574 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
29575 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
29576 .code
29577 control = submission
29578 .endd
29579 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
29580 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
29581 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
29582 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
29583 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
29584 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
29585 .code
29586 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
29587 control = submission
29588 .endd
29589 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
29590 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
29591 is used to separate options. For example:
29592 .code
29593 control = submission/sender_retain
29594 .endd
29595 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
29596 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
29597 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
29598 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
29599 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
29600 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
29601 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
29602
29603 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
29604 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
29605 example:
29606 .code
29607 control = submission/domain=some.domain
29608 .endd
29609 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
29610 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
29611 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
29612 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
29613 .code
29614 accept authenticated = *
29615 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
29616 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
29617 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
29618 .endd
29619 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
29620 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
29621 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
29622 .code
29623 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
29624 .endd
29625 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
29626 line would be:
29627 .code
29628 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
29629 .endd
29630 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
29631 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
29632 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
29633 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
29634
29635 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
29636 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
29637 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
29638 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
29639 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
29640 spoof another's address.
29641
29642 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
29643 .cindex "line endings"
29644 .cindex "carriage return"
29645 .cindex "linefeed"
29646 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
29647 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
29648 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
29649 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
29650 use CRLF or just CR.
29651
29652 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
29653 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
29654 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
29655 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
29656 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
29657 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
29658 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
29659 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
29660 follows:
29661
29662 .ilist
29663 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
29664 .next
29665 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
29666 is ignored.
29667 .next
29668 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
29669 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
29670 terminator.
29671 .next
29672 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
29673 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
29674 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
29675 people trying to play silly games.
29676 .next
29677 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
29678 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
29679 line.
29680 .endlist
29681
29682
29683
29684
29685
29686 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
29687 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
29688 .cindex "address" "qualification"
29689 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
29690 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
29691 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
29692 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
29693 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
29694
29695 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
29696 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
29697 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
29698 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
29699 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
29700
29701 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
29702 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
29703 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
29704 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
29705 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
29706 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
29707 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
29708 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
29709
29710
29711
29712
29713 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
29714 .cindex "&""From""& line"
29715 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
29716 .cindex "sender" "address"
29717 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
29718 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
29719 .cindex "envelope sender"
29720 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29721 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
29722 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
29723 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
29724 .code
29725 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
29726 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
29727 .endd
29728 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
29729 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
29730 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
29731 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
29732 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
29733 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
29734 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
29735 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
29736 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
29737
29738 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
29739 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
29740 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
29741 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
29742 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
29743 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
29744 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
29745
29746 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
29747 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
29748 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
29749
29750 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
29751 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
29752 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
29753 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
29754
29755
29756
29757 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
29758 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
29759 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
29760 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
29761 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
29762 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
29763 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
29764
29765 .blockquote
29766 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
29767 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
29768 .endblockquote
29769
29770 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
29771 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
29772 follows:
29773
29774 .ilist
29775 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
29776 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
29777 .next
29778 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
29779 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
29780 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
29781 .next
29782 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
29783 also removed.
29784 .next
29785 For a locally-submitted message,
29786 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
29787 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
29788 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
29789 included in log lines in this case.
29790 .next
29791 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
29792 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
29793 .endlist
29794
29795
29796
29797
29798 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
29799 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
29800 includes the header line:
29801 .code
29802 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
29803 .endd
29804
29805 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
29806 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
29807 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
29808 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
29809 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
29810 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
29811
29812
29813 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
29814 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
29815 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
29816 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
29817 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
29818
29819 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
29820 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
29821 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
29822 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
29823 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
29824 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
29825 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
29826 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
29827 messages.
29828
29829
29830 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
29831 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
29832 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
29833 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
29834 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
29835 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
29836 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
29837 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
29838 messages.
29839
29840
29841 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
29842 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
29843 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29844 .cindex "message" "submission"
29845 .cindex "submission mode"
29846 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
29847 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
29848
29849 .ilist
29850 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
29851 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
29852 .next
29853 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29854 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
29855 .olist
29856 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29857 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
29858 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
29859 .next
29860 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
29861 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
29862 .next
29863 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
29864 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
29865 .endlist
29866 .endlist
29867
29868 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
29869
29870 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
29871 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
29872 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
29873 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29874 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
29875 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
29876 &%qualify_domain%&.
29877
29878 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
29879 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
29880 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
29881 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29882
29883
29884 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
29885 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
29886 .cindex "message" "submission"
29887 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
29888 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
29889 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
29890 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
29891 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
29892 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
29893 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
29894 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
29895 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
29896 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
29897
29898
29899 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
29900 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
29901 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
29902 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
29903 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
29904
29905 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
29906 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
29907 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
29908 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
29909
29910 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
29911 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
29912 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
29913
29914
29915 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
29916 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
29917 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
29918 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
29919 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
29920 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
29921 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
29922 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
29923 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
29924 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
29925 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
29926
29927
29928
29929 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
29930 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
29931 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
29932 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
29933 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
29934 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
29935 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
29936 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
29937
29938
29939
29940 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
29941 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
29942 .cindex "message" "submission"
29943 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
29944 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
29945 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
29946 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
29947 control setting.
29948
29949 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
29950 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
29951 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
29952 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
29953 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
29954 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
29955 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
29956 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
29957 line is added to the message.
29958
29959 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
29960 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
29961 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
29962 options true at the same time.
29963
29964 .cindex "submission mode"
29965 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
29966 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
29967 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
29968 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
29969
29970 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29971 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
29972 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
29973 created as follows:
29974
29975 .ilist
29976 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29977 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
29978 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
29979 .next
29980 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
29981 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
29982 .next
29983 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
29984 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
29985 .endlist
29986
29987 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
29988 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
29989 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
29990 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
29991
29992 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
29993 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
29994 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
29995 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
29996
29997
29998
29999 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
30000 "SECTheadersaddrem"
30001 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
30002 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
30003 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
30004 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
30005 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30006 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30007 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30008
30009 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30010 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30011 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30012 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30013 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30014 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30015
30016 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30017 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30018 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30019
30020 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30021 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30022 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30023 .code
30024 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30025 X-added-second: another added header line
30026 .endd
30027 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30028
30029 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30030 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30031 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30032 not part of the names. For example:
30033 .code
30034 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30035 .endd
30036 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30037 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30038 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30039 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30040 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30041
30042 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
30043 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30044 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30045 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30046
30047 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30048 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30049 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30050 requirements.
30051
30052 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30053 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30054 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30055 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30056 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30057 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30058 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30059
30060 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30061 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30062 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30063 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30064
30065 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30066 the following consequences:
30067
30068 .ilist
30069 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30070 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30071 to it, at all times.
30072 .next
30073 Header lines that are added by a router's
30074 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30075 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30076 .next
30077 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30078 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30079 .next
30080 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30081 a later router or by a transport.
30082 .next
30083 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30084 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30085 .code
30086 headers_remove = subject
30087 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30088 .endd
30089 .endlist
30090
30091 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30092 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30093
30094
30095
30096
30097
30098 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30099 .cindex "address" "constructed"
30100 .cindex "constructed address"
30101 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30102 the form
30103 .display
30104 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30105 .endd
30106 For example:
30107 .code
30108 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30109 .endd
30110 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30111 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30112 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30113 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30114 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30115 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30116 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30117 there is no password file entry.
30118
30119 .cindex "RFC 2047"
30120 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30121 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30122 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30123 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30124 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30125 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30126 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30127 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30128
30129
30130
30131 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30132 .cindex "case of local parts"
30133 .cindex "local part" "case of"
30134 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30135 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30136 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30137 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30138 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30139 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30140 router option.
30141
30142 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
30143 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30144 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30145 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30146 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30147 .code
30148 correct_case:
30149 driver = redirect
30150 domains = +local_domains
30151 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30152 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
30153 @$domain
30154 .endd
30155 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
30156 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
30157 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
30158 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
30159 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
30160
30161
30162
30163 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
30164 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
30165 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
30166 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
30167 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
30168 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
30169 empty components for compatibility.
30170
30171
30172
30173 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
30174 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
30175 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
30176 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
30177 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
30178 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
30179
30180 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
30181 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
30182 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
30183 example, a header such as
30184 .code
30185 To: hare@teaparty
30186 .endd
30187 might get rewritten as
30188 .code
30189 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
30190 .endd
30191 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
30192 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
30193 been routed.
30194
30195 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
30196 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
30197 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
30198 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
30199 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
30200 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
30201 .ecindex IIDmesproc
30202
30203
30204
30205 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30206 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30207
30208 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
30209 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
30210 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
30211 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
30212 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
30213 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
30214 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
30215
30216 .ilist
30217 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
30218 .next
30219 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
30220 .next
30221 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
30222 .endlist
30223
30224 For mail delivery, the following are available:
30225
30226 .ilist
30227 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
30228 .next
30229 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
30230 &"lmtp"&);
30231 .next
30232 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
30233 transport);
30234 .next
30235 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
30236 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
30237 .endlist
30238
30239 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
30240 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
30241 used to contain the envelope information.
30242
30243
30244
30245 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
30246 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
30247 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
30248 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
30249 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
30250 .cindex "EHLO"
30251 .cindex "HELO"
30252 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30253 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
30254 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
30255 processing is the same in both cases.
30256
30257 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
30258 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
30259 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
30260 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
30261 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
30262 .cindex "transport" "filter"
30263 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
30264 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
30265 suppressed.
30266
30267 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
30268 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
30269 required for the transaction.
30270
30271 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
30272 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
30273 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
30274
30275 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
30276 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
30277 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
30278
30279 .cindex "carriage return"
30280 .cindex "linefeed"
30281 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30282 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
30283 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30284 line terminator.
30285
30286 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
30287 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
30288 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
30289 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
30290 of the &%max_rcpts%& option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
30291 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpts%& addresses
30292 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
30293 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
30294 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
30295
30296 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
30297 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
30298 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
30299 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
30300
30301 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
30302 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
30303 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
30304 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
30305
30306 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
30307 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
30308 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
30309 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
30310 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
30311 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
30312 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
30313 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
30314 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
30315 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
30316
30317 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
30318 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
30319
30320 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
30321 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
30322 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
30323 square bracket of the IP address.
30324
30325
30326
30327
30328 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
30329 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
30330 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
30331 .cindex "host" "error"
30332 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
30333 message errors, and recipient errors.
30334
30335 .vlist
30336 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
30337 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
30338 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
30339
30340 .ilist
30341 Connection refused or timed out,
30342 .next
30343 Any error response code on connection,
30344 .next
30345 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
30346 .next
30347 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
30348 .next
30349 I/O errors at any time,
30350 .next
30351 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
30352 the &"."& at the end of the data.
30353 .endlist ilist
30354
30355 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
30356 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
30357 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
30358 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
30359 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
30360 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
30361 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
30362 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
30363
30364 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
30365 .cindex "message" "error"
30366 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
30367 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
30368 message errors are:
30369
30370 .ilist
30371 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
30372 the data,
30373 .next
30374 Timeout after MAIL,
30375 .next
30376 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
30377 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
30378 connection at any other time.
30379 .endlist ilist
30380
30381 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
30382 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
30383 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
30384 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
30385 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
30386 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
30387 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
30388 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
30389 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
30390 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
30391
30392 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
30393 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
30394 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
30395 response to MAIL.
30396
30397 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
30398 .cindex "recipient" "error"
30399 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
30400 recipient errors are:
30401
30402 .ilist
30403 Any error response to RCPT,
30404 .next
30405 Timeout after RCPT.
30406 .endlist
30407
30408 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
30409 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
30410 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
30411 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
30412 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
30413 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
30414 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
30415 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
30416 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
30417 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
30418 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
30419 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
30420 the retry clock is reset.
30421
30422 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
30423 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
30424 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
30425 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
30426 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
30427 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
30428 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
30429 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
30430 recipient's retry time.
30431 .endlist
30432
30433 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
30434 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
30435 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
30436 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
30437 until the next delivery attempt.
30438
30439 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
30440 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
30441 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
30442 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
30443 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
30444 is created.
30445
30446 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
30447 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
30448 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
30449 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
30450 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
30451 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
30452 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
30453
30454 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
30455 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
30456 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
30457 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
30458 then to be treated as a host error.
30459
30460 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
30461 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
30462 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
30463 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
30464 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
30465
30466
30467
30468
30469 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
30470 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
30471 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
30472 .cindex "inetd"
30473 .cindex "daemon"
30474 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
30475 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
30476 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
30477 .code
30478 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
30479 .endd
30480 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
30481 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
30482 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
30483 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
30484 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
30485 stream and exits with an error code.
30486
30487 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
30488 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
30489 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
30490 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
30491
30492 .cindex "carriage return"
30493 .cindex "linefeed"
30494 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30495 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
30496 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30497 line terminator.
30498 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
30499 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
30500 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
30501
30502 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
30503 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
30504 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
30505 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
30506 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
30507 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
30508 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
30509 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
30510
30511 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30512 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
30513 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
30514 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
30515 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
30516 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
30517 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
30518 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
30519 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
30520
30521 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
30522 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
30523 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
30524
30525 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
30526 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
30527 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
30528 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
30529 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
30530
30531 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
30532 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
30533 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
30534 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
30535 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
30536 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
30537 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
30538
30539 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
30540 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
30541 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
30542 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
30543 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
30544
30545 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
30546 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
30547 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
30548 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
30549 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
30550 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
30551 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
30552 a delivery process.
30553
30554 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
30555 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
30556 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
30557 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
30558 however, available with &'inetd'&.
30559
30560 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
30561 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
30562 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
30563 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
30564
30565 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
30566 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
30567 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
30568
30569
30570
30571 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
30572 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
30573 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
30574 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
30575 the error response to the last command. The default value for
30576 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
30577 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
30578 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
30579
30580
30581 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
30582 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
30583 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
30584 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
30585 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
30586 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
30587 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
30588 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
30589 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
30590 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
30591 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
30592
30593
30594
30595 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
30596 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
30597 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
30598 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
30599 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
30600 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
30601 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
30602 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
30603
30604 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
30605 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
30606 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
30607 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
30608 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
30609 counted.
30610
30611 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
30612 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
30613 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
30614
30615 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
30616 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
30617 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
30618 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
30619 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
30620
30621
30622
30623
30624 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
30625 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
30626 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
30627 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
30628 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30629
30630 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
30631 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
30632 called with the &%-bv%& option.
30633
30634 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
30635 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
30636 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
30637 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
30638 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
30639 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
30640 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
30641 RCPT failures.
30642
30643
30644
30645 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
30646 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
30647 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
30648 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
30649 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
30650 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
30651 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30652
30653 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
30654 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
30655 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
30656 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
30657 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
30658 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
30659 argument. For example,
30660 .code
30661 ETRN #brigadoon
30662 .endd
30663 runs the command
30664 .code
30665 exim -R brigadoon
30666 .endd
30667 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
30668 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
30669 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
30670 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
30671 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
30672
30673 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
30674 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
30675 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
30676 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
30677 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
30678 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
30679 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
30680 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
30681
30682 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
30683 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
30684 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
30685 whatever the form of its argument. For
30686 example:
30687 .code
30688 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
30689 $sender_host_address
30690 .endd
30691 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30692 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
30693 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
30694 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
30695 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
30696 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
30697 for it to change them before running the command.
30698
30699
30700
30701 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
30702 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
30703 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
30704 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
30705 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
30706 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
30707 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
30708 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
30709 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
30710 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
30711 runs for RCPT commands:
30712 .code
30713 accept hosts = :
30714 .endd
30715 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
30716
30717
30718
30719 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
30720 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
30721 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
30722 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
30723 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
30724 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
30725 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
30726 envelope along with the message.
30727
30728 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
30729 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
30730 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
30731 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
30732 can be used to specify it.
30733
30734 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
30735 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
30736 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
30737 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
30738 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
30739
30740 .vindex "&$host$&"
30741 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
30742 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
30743 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
30744 router:
30745 .code
30746 begin routers
30747 route_append:
30748 driver = manualroute
30749 transport = smtp_appendfile
30750 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
30751
30752 begin transports
30753 smtp_appendfile:
30754 driver = appendfile
30755 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
30756 batch_max = 1000
30757 use_bsmtp
30758 user = exim
30759 .endd
30760 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
30761 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
30762 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
30763
30764
30765
30766 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
30767 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
30768 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
30769 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
30770 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
30771 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
30772 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
30773 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
30774 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
30775 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
30776
30777 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
30778 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
30779
30780 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
30781 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
30782 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
30783 make some use of automatically, for example:
30784 .code
30785 554 Unexpected end of file
30786 Transaction started in line 10
30787 Error detected in line 14
30788 .endd
30789 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
30790 file, for example:
30791 .code
30792 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
30793 The error message was:
30794
30795 501 '>' missing at end of address
30796
30797 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
30798 The error was detected in line 12.
30799 The SMTP command at fault was:
30800
30801 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
30802
30803 1 previous message was successfully processed.
30804 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
30805 .endd
30806 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
30807 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
30808 accepted.
30809 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
30810 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
30811
30812
30813
30814 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30815 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30816
30817 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
30818 "Customizing messages"
30819 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
30820 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
30821 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
30822 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
30823 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
30824
30825 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
30826 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
30827 option. Exim also adds the line
30828 .code
30829 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
30830 .endd
30831 to all warning and bounce messages,
30832
30833
30834 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
30835 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
30836 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
30837 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
30838 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
30839 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
30840 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
30841
30842 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
30843 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
30844 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
30845 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
30846 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
30847 item.
30848
30849 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
30850 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
30851 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
30852 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
30853 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
30854 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
30855 option, rounded to a whole number.
30856
30857 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
30858
30859 .ilist
30860 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30861 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30862 .next
30863 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
30864 failing addresses with their error messages.
30865 .next
30866 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
30867 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
30868 .next
30869 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
30870 as part of the error report.
30871 .next
30872 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
30873 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
30874 .next
30875 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
30876 .endlist
30877
30878 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
30879 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
30880 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
30881 .code
30882 Subject: Mail delivery failed
30883 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30884 {: returning message to sender}}
30885 ****
30886 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30887
30888 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30889 {that you sent }{sent by
30890
30891 <$sender_address>
30892
30893 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
30894 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
30895 ****
30896 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
30897 ****
30898 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
30899 ------
30900 ****
30901 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
30902 only the first
30903 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
30904 ****
30905 .endd
30906 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
30907 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
30908 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
30909 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
30910 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
30911 text sections:
30912
30913 .ilist
30914 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30915 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30916 .next
30917 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
30918 the delayed addresses.
30919 .next
30920 The third item then ends the message.
30921 .endlist
30922
30923 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
30924 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
30925 .code
30926 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
30927 $warn_message_delay
30928 ****
30929 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30930
30931 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
30932 {that you sent }{sent by
30933
30934 <$sender_address>
30935
30936 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
30937 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
30938
30939 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
30940 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
30941 The date of the message is: $h_date
30942
30943 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
30944 ****
30945 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
30946 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
30947 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
30948 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
30949 the message will be returned to you.
30950 .endd
30951 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
30952 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
30953 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
30954 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
30955 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
30956 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
30957 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
30958 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
30959 handled them.
30960
30961
30962
30963
30964 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30965 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30966
30967 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
30968 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
30969 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
30970
30971
30972
30973 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
30974 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
30975 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
30976 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
30977 routing explicitly:
30978 .code
30979 send_to_smart_host:
30980 driver = manualroute
30981 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
30982 transport = remote_smtp
30983 .endd
30984 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
30985 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
30986 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
30987 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
30988 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
30989
30990
30991
30992
30993 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
30994 .cindex "mailing lists"
30995 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
30996 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
30997 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
30998
30999 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
31000 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
31001 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
31002 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31003 .code
31004 lists:
31005 driver = redirect
31006 domains = lists.example
31007 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31008 forbid_pipe
31009 forbid_file
31010 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31011 no_more
31012 .endd
31013 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31014 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31015 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31016 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31017
31018 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31019 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31020 a mailing list.
31021
31022 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31023 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31024 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31025 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31026 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31027
31028 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31029 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31030 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31031 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31032 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31033 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31034 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31035 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31036 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31037
31038
31039
31040 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31041 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31042 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31043 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31044 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31045 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31046 addresses are not rigorously checked.
31047
31048 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31049 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31050 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31051 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31052 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31053
31054
31055
31056 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31057 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31058 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31059 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31060 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31061 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31062 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31063 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31064 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31065 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31066
31067 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31068 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31069 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31070 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31071 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31072 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31073 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31074 pre-existing messages.
31075
31076 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31077 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31078 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31079 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31080 one level of expansion anyway.
31081
31082
31083
31084 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31085 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31086 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31087 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31088 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31089 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31090
31091 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31092 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31093 .code
31094 lists_request:
31095 driver = redirect
31096 domains = lists.example
31097 local_part_suffix = -request
31098 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31099 no_more
31100
31101 lists_post:
31102 driver = redirect
31103 domains = lists.example
31104 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31105 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31106 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31107 forbid_pipe
31108 forbid_file
31109 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31110 no_more
31111
31112 lists_closed:
31113 driver = redirect
31114 domains = lists.example
31115 allow_fail
31116 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31117 .endd
31118 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31119 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31120 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31121 mailing list.
31122
31123 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31124 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31125 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31126 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31127 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31128 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31129 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31130 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31131 &"unrouteable address"& error.
31132
31133 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31134 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31135 the address, giving a suitable error message.
31136
31137
31138
31139
31140 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31141 .cindex "VERP"
31142 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31143 .cindex "envelope sender"
31144 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31145 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31146 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31147 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31148 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31149 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31150
31151 .oindex &%errors_to%&
31152 .oindex &%return_path%&
31153 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31154 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
31155 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
31156 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
31157 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
31158 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
31159 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
31160 .code
31161 verp_smtp:
31162 driver = smtp
31163 max_rcpt = 1
31164 return_path = \
31165 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31166 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31167 .endd
31168 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
31169 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
31170 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
31171 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
31172 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
31173 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
31174 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
31175 rewritten as
31176 .code
31177 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
31178 .endd
31179 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31180 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
31181 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
31182 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
31183 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
31184 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
31185
31186 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
31187 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
31188 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
31189 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
31190 .code
31191 dnslookup:
31192 driver = dnslookup
31193 domains = ! +local_domains
31194 transport = \
31195 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31196 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
31197 no_more
31198 .endd
31199 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
31200 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
31201 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
31202 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
31203 address.
31204
31205 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
31206 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
31207 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
31208 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
31209 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
31210 .code
31211 verp_dnslookup:
31212 driver = dnslookup
31213 domains = ! +local_domains
31214 transport = remote_smtp
31215 errors_to = \
31216 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
31217 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31218 no_more
31219 .endd
31220 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
31221 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
31222 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
31223 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
31224 them.
31225
31226 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
31227 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
31228 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
31229 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
31230 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
31231 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
31232 used).
31233
31234
31235
31236
31237
31238
31239 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
31240 .cindex "virtual domains"
31241 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
31242 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
31243 meanings:
31244
31245 .ilist
31246 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
31247 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
31248 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
31249 .next
31250 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
31251 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
31252 have login accounts on that host.
31253 .endlist
31254
31255 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
31256 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
31257 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
31258 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
31259 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
31260 to a router of this form:
31261 .code
31262 virtual:
31263 driver = redirect
31264 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
31265 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
31266 no_more
31267 .endd
31268 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
31269 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
31270 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
31271 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
31272 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
31273 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
31274
31275 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
31276 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
31277 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
31278 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
31279
31280 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
31281 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
31282 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
31283 .code
31284 my_domains:
31285 driver = accept
31286 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
31287 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
31288 transport = my_mailboxes
31289 .endd
31290 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
31291 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
31292 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
31293 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
31294 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
31295 follows:
31296 .code
31297 my_mailboxes:
31298 driver = appendfile
31299 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
31300 user = mail
31301 .endd
31302 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
31303 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
31304
31305 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
31306 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
31307 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
31308 information about the domains.
31309
31310
31311
31312 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
31313 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
31314 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
31315 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
31316 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
31317 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
31318 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
31319 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
31320 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
31321 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
31322 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
31323 example, consider this router:
31324 .code
31325 userforward:
31326 driver = redirect
31327 check_local_user
31328 file = $home/.forward
31329 local_part_suffix = -*
31330 local_part_suffix_optional
31331 allow_filter
31332 .endd
31333 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
31334 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
31335 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
31336 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
31337 .code
31338 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
31339 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
31340 endif
31341 .endd
31342 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
31343 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
31344 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
31345 control over which suffixes are valid.
31346
31347 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
31348 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
31349 another MTA:
31350 .code
31351 userforward:
31352 driver = redirect
31353 check_local_user
31354 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
31355 local_part_suffix = -*
31356 local_part_suffix_optional
31357 allow_filter
31358 .endd
31359 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
31360 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
31361 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
31362 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
31363 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
31364
31365
31366
31367 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
31368 .cindex "vacation processing"
31369 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
31370 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
31371 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
31372 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
31373 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
31374
31375 .ilist
31376 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
31377 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
31378 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
31379 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
31380 .code
31381 spqr, vacation-spqr
31382 .endd
31383 .next
31384 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
31385 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
31386 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
31387 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
31388 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
31389 message.
31390 .endlist
31391
31392 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
31393 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
31394
31395
31396
31397 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
31398 .cindex "message" "copying every"
31399 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
31400 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
31401 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
31402 each day's messages.
31403
31404 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
31405 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
31406 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
31407 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
31408
31409
31410
31411 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
31412 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
31413 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
31414 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
31415 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
31416 permanently connected.
31417
31418 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
31419 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
31420 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
31421
31422
31423 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
31424 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
31425 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
31426 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
31427 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
31428 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
31429 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
31430 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
31431
31432 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
31433 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
31434 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
31435 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
31436 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
31437 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
31438 if required.
31439
31440 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
31441 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
31442 intermittent host. For example:
31443 .code
31444 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
31445 .endd
31446 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
31447 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
31448 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
31449 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
31450 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
31451 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
31452 immediately.
31453
31454 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
31455 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
31456 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
31457 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
31458 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
31459 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
31460 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
31461
31462
31463
31464 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
31465 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
31466 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
31467 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
31468 delivered immediately.
31469
31470 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31471 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
31472 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
31473 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
31474 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
31475 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
31476 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
31477 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
31478 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
31479 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
31480 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
31481 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
31482 single SMTP connection.
31483
31484
31485
31486 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31487 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31488
31489 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
31490 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
31491 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
31492 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
31493 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
31494 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
31495 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
31496 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
31497 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
31498 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
31499 messages this way.
31500
31501 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
31502 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
31503 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
31504 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
31505 email is not desirable.
31506
31507 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
31508 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
31509 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
31510 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
31511 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
31512 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
31513 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
31514
31515 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
31516 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
31517 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
31518 before sending a message to the smart host.
31519
31520 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
31521 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
31522 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
31523
31524 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
31525 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
31526 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
31527 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
31528 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
31529 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
31530 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
31531
31532 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
31533 following ways:
31534
31535 .ilist
31536 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
31537 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
31538 .next
31539 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
31540 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
31541 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
31542 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
31543 successful, a zero return code is given.
31544 .next
31545 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
31546 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
31547 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
31548 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
31549 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
31550 are.
31551 .next
31552 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
31553 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
31554 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
31555 .next
31556 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
31557 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
31558 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
31559 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
31560 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
31561 .next
31562 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
31563 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
31564 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
31565 .next
31566 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
31567 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
31568 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
31569 are ever generated.
31570 .next
31571 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
31572 .next
31573 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
31574 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
31575 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
31576 .endlist
31577
31578 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
31579 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
31580 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
31581 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
31582 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
31583 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
31584
31585
31586
31587
31588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31589 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31590
31591 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
31592 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
31593 .cindex "log" "types of"
31594 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
31595 and the panic log:
31596
31597 .ilist
31598 .cindex "main log"
31599 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
31600 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
31601 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
31602 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
31603 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
31604 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
31605 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
31606 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
31607 .next
31608 .cindex "reject log"
31609 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
31610 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
31611 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
31612 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
31613 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
31614 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
31615 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
31616 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
31617 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
31618 false.
31619 .next
31620 .cindex "panic log"
31621 .cindex "system log"
31622 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
31623 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
31624 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
31625 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
31626 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
31627 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
31628 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
31629 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
31630 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
31631 .endlist
31632
31633 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
31634 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
31635 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
31636 .code
31637 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
31638 by QUIT
31639 .endd
31640 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
31641 ways of changing this:
31642
31643 .ilist
31644 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
31645 you set
31646 .code
31647 timezone = UTC
31648 .endd
31649 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
31650 .next
31651 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
31652 example:
31653 .code
31654 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
31655 .endd
31656 .endlist
31657
31658 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
31659 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
31660 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
31661 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
31662 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
31663 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
31664
31665
31666
31667
31668 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
31669 .cindex "log" "destination"
31670 .cindex "log" "to file"
31671 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
31672 .cindex "syslog"
31673 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
31674 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
31675 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
31676 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
31677 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
31678 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
31679 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
31680
31681 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
31682 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
31683 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
31684 references to the host name:
31685 .code
31686 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
31687 .endd
31688 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
31689 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
31690 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
31691 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
31692 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
31693 log at all.
31694
31695 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
31696 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
31697 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
31698 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
31699 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
31700 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
31701 implying the use of a default path.
31702
31703 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
31704 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
31705 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
31706 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
31707 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
31708 equivalent to the setting:
31709 .code
31710 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
31711 .endd
31712 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
31713 logs are written.
31714
31715 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& if datestamped log file names are in
31716 use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
31717
31718 Here are some examples of possible settings:
31719 .display
31720 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
31721 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
31722 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
31723 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
31724 .endd
31725 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
31726 error is logged.
31727
31728
31729
31730 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
31731 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
31732 .cindex "cycling logs"
31733 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
31734 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
31735 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
31736 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
31737 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
31738 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
31739 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
31740
31741 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
31742 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
31743 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
31744 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
31745 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
31746 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
31747 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
31748 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
31749 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
31750 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
31751 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
31752 renamed.
31753
31754
31755
31756 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
31757 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
31758 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
31759 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
31760 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_&.
31761 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
31762 &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& at the point where the
31763 datestamp is required. For example:
31764 .code
31765 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
31766 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
31767 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
31768 .endd
31769 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
31770 examples of names generated by the above examples:
31771 .code
31772 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
31773 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
31774 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
31775 .endd
31776 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
31777 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
31778 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
31779 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
31780
31781 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
31782 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
31783 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& is removed from the string.
31784 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
31785 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
31786 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
31787 .code
31788 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31789 /var/log/exim-panic.log
31790 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31791 .endd
31792
31793
31794 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
31795 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
31796 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
31797 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
31798 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
31799 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
31800 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
31801 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
31802 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
31803 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
31804 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
31805 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
31806 the time and host name to each line.
31807 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
31808
31809 .ilist
31810 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
31811 .next
31812 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
31813 .next
31814 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
31815 .endlist
31816
31817 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
31818 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
31819 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
31820 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
31821
31822 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
31823 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
31824 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
31825 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
31826 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
31827 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
31828 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
31829 RFC 3164, you should set
31830 .code
31831 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
31832 .endd
31833 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
31834 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
31835
31836 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
31837 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
31838 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
31839 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
31840 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
31841 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
31842 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
31843 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
31844 name, and pid as added by syslog:
31845 .code
31846 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
31847 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
31848 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
31849 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
31850 [5/5] mple>)
31851 .endd
31852 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
31853 (LOG_NOTICE):
31854 .code
31855 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
31856 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
31857 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
31858 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
31859 [5\18] .example>)
31860 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
31861 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
31862 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
31863 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
31864 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
31865 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
31866 [12\18] F From: <>
31867 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
31868 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
31869 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
31870 [16\18] le>
31871 [17\18] B Bcc:
31872 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
31873 .endd
31874 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
31875 without modification.
31876
31877 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
31878 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
31879 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
31880 where it is.
31881
31882
31883
31884 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
31885 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
31886 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
31887 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
31888 timestamp. The flags are:
31889 .display
31890 &`<=`& message arrival
31891 &`=>`& normal message delivery
31892 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
31893 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
31894 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
31895 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
31896 .endd
31897
31898
31899 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
31900 .cindex "log" "reception line"
31901 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
31902 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
31903 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
31904 .code
31905 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
31906 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
31907 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
31908 .endd
31909 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
31910 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
31911 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
31912 .code
31913 R=<message id>
31914 .endd
31915 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
31916
31917 .cindex "HELO"
31918 .cindex "EHLO"
31919 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
31920 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
31921 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
31922 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
31923 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
31924 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
31925 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
31926 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
31927 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
31928 name in parentheses.
31929
31930 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
31931 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
31932 the log containing text like these examples:
31933 .code
31934 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
31935 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
31936 .endd
31937 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
31938 on.
31939
31940 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
31941 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
31942 of Exim.
31943
31944 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
31945 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
31946 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
31947 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
31948 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
31949 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
31950 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
31951 suite that was used.
31952
31953 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
31954 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
31955 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
31956 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
31957 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
31958 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
31959 authenticator name.
31960
31961 .cindex "size" "of message"
31962 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
31963 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
31964 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
31965 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
31966 other).
31967
31968 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
31969 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
31970
31971
31972
31973 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
31974 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
31975 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
31976 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
31977 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
31978 to fit it on the page:
31979 .code
31980 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
31981 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
31982 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
31983 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
31984 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
31985 .endd
31986 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
31987 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
31988 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
31989 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
31990 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
31991
31992 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
31993 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
31994 .display
31995 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
31996 .endd
31997 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
31998 parentheses afterwards.
31999
32000 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32001 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
32002 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
32003 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
32004 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
32005 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32006
32007 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32008 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32009
32010 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32011 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32012
32013
32014 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32015 .cindex "discarded messages"
32016 .cindex "message" "discarded"
32017 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32018 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32019 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32020 .code
32021 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32022 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32023 .endd
32024 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32025 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32026 .code
32027 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32028 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32029 .endd
32030
32031
32032 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32033 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32034 .code
32035 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32036 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32037 .endd
32038 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32039 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32040 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32041 .code
32042 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32043 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32044 .endd
32045 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32046 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32047 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32048
32049
32050
32051 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32052 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32053 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32054 following form is logged:
32055 .code
32056 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32057 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32058 .endd
32059 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32060 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32061 .code
32062 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32063 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32064 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32065 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32066 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32067 .endd
32068 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32069 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32070 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32071 flagged with &`**`&.
32072
32073
32074
32075 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32076 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32077 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32078 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32079 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32080
32081
32082
32083 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
32084 A line of the form
32085 .code
32086 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32087 .endd
32088 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32089 at the end of its processing.
32090
32091
32092
32093
32094 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32095 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32096 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32097 the following table:
32098 .display
32099 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32100 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32101 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32102 &`CV `& certificate verification status
32103 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32104 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32105 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32106 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32107 &`H `& host name and IP address
32108 &`I `& local interface used
32109 &`id `& message id for incoming message
32110 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32111 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32112 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32113 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32114 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32115 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32116 &`S `& size of message
32117 &`ST `& shadow transport name
32118 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32119 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32120 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32121 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
32122 .endd
32123
32124
32125 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32126 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32127 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32128
32129 .ilist
32130 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32131 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32132 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32133 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32134 during the first delivery attempt.
32135 .next
32136 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32137 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32138 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32139 .next
32140 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32141 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32142 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32143 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32144 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32145 doing.
32146 .next
32147 .cindex "error" "ignored"
32148 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
32149 message:
32150 .olist
32151 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
32152 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
32153 .next
32154 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
32155 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32156 .next
32157 A delivery set up by a router configured with
32158 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
32159 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
32160 .code
32161 errors_to = <>
32162 .endd
32163 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32164 .endlist olist
32165 .endlist ilist
32166
32167
32168
32169
32170
32171 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
32172 .cindex "log" "selectors"
32173 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
32174 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
32175 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
32176 example:
32177 .code
32178 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
32179 .endd
32180 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
32181 selection marked by asterisks:
32182 .display
32183 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
32184 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
32185 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
32186 &` arguments `& command line arguments
32187 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
32188 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
32189 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
32190 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
32191 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
32192 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
32193 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
32194 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
32195 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
32196 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
32197 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
32198 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
32199 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
32200 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
32201 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
32202 &` pid `& Exim process id
32203 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
32204 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
32205 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
32206 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
32207 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
32208 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
32209 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
32210 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
32211 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
32212 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
32213 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
32214 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
32215 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
32216 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
32217 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
32218 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
32219 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
32220 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
32221 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
32222 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
32223
32224 &` all `& all of the above
32225 .endd
32226 More details on each of these items follows:
32227
32228 .ilist
32229 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
32230 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
32231 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
32232 this log selector is set.
32233 .next
32234 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
32235 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
32236 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
32237 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
32238 such users cannot access the log).
32239 .next
32240 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
32241 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
32242 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
32243 parentheses between them.
32244 .next
32245 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
32246 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
32247 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
32248 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
32249 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
32250 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
32251 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
32252 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
32253 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
32254 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
32255 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
32256 between the caller and Exim.
32257 .next
32258 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
32259 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
32260 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
32261 .next
32262 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
32263 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
32264 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
32265 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
32266 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
32267 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
32268 .next
32269 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
32270 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
32271 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
32272 .next
32273 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
32274 .cindex "size" "of message"
32275 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
32276 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
32277 .next
32278 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
32279 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
32280 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32281 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
32282 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
32283 .next
32284 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
32285 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
32286 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
32287 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
32288 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
32289 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
32290 .next
32291 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
32292 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
32293 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
32294 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
32295 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
32296 .next
32297 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
32298 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
32299 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
32300 client's ident port times out.
32301 .next
32302 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
32303 .cindex "interface" "logging"
32304 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
32305 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
32306 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
32307 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
32308 rejection lines.
32309 .next
32310 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
32311 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
32312 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
32313 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
32314 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
32315 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
32316 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
32317 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
32318 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
32319 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
32320 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
32321 .next
32322 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
32323 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
32324 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
32325 .next
32326 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
32327 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
32328 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
32329 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
32330 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
32331 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
32332 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
32333 .next
32334 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32335 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32336 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
32337 immediately after the time and date.
32338 .next
32339 .cindex "log" "queue run"
32340 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
32341 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
32342 .next
32343 .cindex "log" "queue time"
32344 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
32345 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
32346 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
32347 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
32348 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
32349 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
32350 message has been successfully received.
32351 .next
32352 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
32353 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
32354 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
32355 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
32356 .next
32357 .cindex "log" "recipients"
32358 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
32359 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
32360 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
32361 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
32362 has taken place.
32363 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
32364 in the list.
32365 .next
32366 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
32367 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
32368 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
32369 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
32370 .next
32371 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
32372 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
32373 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
32374 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
32375 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
32376 .next
32377 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
32378 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
32379 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
32380 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
32381 attempt.
32382 .next
32383 .cindex "log" "return path"
32384 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
32385 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
32386 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
32387 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
32388 .next
32389 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
32390 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
32391 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
32392 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
32393 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
32394 .next
32395 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
32396 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
32397 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
32398 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
32399 detail is lost.
32400 .next
32401 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
32402 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
32403 it is too big.
32404 .next
32405 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
32406 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
32407 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
32408 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
32409 it.
32410 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
32411 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
32412 .next
32413 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
32414 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
32415 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
32416 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
32417 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
32418 response.
32419 .next
32420 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
32421 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
32422 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
32423 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
32424 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
32425 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
32426 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
32427 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
32428 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
32429 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
32430
32431 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
32432 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
32433 reset if the daemon is restarted.
32434 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
32435 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
32436 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
32437 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
32438 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
32439 .next
32440 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
32441 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
32442 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
32443 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
32444 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
32445 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
32446 .next
32447 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
32448 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
32449 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
32450 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
32451 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
32452 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
32453 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
32454 already have their own log lines.
32455
32456 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
32457 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
32458 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
32459 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
32460 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
32461 the same logging options.
32462
32463 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
32464 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
32465 .code
32466 C=EHLO,QUIT
32467 .endd
32468 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
32469 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
32470 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
32471 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
32472 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
32473 .next
32474 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
32475 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
32476 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
32477 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
32478 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
32479 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
32480 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
32481 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
32482 .next
32483 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
32484 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
32485 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
32486 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
32487 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
32488 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
32489 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
32490 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
32491 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
32492 .next
32493 .cindex "log" "subject"
32494 .cindex "subject, logging"
32495 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
32496 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
32497 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
32498 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
32499 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
32500 .next
32501 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
32502 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
32503 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
32504 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
32505 .next
32506 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
32507 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
32508 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32509 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
32510 .next
32511 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
32512 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
32513 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32514 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
32515 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
32516 .next
32517 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
32518 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
32519 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
32520 .endlist
32521
32522
32523 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
32524 .cindex "message" "log file for"
32525 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
32526 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
32527 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
32528 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
32529 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
32530 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
32531 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
32532 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
32533 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
32534 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
32535 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
32536
32537 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
32538 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
32539 &%message_logs%& option false.
32540 .ecindex IIDloggen
32541
32542
32543
32544
32545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32547
32548 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
32549 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
32550 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
32551 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
32552 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
32553
32554 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
32555 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
32556 "list what Exim processes are doing"
32557 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
32558 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
32559 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
32560 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
32561 various criteria"
32562 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
32563 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
32564 "extract statistics from the log"
32565 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
32566 "check address acceptance from given IP"
32567 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
32568 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
32569 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
32570 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
32571 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
32572 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
32573 .endtable
32574
32575 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
32576 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
32577 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
32578
32579
32580
32581
32582 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
32583 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
32584 .cindex "process, querying"
32585 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
32586 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
32587 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
32588 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
32589 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
32590 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
32591 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
32592 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
32593 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
32594
32595 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
32596 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
32597 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
32598
32599
32600 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
32601 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
32602 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
32603 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
32604 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
32605 options:
32606 .display
32607 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
32608 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
32609 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
32610 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
32611 .endd
32612 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
32613 .code
32614 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
32615 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
32616 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
32617 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
32618 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
32619 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
32620 .endd
32621 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
32622 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
32623
32624
32625
32626 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
32627 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
32628 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
32629 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
32630 .code
32631 exim -bpu
32632 .endd
32633 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
32634 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
32635 options are available:
32636
32637 .vlist
32638 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
32639 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
32640 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
32641 .code
32642 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
32643 .endd
32644 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
32645 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
32646 brackets.
32647
32648 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
32649 Match against the size field.
32650
32651 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32652 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
32653
32654 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32655 Match messages that are older than the given time.
32656
32657 .vitem &*-z*&
32658 Match only frozen messages.
32659
32660 .vitem &*-x*&
32661 Match only non-frozen messages.
32662 .endlist
32663
32664 The following options control the format of the output:
32665
32666 .vlist
32667 .vitem &*-c*&
32668 Display only the count of matching messages.
32669
32670 .vitem &*-l*&
32671 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
32672 the default.
32673
32674 .vitem &*-i*&
32675 Display message ids only.
32676
32677 .vitem &*-b*&
32678 Brief format &-- one line per message.
32679
32680 .vitem &*-R*&
32681 Display messages in reverse order.
32682 .endlist
32683
32684 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
32685
32686
32687
32688 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
32689 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
32690 .cindex "queue" "summary"
32691 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
32692 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
32693 running a command such as
32694 .code
32695 exim -bp | exiqsumm
32696 .endd
32697 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
32698 it, as in the following example:
32699 .code
32700 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
32701 .endd
32702 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
32703 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
32704 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
32705 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
32706
32707 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
32708 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
32709 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
32710 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
32711 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
32712 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
32713 sender.
32714
32715 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
32716 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
32717 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
32718 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
32719 level"& addresses).
32720
32721
32722
32723
32724 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
32725 "SECTextspeinf"
32726 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
32727 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
32728 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
32729 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
32730 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
32731 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
32732 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
32733 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
32734 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
32735 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
32736 .display
32737 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
32738 .endd
32739 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
32740
32741 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
32742 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
32743 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
32744
32745 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
32746 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
32747 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
32748 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
32749 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
32750
32751 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
32752 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
32753 regular expression.
32754
32755 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
32756 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
32757
32758 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
32759 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
32760 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
32761
32762
32763 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
32764 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
32765 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
32766 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
32767 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
32768 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
32769 the &%--help%& option.
32770
32771
32772 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
32773 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32774 .cindex "cycling logs"
32775 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32776 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
32777 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
32778 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
32779 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
32780 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
32781 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
32782 .ilist
32783 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
32784 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
32785 .next
32786 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
32787 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
32788 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
32789 configuration.
32790 .endlist
32791
32792 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
32793 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
32794 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
32795 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
32796 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
32797 logs are handled similarly.
32798
32799 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
32800 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
32801 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
32802 any existing log files.
32803
32804 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
32805 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
32806 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
32807 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
32808 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
32809 .code
32810 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
32811 .endd
32812 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
32813 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
32814
32815
32816
32817 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
32818 .cindex "statistics"
32819 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
32820 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
32821 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
32822 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
32823 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
32824
32825 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
32826 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
32827 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
32828 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
32829 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
32830 .code
32831 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
32832 .endd
32833 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
32834 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
32835 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
32836 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
32837 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
32838 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
32839 also produced per user.
32840
32841 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
32842 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
32843 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
32844 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
32845 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
32846
32847 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
32848 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
32849 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
32850 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
32851 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
32852 an entirely separate message.
32853
32854 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
32855 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
32856 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
32857 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
32858 least one address that failed.
32859
32860 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
32861 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
32862 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
32863 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
32864 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
32865 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
32866 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
32867
32868 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
32869 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
32870 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
32871
32872 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
32873 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
32874 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
32875 .code
32876 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
32877 .endd
32878
32879 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
32880 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
32881 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
32882 .cindex "checking access"
32883 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
32884 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
32885 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
32886 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
32887 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
32888 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
32889
32890 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
32891 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
32892 .code
32893 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
32894 .endd
32895 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
32896 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
32897 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
32898 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
32899 .code
32900 Rejected:
32901 550 Relay not permitted
32902 .endd
32903 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
32904 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
32905 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
32906 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
32907 you can use:
32908 .code
32909 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
32910 -f himself@there.example
32911 .endd
32912 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
32913 mandatory arguments.
32914
32915 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
32916 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
32917 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
32918
32919
32920
32921 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
32922 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
32923 .cindex "building DBM files"
32924 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
32925 .cindex "lower casing"
32926 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
32927 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
32928 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
32929 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
32930 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
32931 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
32932
32933 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
32934 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
32935 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
32936 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
32937 files.
32938
32939 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
32940 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
32941 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
32942 well.
32943
32944 .cindex "USE_DB"
32945 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
32946 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
32947 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
32948 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
32949 .code
32950 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
32951 .endd
32952 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
32953 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
32954
32955 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
32956 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
32957 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
32958 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
32959 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
32960 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
32961
32962 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
32963 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
32964 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
32965 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
32966 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
32967 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
32968 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
32969 return code is 2.
32970
32971
32972
32973
32974 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
32975 .cindex "retry" "times"
32976 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
32977 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
32978 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
32979 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
32980 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
32981 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
32982 output. For example:
32983 .code
32984 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
32985 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
32986 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
32987 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
32988 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
32989 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
32990 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
32991 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
32992 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
32993 past final cutoff time
32994 .endd
32995 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
32996 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
32997 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
32998 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
32999 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
33000 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
33001 run very often.
33002
33003 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
33004 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
33005 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33006 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33007 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33008 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33009
33010
33011
33012 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33013 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33014 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33015 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33016 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33017 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33018 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33019
33020 .ilist
33021 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
33022 .next
33023 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33024 for remote hosts
33025 .next
33026 &'callout'&: the callout cache
33027 .next
33028 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33029 .next
33030 &'misc'&: other hints data
33031 .endlist
33032
33033 The &'misc'& database is used for
33034
33035 .ilist
33036 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33037 .next
33038 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33039 &(smtp)& transport)
33040 .endlist
33041
33042
33043
33044 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33045 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33046 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33047 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33048 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33049 .code
33050 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33051 .endd
33052 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33053 .code
33054 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
33055 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33056 .endd
33057 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33058 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33059 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33060 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33061 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33062 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33063 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33064 and a textual description of the error.
33065
33066 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33067 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33068 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33069 exceeded.
33070
33071 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33072 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33073 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33074 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33075 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33076 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33077 cross-references.
33078
33079
33080
33081 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33082 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33083 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33084 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33085 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33086 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33087 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33088 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33089 updated sufficiently often.
33090
33091 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33092 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33093 the retry database:
33094 .code
33095 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33096 .endd
33097 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33098 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33099 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33100 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33101 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33102 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33103 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33104 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33105 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33106 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33107 whenever it removes information from the database.
33108
33109 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33110 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33111 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33112 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33113 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33114
33115 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33116 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33117 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33118 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33119 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33120 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33121 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33122 tidied.
33123
33124 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33125 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33126
33127
33128
33129
33130 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33131 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33132 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33133 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33134 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33135 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33136 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33137 displayed.
33138
33139 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33140 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33141 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33142 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33143 by new data, for example:
33144 .code
33145 > 4 951102:1000
33146 .endd
33147 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33148 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33149 used as optional separators.
33150
33151
33152
33153
33154 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
33155 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
33156 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
33157 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
33158 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
33159 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
33160 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
33161 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
33162 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
33163 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
33164 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
33165 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
33166 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
33167
33168 .vlist
33169 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
33170 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
33171
33172 .vitem &%-flock%&
33173 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
33174 supports it.
33175
33176 .vitem &%-interval%&
33177 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
33178 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
33179
33180 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
33181 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
33182
33183 .vitem &%-mbx%&
33184 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
33185
33186 .vitem &%-q%&
33187 Suppress verification output.
33188
33189 .vitem &%-retries%&
33190 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
33191 the lock (default 10).
33192
33193 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
33194 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
33195 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
33196 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
33197 subsequently sees.
33198
33199 .vitem &%-timeout%&
33200 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
33201 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
33202 default), a non-blocking call is used.
33203
33204 .vitem &%-v%&
33205 Generate verbose output.
33206 .endlist
33207
33208 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
33209 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
33210 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
33211 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
33212 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
33213 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
33214 more than 30 minutes old.
33215
33216 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
33217 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
33218 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
33219 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
33220 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
33221 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
33222
33223 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
33224 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
33225 suppresses all output except error messages.
33226
33227 A command such as
33228 .code
33229 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
33230 .endd
33231 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
33232 .display
33233 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
33234 <&'some commands'&>
33235 &`End`&
33236 .endd
33237 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
33238 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
33239 such as
33240 .code
33241 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
33242 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
33243 .endd
33244 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
33245 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
33246 .ecindex IIDutils
33247
33248
33249 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33250 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33251
33252 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
33253 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
33254 .cindex "X-windows"
33255 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
33256 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
33257 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
33258 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
33259 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
33260 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
33261 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
33262 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
33263
33264
33265
33266 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
33267 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
33268 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
33269 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
33270 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
33271 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
33272 parameters are for.
33273
33274 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
33275 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
33276 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
33277 .code
33278 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
33279 .endd
33280 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
33281 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
33282 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
33283 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
33284 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
33285
33286 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
33287 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
33288 .code
33289 Eximon*background: gray94
33290 .endd
33291 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
33292 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
33293 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
33294 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
33295 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
33296 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
33297 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
33298 .code
33299 xrdb -merge <<End
33300 Eximon*highlight: gray
33301 End
33302 .endd
33303 .cindex "admin user"
33304 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
33305 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
33306
33307 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
33308 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
33309 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
33310 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
33311 different parts of the display.
33312
33313
33314
33315
33316 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
33317 .cindex "stripchart"
33318 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
33319 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33320 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
33321 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
33322 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
33323 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
33324 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
33325 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
33326 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33327
33328 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
33329 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
33330 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
33331 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
33332
33333 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
33334 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
33335 to a single partition.
33336
33337 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
33338 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
33339 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
33340 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
33341 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
33342 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33343 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33344
33345
33346
33347
33348 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
33349 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
33350 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
33351 .cindex "window size"
33352 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
33353 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
33354 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
33355 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
33356 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
33357 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
33358
33359 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
33360 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
33361 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
33362 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
33363
33364 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
33365 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
33366 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
33367 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
33368 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
33369 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33370
33371 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
33372 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
33373 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33374
33375
33376
33377 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
33378 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
33379 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
33380 the main log is maintained.
33381 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
33382 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
33383 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
33384 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
33385 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
33386
33387 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
33388 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
33389 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
33390 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
33391 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
33392 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
33393 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
33394 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
33395 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
33396 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
33397 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33398
33399 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
33400 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
33401 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
33402 It cannot go further back up the log.
33403
33404 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
33405 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
33406 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
33407 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
33408 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
33409 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
33410
33411 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
33412 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
33413 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
33414 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
33415 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
33416 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
33417
33418 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
33419 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
33420 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
33421 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
33422 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
33423 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
33424 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
33425 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
33426 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
33427 window.
33428
33429
33430
33431 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
33432 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
33433 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
33434 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
33435 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
33436 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
33437 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
33438 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
33439 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
33440 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
33441
33442 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
33443 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
33444 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
33445 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
33446 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
33447 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
33448 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
33449
33450 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
33451 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
33452 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
33453 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
33454 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
33455 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
33456 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
33457
33458 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
33459 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
33460 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
33461 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
33462
33463 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
33464 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
33465 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
33466 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
33467 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
33468 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
33469 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
33470 not shown.
33471
33472 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
33473 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
33474
33475 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
33476 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
33477 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
33478 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
33479 display is updated.
33480
33481
33482
33483 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
33484 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
33485 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
33486 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
33487 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
33488 any selected text.
33489
33490 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
33491 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
33492 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
33493 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
33494 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
33495 .code
33496 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
33497 .endd
33498 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
33499 follows:
33500
33501 .ilist
33502 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
33503 in a new text window.
33504 .next
33505 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
33506 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
33507 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
33508 .next
33509 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
33510 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
33511 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
33512 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
33513 .next
33514 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
33515 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
33516 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
33517 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
33518 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
33519 .next
33520 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
33521 that the message be frozen.
33522 .next
33523 .cindex "thawing messages"
33524 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
33525 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
33526 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
33527 that the message be thawed.
33528 .next
33529 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
33530 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
33531 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
33532 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
33533 .next
33534 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
33535 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
33536 message.
33537 .next
33538 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
33539 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33540 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33541 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33542 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
33543 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
33544 which case no action is taken.
33545 .next
33546 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
33547 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33548 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33549 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33550 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
33551 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
33552 case no action is taken.
33553 .next
33554 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
33555 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
33556 .next
33557 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
33558 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
33559 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
33560 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
33561 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
33562 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
33563 the address is qualified with that domain.
33564 .endlist
33565
33566 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
33567 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
33568 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
33569 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
33570 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
33571 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
33572 if no output is generated.
33573
33574 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
33575 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
33576 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
33577 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
33578
33579 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
33580 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
33581 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
33582 .ecindex IIDeximon
33583
33584
33585
33586
33587
33588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33589 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33590
33591 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
33592 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
33593 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
33594 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
33595
33596 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
33597 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
33598 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
33599 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
33600 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
33601 its security as compared with other MTAs.
33602
33603 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
33604 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
33605 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
33606 as soon as possible.
33607
33608
33609 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
33610 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
33611 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
33612 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
33613 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
33614 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
33615
33616 .ilist
33617 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
33618 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
33619 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
33620 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
33621 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
33622 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
33623
33624 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
33625 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
33626 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
33627 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
33628 .next
33629 If ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined, root privilege is retained for &%-C%&
33630 and &%-D%& only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
33631 also use &%-C%& and &%-D%& and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
33632 the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message
33633 reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
33634 that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
33635 privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost.
33636 However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
33637 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is not set by default.
33638 .next
33639 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
33640 is disabled.
33641 .next
33642 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
33643 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
33644 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
33645 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
33646 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
33647 .endlist
33648
33649
33650
33651
33652 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
33653 .cindex "setuid"
33654 .cindex "root privilege"
33655 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
33656 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
33657 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
33658 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
33659 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
33660 is required for two things:
33661
33662 .ilist
33663 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
33664 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
33665 not required.
33666 .next
33667 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
33668 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
33669 configuration.
33670 .endlist
33671
33672 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
33673 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
33674 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
33675 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
33676 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
33677 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
33678 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
33679 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
33680
33681 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
33682 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
33683 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
33684
33685 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
33686 uid and gid in the following cases:
33687
33688 .ilist
33689 .oindex "&%-C%&"
33690 .oindex "&%-D%&"
33691 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
33692 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
33693 calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
33694 changed to those of the calling process.
33695 However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, only
33696 root callers may use &%-C%& and &%-D%& without losing privilege, and if
33697 DISABLE_D_OPTION is set, the &%-D%& option may not be used at all.
33698 .next
33699 .oindex "&%-be%&"
33700 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
33701 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
33702 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
33703 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
33704 calling process.
33705 .next
33706 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
33707 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
33708 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
33709 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
33710 testing address verification
33711 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
33712 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
33713 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
33714 option).
33715 .next
33716 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
33717 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
33718 .endlist
33719
33720 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
33721
33722 .ilist
33723 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
33724 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
33725 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
33726 will be used during message reception.
33727 .next
33728 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
33729 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
33730 .next
33731 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
33732 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
33733 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
33734 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
33735 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
33736 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
33737 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
33738 generating bounce and warning messages.
33739
33740 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
33741 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
33742 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
33743 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
33744 .next
33745 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
33746 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
33747 .endlist
33748
33749
33750
33751
33752 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
33753 .cindex "privilege, running without"
33754 .cindex "unprivileged running"
33755 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
33756 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
33757 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
33758 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
33759 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
33760 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
33761 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
33762 to any other uid.
33763
33764 .cindex SIGHUP
33765 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
33766 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
33767 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
33768 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
33769
33770 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
33771 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
33772 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
33773 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
33774 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
33775
33776 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
33777 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
33778 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
33779 effect.
33780
33781 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
33782 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
33783 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
33784
33785 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
33786 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
33787 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
33788 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
33789 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
33790 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
33791 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
33792 address this problem at this time.
33793
33794 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
33795 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
33796 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
33797 be used in the most straightforward way.
33798
33799 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
33800 number of restrictions on what you can do:
33801
33802 .ilist
33803 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
33804 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
33805 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
33806 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
33807 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
33808 .next
33809 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
33810 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
33811 .next
33812 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
33813 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
33814 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
33815 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
33816 .next
33817 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
33818 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
33819
33820 .olist
33821 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
33822 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
33823 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
33824 .next
33825 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
33826 owned by the Exim user.
33827 .next
33828 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
33829 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
33830 mailboxes need to be created manually.
33831 .endlist olist
33832 .endlist ilist
33833
33834
33835 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
33836 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
33837 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
33838 gives more security at essentially no cost.
33839
33840 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
33841 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
33842
33843
33844
33845
33846 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
33847 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
33848 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
33849
33850
33851
33852 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
33853 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
33854 .cindex "IP source routing"
33855 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
33856 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
33857 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
33858 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
33859
33860
33861
33862 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
33863 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
33864 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
33865
33866
33867
33868
33869 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
33870 .cindex "trusted users"
33871 .cindex "admin user"
33872 .cindex "privileged user"
33873 .cindex "user" "trusted"
33874 .cindex "user" "admin"
33875 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
33876 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
33877 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
33878 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
33879 permit a remote host to be specified.
33880
33881 .oindex "&%-f%&"
33882 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
33883 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
33884 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
33885 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
33886 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
33887 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
33888
33889 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
33890 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
33891 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
33892 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
33893 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
33894
33895 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
33896 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
33897 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
33898 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
33899 includes the contents of files on the spool.
33900
33901 .oindex "&%-M%&"
33902 .oindex "&%-q%&"
33903 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
33904 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
33905 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
33906 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
33907 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
33908 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
33909
33910 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
33911 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
33912 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
33913 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
33914 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
33915 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
33916 files.
33917
33918
33919
33920 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
33921 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
33922 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
33923 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
33924 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
33925 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
33926
33927
33928
33929 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
33930 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
33931 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
33932 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
33933 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
33934 this.
33935
33936
33937
33938 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
33939 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
33940 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
33941 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
33942 converted output.
33943
33944
33945
33946 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
33947 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
33948 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
33949 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
33950 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
33951
33952
33953
33954 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
33955 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
33956 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
33957 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
33958 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
33959 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
33960 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
33961
33962 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
33963 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
33964 string.
33965
33966
33967
33968 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
33969 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
33970 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
33971 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
33972
33973
33974
33975 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
33976 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
33977 enough to hold the result.
33978 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
33979
33980
33981
33982
33983 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33985
33986 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
33987 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
33988 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
33989 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
33990 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
33991 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
33992 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
33993 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
33994 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
33995 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
33996 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
33997 themselves are recoverable.
33998
33999 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
34000 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
34001 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
34002
34003 .ilist
34004 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
34005 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34006 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34007 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34008 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34009 .next
34010 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34011 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34012 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34013 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34014 will always be the case.
34015 .next
34016 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34017 .next
34018 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34019 signature.
34020 .endlist
34021 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34022
34023 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34024 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34025 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34026 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34027 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34028 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34029 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34030 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34031 attempt.
34032
34033 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34034 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34035 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34036 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34037 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34038 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34039 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34040 normally the Exim user.
34041
34042 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34043 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34044 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34045 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34046 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34047 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34048 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34049 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34050
34051 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34052 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34053 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34054 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34055
34056 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34057 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34058
34059 .vlist
34060 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34061 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34062 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34063 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34064 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34065 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34066 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34067 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34068 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34069 newlines.
34070
34071 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34072 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34073 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34074 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34075 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34076 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34077
34078 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34079 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34080 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34081 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34082 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34083 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34084
34085 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34086 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34087 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34088
34089 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34090 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34091 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34092 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34093 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34094
34095 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34096 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34097 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34098 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34099 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34100
34101 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34102 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34103 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34104
34105 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34106 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34107 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34108
34109 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34110 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34111 present.
34112
34113 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34114 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34115 present if the number is greater than zero.
34116
34117 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34118 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34119 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34120
34121 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34122 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34123 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34124
34125 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34126 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34127 command.
34128
34129 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34130 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34131 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
34132 messages.
34133
34134 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
34135 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
34136 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
34137 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
34138
34139 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
34140 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
34141 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
34142
34143 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34144 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
34145 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
34146 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
34147 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
34148 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
34149
34150 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
34151 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
34152 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
34153 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
34154 supplied by the remote host, if any.
34155
34156 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34157 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
34158 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
34159 generated messages.
34160
34161 .vitem &%-local%&
34162 The message is from a local sender.
34163
34164 .vitem &%-localerror%&
34165 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
34166
34167 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
34168 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
34169 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
34170 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
34171
34172 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
34173 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
34174 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
34175
34176 .vitem &%-N%&
34177 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
34178 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
34179 &%-N%& is assumed.
34180
34181 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
34182 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
34183 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34184
34185 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
34186 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
34187 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
34188
34189 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
34190 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
34191 of &$spam_score_int$&.
34192
34193 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
34194 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
34195 certificate was verified by the server.
34196
34197 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
34198 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
34199 name of the cipher suite that was used.
34200
34201 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
34202 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
34203 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
34204 certificate.
34205 .endlist
34206
34207 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
34208 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
34209 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
34210 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
34211 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
34212 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
34213 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
34214 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
34215 addresses are complete.
34216
34217 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
34218 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
34219 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
34220 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
34221 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
34222 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
34223 .code
34224 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
34225 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
34226 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34227 .endd
34228 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
34229 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
34230 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
34231 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
34232 example:
34233 .code
34234 4
34235 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34236 darcy@austen.fict.example
34237 rdo@foundation
34238 alice@wonderland.fict.example
34239 .endd
34240 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
34241 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
34242 line is of the following form:
34243 .display
34244 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
34245 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
34246 .endd
34247 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
34248 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
34249 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
34250 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
34251 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
34252 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
34253 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
34254 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
34255
34256
34257 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
34258 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
34259 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
34260 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
34261 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
34262 following:
34263
34264 .table2 50pt
34265 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
34266 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
34267 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
34268 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
34269 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
34270 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
34271 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
34272 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
34273 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
34274 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
34275 .endtable
34276
34277 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
34278 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
34279 typical set of headers:
34280 .code
34281 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
34282 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34283 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
34284 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
34285 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
34286 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
34287 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
34288 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34289 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
34290 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34291 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34292 .endd
34293 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
34294 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
34295 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
34296 .ecindex IIDforspo1
34297 .ecindex IIDforspo2
34298 .ecindex IIDforspo3
34299
34300 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34301 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34302
34303 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail) - RFC4871" "CHID12" &&&
34304 "DKIM Support"
34305 .cindex "DKIM"
34306
34307 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
34308 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
34309
34310 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
34311 .olist
34312 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
34313 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
34314 .next
34315 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
34316 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
34317 different signature context.
34318 .endlist
34319
34320 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
34321 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
34322 Exim's standard controls.
34323
34324 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
34325 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
34326 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
34327 signature status. Here is an example:
34328 .code
34329 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM: d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
34330 .endd
34331 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
34332 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
34333 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
34334 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
34335 senders).
34336
34337
34338 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
34339 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
34340
34341 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
34342 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
34343
34344 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
34345 MANDATORY
34346 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
34347 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
34348
34349 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
34350 MANDATORY
34351 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
34352 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
34353 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
34354 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
34355
34356 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
34357 MANDATORY
34358 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
34359 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
34360 The result can either
34361 .ilist
34362 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
34363 .next
34364 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
34365 the private key.
34366 .next
34367 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
34368 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
34369 is set.
34370 .endlist
34371
34372 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
34373 OPTIONAL
34374 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
34375 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
34376 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
34377 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
34378
34379 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
34380 OPTIONAL
34381 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
34382 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
34383 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
34384 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
34385 variables here.
34386
34387 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
34388 OPTIONAL
34389 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
34390 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
34391 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
34392 used.
34393
34394
34395 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
34396 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
34397
34398 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
34399 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
34400 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
34401
34402 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
34403 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
34404 runtime of the ACL.
34405
34406 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
34407 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
34408 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
34409 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
34410
34411 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
34412 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
34413 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
34414 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-
34415 separated list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
34416 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
34417 it defaults as:
34418 .code
34419 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
34420 .endd
34421 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
34422 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
34423 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
34424 .code
34425 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
34426 .endd
34427 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
34428 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
34429 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. Example:
34430 .code
34431 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
34432 .endd
34433
34434 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
34435 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
34436
34437
34438 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
34439 available (from most to least important):
34440
34441 .vlist
34442 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
34443 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be domain or
34444 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
34445 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
34446 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
34447 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
34448 .ilist
34449 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
34450 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34451 .next
34452 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
34453 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34454 .next
34455 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
34456 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34457 .next
34458 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
34459 .endlist
34460 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
34461 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
34462 "fail" or "invalid". One of
34463 .ilist
34464 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
34465 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
34466 .next
34467 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
34468 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
34469 .next
34470 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
34471 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
34472 means that the message body was modified in transit.
34473 .next
34474 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
34475 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
34476 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
34477 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
34478 .endlist
34479 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
34480 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
34481 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
34482 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34483 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
34484 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
34485 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
34486 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34487 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
34488 The key record selector string
34489 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
34490 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
34491 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
34492 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34493 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
34494 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34495 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
34496 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
34497 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
34498 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
34499 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
34500 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
34501 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
34502 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
34503 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
34504 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
34505 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
34506 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
34507 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
34508 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
34509 integer size comparisons against this value.
34510 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
34511 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
34512 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
34513 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
34514 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomaining%&
34515 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
34516 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
34517 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34518 in the key record.
34519 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
34520 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34521 in the key record.
34522 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
34523 Notes from the key record (tag n=)
34524 .endlist
34525
34526 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
34527
34528 .vlist
34529 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
34530 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
34531 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
34532 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
34533 verb to a group of domains or identities, like:
34534
34535 .code
34536 # Warn when message apparently from GMail has no signature at all
34537 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
34538 sender_domains = gmail.com
34539 dkim_signers = gmail.com
34540 dkim_status = none
34541 .endd
34542
34543 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
34544 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
34545 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
34546 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, like:
34547
34548 .code
34549 deny message = Message from Paypal with invalid or missing signature
34550 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
34551 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
34552 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
34553 .endd
34554
34555 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
34556 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
34557 for more information of what they mean.
34558 .endlist
34559
34560
34561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34563
34564 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
34565 "Adding drivers or lookups"
34566 .cindex "adding drivers"
34567 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
34568 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
34569 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
34570 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
34571
34572 .olist
34573 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
34574 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
34575 .next
34576 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
34577 .display
34578 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
34579 .endd
34580 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
34581 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
34582 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
34583 .next
34584 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
34585 .code
34586 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
34587 .endd
34588 .next
34589 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
34590 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
34591 .next
34592 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
34593 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
34594 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
34595 .next
34596 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
34597 &_src_&.
34598 .next
34599 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
34600 as for other drivers and lookups.
34601 .endlist
34602
34603 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
34604 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
34605 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
34606 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
34607 searched using a binary chop procedure.
34608
34609 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
34610 the interface that is expected.
34611
34612
34613
34614
34615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34616 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34617
34618 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34619 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
34620 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
34621 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
34622 . processors.
34623 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34624
34625 .literal xml
34626 <?sdop
34627 format="newpage"
34628 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
34629 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
34630 ?>
34631 .literal off
34632
34633 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
34634 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
34635 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
34636
34637
34638 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34639 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////